ipkii hardware man
Notice
Note that when converting this document from its original format to a
.pdf file, some minor font and format changes may occur. When
viewing and printing this document, we cannot guarantee that your
specific PC or printer will support all of the fonts or graphics.
Therefore, when you view the document, fonts may be substituted and
your individual printer may not have the capability to print the
document correctly.
SYSTEM HARDWARE
MANUAL
INT-1076 (IPK II)
OCUMENT REVISION 3
ERSION 2000)
D
(V
NEC Unified Solutions, Inc. reserves the right to change the specifications,
functions, or features at any time without notice.
NEC Unified Solutions, Inc. has prepared this document for use by its
employees and customers. The information contained herein is the property of
NEC Unified Solutions, Inc. and shall not be reproduced without prior written
approval of NEC Unified Solutions, Inc.
Dterm and NEAX is a registered trademark of NEC Corporation and Electra Elite is
a registered trademark of NEC America, Inc. Windows is a registered trademark
of Microsoft Corporation. AT&T is a registered trademark of AT&T Wireless
Services, Inc.
Copyright 2006
NEC Infrontia, Inc.
6535 N. State Highway 161
Irving, TX 75039-2402
Technology Development
Preface
___________________________________________________________________________________
GENERAL
INFORMATION
Congratulations! You have purchased the NEC Electra Elite IPK II System.
The feature-rich Electra Elite IPK II key system provides over 200 features including
Computer Telephony Integration, Least Cost Routing, Automatic Call Distribution, T1,
ISDN-BRI Voice Trunks, ISDN-PRI Voice Trunks, Voice over Internet Protocol, and
many others.
The Electra Elite IPK II system provides what the customer needs today, and as
business expands the system can be expanded to grow as well.
The Electra Elite IPK II system has a set of manuals that provide all the information
necessary to install and support the system. This preface describes these manuals.
THIS MANUAL
This manual contains detailed instructions to install the Electra Elite IPK II KSUs,
ETUs, Multiline Terminals, and optional equipment in the following chapters.
Chapter 1 – Regulatory Information
This chapter provides important regulatory information.
Chapter 2 – Introduction
This chapter provides an overview of the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Chapter 3– System Specifications
This chapter contains detailed specifications for the Electra Elite IPK II system and
should be carefully reviewed by the technician before installing the system.
Chapter 4 – Hardware Requirements
This chapter contains the hardware requirements for the Electra Elite IPK II system
and should be read by the technician before installing the system.
Chapter 5 – Installing KSUs
This chapter contains the information necessary for installing the basic and expansion
KSUs. The technician should become familiar with this section before starting
installation.
Chapter 6 – Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
This chapter contains instructions to install the Electronic Telephone Units (ETUs) in
the Basic and Expansion KSUs.
Chapter 7 – Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
This chapter provides information regarding Music on Hold, Station Background
Music and external paging.
Chapter 8 – Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
This chapter describes the Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals that can be used with
the Electra Elite IPK II system and provides installation instructions for each
telephone.
Chapter 9 – Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
This chapter contains installation instructions for Electra Elite IPK II optional
equipment that can be added to the system as a customer’s business grows.
Chapter 10– Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
This chapter describes the available Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be used
with the Electra Elite IPK II system and provides installation instructions for each
telephone.
Chapter 11 – Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
This chapter contains installation instructions for installing Electra Elite optional
equipment that can be added to the Electra Elite IPK II as a customer’s business
grows.
Chapter 12 – Installing Single Line Telephones
This chapter describes the single line telephones that are compatible with the Electra
Elite IPK II system. Installation instructions are provided where necessary.
Chapter 13 – Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
This chapter describes the cordless and wireless telephones that are compatible with
the Electra Elite IPK II system and provides installation instructions where necessary.
Chapter 14 – System Maintenance
This chapter is a guide to help the technician troubleshoot and diagnose problems
during and after system installation.
Appendix A – Glossary of Abbreviations
This chapter provides a list of commonly used abbreviations that are found
throughout the manual.
SUPPORTING
DOCUMENTS
Other manuals in the set are described below.
Electra Elite IPK II Features and Specifications Manual
This manual describes each available feature for the system.
Electra Elite IPK II General Description Manual
This manual contains general information about the system features, configuration
and standards. This overview of the Electra Elite IPK II system is useful when
presenting information to potential customers.
Electra Elite IPK II Programming Manual
This manual contains all programming instructions for the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Electra Elite IPK II PC Programming Manual
This manual describes the operation of the PCPro program for the Electra Elite IPK II
key telephone system. This program is a user-friendly Windows application that
allows the user to program and configure features of the Electra Elite IPK II KTS from
the PC environment.
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 1
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ....................................................................................... 1-1
Section 2
Company Notification .................................................................................... 1-1
Section 3
Incidence of Harm .......................................................................................... 1-2
Section 4
Radio Frequency Interference ....................................................................... 1-3
Section 5
Hearing Aid Compatibility ............................................................................. 1-3
Section 6
Direct Inward Dialing ...................................................................................... 1-3
Section 7
Voice Announcement/Monitoring Over DID Lines ...................................... 1-4
Section 8
Music On Hold ................................................................................................ 1-4
Section 9
Service Requirements .................................................................................... 1-4
Section 10
UL Regulatory Information ............................................................................ 1-4
Section 11
Industry Canada Requirements .................................................................... 1-5
Section 12
Battery Disposal ............................................................................................. 1-6
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List Of tables
Chapter 1
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 1-1
FIC, REN, SOC, and Jacks for Electra Elite IPK II System ETUs .............................. 1-2
Table 1-2
Battery Types and Quantities for KSUs and ETUs ..................................................... 1-6
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Tables
Regulatory Information
Chapter 1
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
Established Federal Communications Commission (FCC) rules permit this telephone
system to be directly connected to the telephone network. A jack is provided by the
telephone company. Jacks for this type of customer provided equipment are not
provided on party lines or coin lines.
The telephone company may change technical operations and procedures. When
such changes affect the compatibility or use of the Electra Elite IPK II system, the
telephone company is required to give adequate notice of the changes.
SECTION 2
COMPANY NOTIFICATION
Before connecting this telephone system to the telephone network, the following
information must be provided to the telephone company:
1.
Your telephone Number.
2.
FCC registration number:
J
When the system is to be installed as a Key Function system (no dial
access to Trunk Groups/Route Advance Blocks), use the following
number:
NIFMUL-43074-KF-E
J
When the system is to be installed as a Multifunction system, use the
following number:
NIFMUL-43076-MF-E
J
When the system is to be installed as a PBX system, use the following
number:
NIFMUL-43075-PF-E
J
J
Ringer Equivalence Number (REN): 2.0B
USOC jacks required: RJ21X and RJ2GX
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
1-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
The Facility Interface Code (FIC), Ringer Equivalent Number (REN), Service Order
Code (SOC), and Jack for each interface ETU are listed in the following table:
Table 1-1 FIC, REN, SOC, and Jacks for Electra Elite IPK II System ETUs
Trunk/Station ETU Type
FIC
REN
SOC
Jack
02IS5
N/A
6.0F
N/A
02RV-O
0.7A
9.0F
RJ21X
COI(4)-U( ) ETU (Loop Start)
02LS2
0.7A
9.0F
RJ21X
COI(8)-U( ) ETU (Loop Start)
02LS2
0.7A
9.0F
RJ21X
COI(8)-U( ) ETU (Ground Start)
02GS2
0.7A
9.0F
RJ21X
COIB(4)-U(10) ETU for COI/COID
Mode (Loop Start)
02LS2
0.7A
9.0F
RJ21X
COIB(4)-U(10) ETU for COI Mode
(Ground Start)
02GS2
0.7A
9.0F
RJ21X
COIB(4)-U(20) ETU for COID/COI
Mode (Loop Start)
02LS2
0.7A
9.0F
RJ21X
COIB(8)-U( ) ETU for COI/COID
Mode (Loop Start)
02LS2
0.7A
9.0F
RJ21X
02RV2T
N/A
9.0F
RJ21X
04DU9-BN
04DU9-DN
04DU9-1KN
04DU9-1SN
N/A
6.0P
N/A
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU
0L13C
N/A
9.0F
RJ21X
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU
TL31M
N/A
9.0F
RJ21X
BRT(4)-U( ) ETU
CAMA Trunk
DID(4)-U( ) ETU
DTI-U( ) ETU
SECTION 3
INCIDENCE OF HARM
When the system is malfunctioning, it could harm the telephone network. The
telephone system should be disconnected until the problem can be determined and
repair is made. When this is not done, the telephone company may temporarily
disconnect service.
___________________________________________________________________________________
1-2
Regulatory Information
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 4
RADIO FREQUENCY INTERFERENCE
In compliance with FCC Part 15 rules, the following statement is provided:
IMPORTANT NOTE
“This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and when not
installed and used in accordance with the System Hardware Manual, may cause interference
to radio communications. This equipment has been tested and approved for compliance with
the limits for a Class B (except as noted below) computing device pursuant to Subpart J of
Part 15 of FCC Rules, that provide reasonable protection against such interference when
operated in a commercial environment. Operation of this telephone system in a residential
area is likely to cause interference, in which case, the user, at his or her own expense, is
required to take whatever measures may be required to correct the interference.”
When equipped with the B64-U30 KSU and P64-U20 PSU, the Electra Elite IPK II can
be operated as a Class B device except when using one of the ETUs in the following
table. The system then becomes a Class A device that may not be used in a residential
area.
CCH(4)-U-10
CMS(2)/(4)-U30
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U30
HUB(8)-U( )
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U30
SECTION 5
HEARING AID COMPATIBILITY
The NEC Multiline Terminals and NEC Single Line Telephones provided for this
system are hearing aid compatible. The manufacturer of other Single Line
Telephones for use with the system must provide notice of hearing aid compatibility to
comply with FCC rules that prohibit the use of non-hearing aid compatible telephones.
SECTION 6
DIRECT INWARD DIALING
Operating this equipment without providing proper answer supervision is a violation of
Part 68 of the FCC rules.
Proper Answer Supervision occurs when:
J
This equipment returns answer supervision to the Public Switched Telephone
Network (PSTN) when Direct Inward Dialing (DID) calls are:
H
H
H
H
Answered by the called station.
Answered by the Attendant.
Routed to a recorded announcement that can be administered by the
Customer Premise Equipment (CPE) user.
Routed to a dial prompt.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
1-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
This equipment returns answer supervision on all DID calls forwarded to the
Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN). Permissible exceptions are:
H
H
H
SECTION 7
A call is unanswered.
A busy tone is received.
A reorder tone is received.
VOICE ANNOUNCEMENT/MONITORING OVER DID LINES
CAUTION
The use of monitoring, recording or listening devices to eavesdrop, monitor, retrieve or record
telephone conversations or other sound activities, whether or not contemporaneous with its
transmission, may be illegal in certain circumstances under federal or state laws. Legal advise
should be sought prior to implementing any practice that monitors or records any telephone
conversation. Some federal and state laws require some form of notification to all parties to
the telephone conversation, such as using a beep tone or other notification methods, or
require the consent of all parties to the telephone conversation, prior to monitoring or
recording a telephone conversation. Some of these laws incorporate strict penalties.
SECTION 8
MUSIC ON HOLD
IMPORTANT NOTE
"In accordance with U.S. Copyright Law, a license may be required from the American Society
of Composers, Authors and Publishers, or other similar organization, when radio or TV
broadcasts are transmitted through the Music On Hold feature of this telecommunication
system. NEC Unified Solutions, Inc., hereby disclaims any liability arising out of the failure to
obtain such a license."
SECTION 9
SERVICE REQUIREMENTS
When equipment malfunctions, all repairs will be performed by NEC Unified
Solutions, Inc. or by an authorized agent. The user must report the need for service to
an NEC Unified Solutions, Inc. authorized agent or to NEC Unified Solutions, Inc.
SECTION 10
UL REGULATORY INFORMATION
This equipment has been listed by Underwriters Laboratories and complies with all
applicable requirements of the standard for telephone equipment UL 1459.
___________________________________________________________________________________
1-4
Regulatory Information
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 11
INDUSTRY CANADA REQUIREMENTS
Industry Canada has established rules that permit this telephone system to be directly
connected to the telephone network. Prior to the connection or disconnection of this
telephone system to or from the telephone network, the telephone company must be
provided with the following information.
1. Your telephone number:
2. IC Certificate number: 140 7942 A
3. Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) of the equipment: 2.1
The Industry Canada label identifies certified equipment. This certification means that
the equipment meets certain telecommunications network protective, operational and
safety requirements as prescribed in the applicable Terminal Equipment Technical
requirements document(s). The Department does not guarantee that equipment
operates to user satisfaction.
Before installation, the user should ensure that it is permissible to connect this
equipment to the facilities of the local telecommunications company. The equipment
must also be installed using an acceptable method of connection. The customer
should be aware that compliance with the above conditions may not prevent
degradation of service in some situations.
Repairs to certified equipment should be coordinated by a representative designated
by the supplier. Any repairs or alterations made by the user to this equipment, or
equipment malfunctions, may give the telecommunications company cause to request
the user to disconnect the equipment.
Users should ensure for their own protection that the electrical ground connections of
the power utility, telephone lines and internal metallic water pipe system, when
present, are connected together. This precaution may be particularly important in
rural areas.
CAUTION
Users should not attempt to make such connections themselves, but should contact the
applicable electric inspection authority, or electrician.
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) assigned to each terminal device provides an
indication of the maximum number of terminals allowed to be connected to a
telephone interface. The termination of an interface may consist of any combination
of devices subject only to the requirement that the sum of the Ringer Equivalent
Numbers of all the devices does not exceed five.
This equipment is listed by the Canadian Standards Association and complies with all
applicable requirements of the standard for telephone equipment C 22.2 No. 225.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
1-5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
This equipment meets IC requirements CS03.
This digital apparatus does not exceed the Class A limits for radio noise emissions
from digital apparatus as regulated by the radio interference regulations of Industry
Canada.
Le present appareil numerique n’emet pas de bruits radioelectriques depassant les
limites applicables aux appareils numeriques de Classe A prescrites dans le
reglement sur le brouillage radioelectrique edicte par Industrie Canada.
SECTION 12
BATTERY DISPOSAL
The Electra Elite IPK II system includes the batteries listed below. When disposing of
these batteries, KSUs, and/or ETUs, you must comply with applicable federal and
state regulations regarding proper disposal procedures.
Table 1-2 Battery Types and Quantities for KSUs and ETUs
Unit Name
Type of Battery
Quantity
Lead Acid
2
CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
Lithium
1
CTI/VP(4)/(8)/(12)/(16)-U( ) ETU
Lithium
1
DTP-1HM-1 TEL
DTP-1HM-2 TEL
Lithium
1
DTP-16HC-1 TEL
Nickel-Cadmium
1
DTR-1HM-1 TEL
Lithium
1
DTH-4R-1/2 TEL
Nickel-Cadmium
1
DTR-4R-1/2 TEL
Nickel-Cadmium
1
Lead Acid
1
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
Nickel-Cadmium
1
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
Lithium
1
B64-U20 KSU
DTU-4R-1 TEL
The Electra Elite IPK II CPUII( )-U( ) ETU provides memory backup for approximately
three years. The Lithium battery should be replaced about every two years.
___________________________________________________________________________________
1-6
Regulatory Information
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
IMPORTANT SAFEGUARDS FOR BATTERY DISPOSAL
DO NOT PLACE USED BATTERIES IN YOUR REGULAR TRASH! THE PRODUCT
YOU PURCHASED CONTAINS A NICKEL-CADMIUM OR SEALED LEAD
BATTERY. NICKEL-CADMIUM OR SEALED LEAD BATTERIES MUST BE
COLLECTED, RECYCLED, OR DISPOSED OF IN AN ENVIRONMENTALLY
SOUND MANNER.
The incineration, landfilling or mixing of nickel-cadmium or sealed lead batteries with
the municipal solid waste stream is PROHIBITED BY LAW in most areas. Contact
your local solid waste management officials for other information regarding the
environmentally sound collection, recycling, and disposal of the battery.
Nickel-Cadmium (or sealed lead) batteries must be returned to a federal or state
approved nickel-cadmium (or sealed lead) battery recycler. This may be where the
batteries were originally sold or a local seller of automotive batteries. Contact your
local waste management officials for other information regarding the environmentally
sound collection, recycling and disposal of the battery contained in this product. For
Ni-Cd batteries, you can also call 1-800-8-BATTERYSM if further information is
required.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
1-7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
The packaging for the Electra Elite IPK II system contains the following labels
regarding proper disposal.
PRODUCT PACKAGE LABELING
CONTAINS NICKEL-CADMIUM BATTERY.
BATTERY MUST BE RECYCLED OR
DISPOSED OF PROPERLY. MUST NOT BE
DISPOSED OF IN MUNICIPAL WASTE.
Ni-Cd
CONTAINS SEALED LEAD BATTERY.
BATTERY MUST BE RECYCLED. MUST NOT
BE DISPOSED OF IN MUNICIPAL WASTE.
Pb
CONTAINS NICKEL-METAL HYDRIDE
BATTERY. BATTERY MUST BE RECYCLED
OR DISPOSED OF PROPERLY. MUST NOT
BE DISPOSED OF IN MUNICIPAL WASTE.
Ni-MH
___________________________________________________________________________________
1-8
Regulatory Information
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 2
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ....................................................................................... 2-1
1.1
Unique Design ............................................................................................. 2-1
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List of Figures
Chapter 2
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 2-1
System Configuration Example .................................................................................. 2-3
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures
Introduction
Chapter 2
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.1
Unique Design
The Electra Elite IPK II system is a powerful key system that meets the ever
changing business communications demands of today. Unique compact
design allows it to be easily and quickly installed.
The Electra Elite IPK II system can grow with your business. You can easily
and economically increase port size when necessary. Two expansion units
can be added when the CPUII( )-U( ) ETU is installed in the basic cabinet. A
full-blown system includes the basic and two expansion units.
Electra Elite IPK II is a feature-rich system that provides telephone functions
and supports advanced features such as:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
Automatic Number Indication (ANI)/Caller ID
Automatic Call Distribution (ACD)
Automatic Route Selection
Caller ID Call Return
Centralized Voice Mail
Computer Telephony Integration (CTI)
Dialed Number Indication Service (DNIS)
Dterm Cordless II Terminal
Dterm Handset Cordless
Dterm Headset Cordless
E911 Compatibility
Integrated Digital Voice Mail
ISDN-BRI and ISDN-PRI Voice Trunks
K-CCIS Common Channel Interoffice Signaling
Least Cost Routing
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
2-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
Live Monitoring
Live Record
Multiline Conference Bridge
Multilingual LCD Indication
Multiple Music on Hold Using CO Interface
PC Attendant Console
Unified Messaging
Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP)
Wireless
The Electra Elite IPK II system offers a variety of compatible 8-line, 16-line,
and 32-line Multiline Terminals with/without LCD. A 2-line non-LCD terminal
and a 60-line Attendant Console are also available.
A customer with existing Electra Elite or Electric Elite IPK terminals can easily
connect them to the Electra Elite IPK II system to provide inexpensive
migration. Most Electra Elite IPK II system features are available with the
Electra Elite or Electric Elite IPK Multiline Terminals.
The Electra Elite IPK II system supports a wide range of additional equipment
such as Single Line Telephones, external speakers, facsimile machines,
external microphones, and headsets that can be connected to the system to
accommodate individual customer needs. The diagram in Figure 2-1 System
Configuration Example shows an Electra Elite IPK II system with standard and
optional equipment (some locally provided).
___________________________________________________________________________________
2-2
Introduction
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
External
Speakerphone
Message
Display Board
Least Cost Routing
External
Speaker
Wireless – DECT
Computer Telephony Integration
ElectraMail CTI (Unified Messaging)
Electra Elite Multiline Terminal (DTU)
Dterm Series E Multiline Terminal (DTP)
Automatic Call Distribution
PC Programming
Headset
Electra
Elite IPK Multiline Terminals (DTH)
Dterm
Series i Multiline Terminal (DTR)
term
D
IPK (ITH) IP Terminals
Station Message Detail
Recording (SMDR)
Answering Machine
Facsimile
CO/PBX/Centrex/DID
/Tie/FT1/ISDN-BRI/ISDN-PRI
Single Line
Telephone
Attendant
Console
ITH IP Stations
Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP)
Trunks/Stations
Dterm ISDN EXTender Plus
(Telecommuting)
Dterm Cordless Lite II
Dterm Headset Cordless
Dterm Handset Cordless
Dterm Cordless II
Figure 2-1 System Configuration Example
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
2-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
2-4
Introduction
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ....................................................................................... 3-1
Section 2
System Block Diagram .................................................................................. 3-1
Section 3
Maximum System Capacities ........................................................................ 3-5
Section 4
KSU Power-Based Calculator Chart ........................................................... 3-18
Section 5
System Requirements and Specifications ................................................. 3-22
5.1
Cabling Requirements and Specifications ................................................ 3-22
5.2
Cabling Precautions .................................................................................. 3-24
5.3
5.2.1
Cable Placement ............................................................................................ 3-24
5.2.2
Environmental Conditions ............................................................................... 3-25
Power Requirements ................................................................................. 3-25
5.3.1
Power Supply Inputs ....................................................................................... 3-25
5.3.2
Power Supply Consumption ........................................................................... 3-25
5.4
Outside Line Types ................................................................................... 3-26
5.5
Transmission, Network, and Control Specifications .................................. 3-26
5.6
5.7
5.5.1
Transmission .................................................................................................. 3-26
5.5.2
Network ........................................................................................................... 3-27
5.5.3
Control ............................................................................................................ 3-27
5.5.4
Electra Elite IPK Terminals and Equipment .................................................... 3-27
5.5.5
Series i Terminals ........................................................................................... 3-28
Dialing Specifications ................................................................................ 3-29
5.6.1
Dial Pulse Address Signaling .......................................................................... 3-29
5.6.2
Dual-Tone Multifrequency (DTMF) Address Signaling ................................... 3-29
Battery Backup .......................................................................................... 3-30
5.7.1
System Backup ............................................................................................... 3-30
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.7.2
Memory Backup .............................................................................................. 3-30
5.8
Weights and Dimensions .......................................................................... 3-31
5.9
External Equipment Interface ................................................................... 3-35
5.10
5.9.1
Music on Hold/Station Background Music ...................................................... 3-35
5.9.2
Music for Station BGM using Analog CO Trunk ETU
(COI, COIB, or COID) ..................................................................................... 3-35
5.9.3
External Paging (Audio) .................................................................................. 3-35
5.9.4
External Tone Ringer/Night Chime Output ..................................................... 3-36
5.9.5
SMDR Output ................................................................................................. 3-36
5.9.6
PC Connection ................................................................................................ 3-36
5.9.7
ACD/MIS Connector ....................................................................................... 3-36
5.9.8
Relay Contact ................................................................................................. 3-36
Audible and Visual Indications ................................................................. 3-36
5.10.1 Tone Patterns ................................................................................................. 3-36
5.10.2 LED Flash Patterns ......................................................................................... 3-36
Section 6
Traffic Capacity ............................................................................................ 3-39
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List Of figures and tables
Chapter 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-1
List of Abbreviations ................................................................................................... 3-1
Figure 3-1
System Block Diagram ............................................................................................... 3-4
Table 3-2
Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs ........................................... 3-5
Table 3-3
Maximum System Capacities for Trunk Interface ETUs ........................................... 3-12
Table 3-4
Maximum System Capacities for Application Interface ETUs ................................. 3-16
Table 3-5
KSU Power-Based Calculator Chart ........................................................................3-19
Table 3-6
Dterm Series i or Dterm IP Terminal Loop Resistance and Cable Length .................. 3-22
Table 3-7
Electra Elite/Dterm Series E Multiline Terminal
Loop Resistance and Cable Length ......................................................................... 3-23
Figure 3-2
Connecting the ESI Using Twisted 2-Pair Cable ...................................................... 3-23
Table 3-8
Cable Connection Between the Analog Port and the
Single Line Equipment ............................................................................................. 3-24
Table 3-9
Cabling Requirements ..............................................................................................3-24
Table 3-10
Power Consumption ................................................................................................. 3-25
Table 3-11
Fuse Replacement ................................................................................................... 3-26
Table 3-12
Weights and Dimensions ..........................................................................................3-31
Table 3-13
Tone Patterns ........................................................................................................... 3-37
Table 3-14
Multiline Terminal LED Flash Patterns ..................................................................... 3-38
Table 3-15
Traffic Capacity ........................................................................................................ 3-39
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures and Tables
System Specifications
Chapter 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
This chapter provides detailed specifications for the Electra Elite IPK II system
technician. The technician should review this information carefully before installing
the system.
SECTION 2
SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
Figure 3-1 System Block Diagram shows the ETUs that can be installed in the KSU
and the number of channels supported when the ETU is installed. Table 3-1 List of
Abbreviations lists abbreviations used in the diagram.
Table 3-1 List of Abbreviations
Abbreviation
Description
ACD
Automatic Call Distribution
BRT
Basic Rate Trunk Interface
BSU(2)/BSU(4M)
BSU(2S)/BSU(6S)
Master or Slave Base Station Unit
CCH
Common Channel Handler (K-CCIS)
CF
Compact Flash
CNF(8)
Multiline Conference Bridge
CNF(16)
Multimedia Conference Bridge
COI
Central Office Interface
COIB
Central Office Interface (COI/COID mode)
COID
Central Office Interface with Caller ID
COM
Communication
CPUII
Central Processing Unit
CTA
Computer Telephony Adapter
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-1 List of Abbreviations (Continued)
Abbreviation
Description
CTI/VP, FMS,
VMS, CMS, CTP,
IVR, VMP
Voice Mail
DID
Direct Inward Dialing
DTI
Digital Trunk Interface
ESI/ESIB/ESIE
Electronic Station Interface
ETU
Electronic Telephone Unit
EXP
KSU Expansion Controller ETU
EXPT
System Expansion ETU for K-CCIS
FT1
Fractional T1
HDLC
High Level Data Link Control
HFU
Handsfree Unit
HUB
Optional Hub Ethernet Interface
IAD
Optional Integration Device
ISDN
Integrated Services Digital Network
LAN
Local Area Network
MDF
Main Distribution Frame
MG-16
Media Gateway
MIC
Microphone
MOH
Music On Hold
OPX
Off-Premise Extension
PC
Personal Computer
PCM
Pulse Code Modulation
PGD(2)-U10 ADP
Two circuit module for MOH, External
Paging, and Doorphones
PKU
Port Key Unit
PRT
Primary Rate Trunk
PVA
Packet Voice Application
SLI/SLIB/SLIE
Single Line Interface
SLT
Single Line Telephone
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP
Single Line Telephone Adapter
___________________________________________________________________________________
3-2
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-1 List of Abbreviations (Continued)
Abbreviation
Description
SPK
Speaker
TLI
Tie Line Interface
VM/VMP
Voice Mail
VoIP
Voice over Internet Protocol
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Package Control Path
(HDLC)
Analog
VM
SLI(4)(8)
HF-R
Tape
Recorder
Modem
AD(A)
AP(A)
AP(R)
CT(A)
PC
CT(U)
COI(4)/(8)
CO Line
COIB(4)/(8)
CO Line /
CO Line with Caller ID
COID(4)/(8)
CO Line with Caller ID
BSU(2)
BSU(4M)/
(2S)/(6S)
Wireless – DECT
CCH(4)
K-CCIS (C Channel Handler)
BRT(4)
ISDN BRI
PRT(1)-U( )
ISDN PRI
DID(4)
Analog DID Line
TLI(2)
E&M Tie Lines (4-wire)
DTI-U( )
T1/FT1 Lines
OPX(2)
SLT
MIC
Voice Path
(PCM Highway)
Electra
Elite
IPK
and
Dterm
Series i
Terminals
CTA
PC
CTU(S)
Modem
APA
APR
HFU
MIC
Tape
Recorder
SLT
ESI(8)
Electra
Elite
Terminals
EISB(8)
CNF(16)
Multimedia Conference Bridge
ESIE(8)
PVA(X)-U( )
Packet Voice Application
CNF(8)
Conference Bridge
CTI/VP/IVR/
FMS/VMS/CMS
CTP/VMP
Digital Voice Mail
ADA
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP
PGD(2)-U10 ADP
Doorbox Speaker with Amplifier
External Music Source
External Recording System
External Ringing
VRS CF
MG-16
Media Gateway
HUB(8)
Optional Ethernet Interface
IAD(8)
VoIP (Station/Trunk)
In-Mail CF
IP Stations
MOH
CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
EXP/
EXPT
SPK
IP Network (LAN)
Dterm
IPK
(ITH)
AD(A)-2R
Tape
Recorder
Figure 3-1 System Block Diagram
___________________________________________________________________________________
3-4
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 3
MAXIMUM SYSTEM CAPACITIES
The maximum capacities available in the Electra Elite IPK II system are shown Table
3-2 Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs, Table 3-3 Maximum
System Capacities for Trunk Interface ETUs and Table 3-4 Maximum System
Capacities for Application Interface ETUs.
Table 3-2 Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs
Maximum Capacities
Station Interface
Units
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port
Package
Notes
CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU
2- or 4-Port Digital Voice Mail System
1
1
Notes 1~4, 6
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU
8-Port Conference Unit. This Multiline
Conference Bridge allows any
intercom user or outside party calling
to a port of the CNF(8)-U( ) ETU to
join or make a multiparty Conference
Call. Each ETU supports one 8-party
conference or two 4-party
conferences regulated by a switch
setting.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8
in the B64-U20 KSU. The system
recognizes this ETU as an SLI(8)-U( )
ETU. This ETU shares the total
number of station ports in the system.
2
2
Notes 1, 4, 6
CNF(16)-U20 ETU
16-Port Multimedia Conference Unit.
This Multiline Conference Bridge can
support eight or 16 ports. Each
8-port ETU supports one 8-party
conference or two 4-party
conferences. Each 16-port ETU
supports one 16-party conference,
two 8-party conferences, one 6-party
and two 5-party conferences, or four
4-party conferences. This ETU is
installed in slots S1~S8 in the
B64-U20 KSU. The system
recognizes this ETU as CNF( )- U20
ETU. This ETU shares the total
number of station ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1, 4, 6
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3-5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-2 Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Station Interface
Units
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port
Package
Notes
CTI(4)/(8)-U( )
(System) ETU
This ETU is a 4- or 8-Port Digital
Voice Mail system with ports that
support TeLANophy, inbound or
outbound faxing, and Hospitality/
HVM applications. It is installed in
any interface slot. This ETU shares
the total number of station ports in the
system.
1
1
Notes 1, 3, 4, 6
CTI(12)/(16)-U( )
(Daughter) ETU
This ETU and the 4- and 8-port ETU
provide a 12- or 16-port Digital CTI
System Digital Voice Mail system
with ports that support TeLANophy,
inbound or outbound faxing, and
Hospitality/HVM applications. It is
installed in any interface slot. This
ETU shares the total number of
station ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1, 3~5,
6
CTP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
CTP(12)/(16)-U( )
ETU
This ETU is a multiplatform system
that supports a maximum of 16 ports.
It is a PC platform that contains data
storage for voice recording and
application software. A digital signal
processor/voice processing section
handles the following functions:
1
1
Notes 1, 3, 4, 6
Note 7
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
DTMF detection and generation
General tone detection
FAX CNG tone detection
PCM compression for audio
recording/playback
Automatic Gain Control (AGC)
Two USB 1.0 ports for USB
keyboard and mouse support
One 15-pin VGA Connector for
VGA monitor support
One DSP8-U10 ETU is required for
eight ports. Two DSP8-U10 ETUs
are required for 12 or 16 ports.
DSPII-U10 Unit with
In-Mail 2-port or InMail 4-port Compact
Flash card installed.
This unit is a daughter board that is
installed on the CPUII( )-U10 ETU
and is used for the VRS or In-Mail
Compact Flash.
1
1
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
8-Port Electronic Station Interface
7
23
___________________________________________________________________________________
3-6
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-2 Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Station Interface
Units
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port
Package
Notes
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU
This 8-Port Electronic Station
Interface ETU contains eight circuits.
Each circuit can support any
Attendant Console, Multiline
Terminal, or Single Line Telephone
adapter.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8
in the basic or expansion B64-U20
KSU. The maximum number
depends on other station ETUs
installed. This ETU shares the total
number of extension ports in the
system.
7
23
Notes 1, 6
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU with
ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU
These ETUs are a 16-Port Electronic
Station Interface. The ESIE ETU is
installed on ESIB ETU. This
Electronic Station Interface ETU
contains eight circuits. Each circuit
can support any Attendant Console,
Multiline Terminal, or Single Line
Telephone adapter.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8
in the basic or expansion B64-U20
KSU. The maximum number
depends on other station ETUs
installed. This ETU shares the total
number of extension ports in the
system.
3
15
Notes 1, 6
FMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU
This 2- or 4-Port Digital Voice Mail
System is installed in any interface
slot. It has eight channels of built-in
Voice Mail. The system recognizes
this ETU as a VMS(4)-U( ) ETU. This
ETU shares the total number of
station ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1~4, 6
FMS(8)-U( ) ETU
This 8-Port Digital Voice Mail System
is installed in any interface slot. It has
two or four channels of built-in Voice
Mail. The system recognizes this
ETU as a VMS(8)-U( ) ETU. This
ETU shares the total number of
station ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1, 3, 4, 6
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3-7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-2 Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Station Interface
Units
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port
Package
Notes
IVR Application
[VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
with IVR HDD Kit]
This Interactive Voice Response ETU
has four ports to support IVR
applications. When the DSP-U( )
module is attached, eight ports are
available. It is installed in any
interface slot. This ETU shares the
number of station ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1, 3, 4, 6
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU
This 2-Port Off-Premise Extension
Interface ETU provides termination
and operation of two off-premise
extensions. Each ETU has a built-in
ringer signal generator (RSG). Up to
1600 ohms of resistance (including
the Single Line instrument) is
acceptable between the OPX ETU
and the Single Line Telephone.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8
in any B64-U20 KSU and shares the
number of station ports in the system.
6
22
Note 1, 2, 6
SLI(4)-U( ) ETU
This 4-Port Single Line Interface ETU
supports four Single Line Telephones
and/or analog voice mail ports. Each
ETU provides a built-in ringer signal
generator (RSG) and Message
Waiting (MW) LED voltage to Single
Line Telephones.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8
in any B64-U20 KSU. The maximum
number depends on other station
ETUs installed. This ETU shares the
total number of station ports in the
system.
12
22
Notes 1, 6
___________________________________________________________________________________
3-8
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-2 Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Station Interface
Units
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port
Package
Notes
SLI(8)-U( ) ETU
This 8-Port Single Line Interface ETU
supports eight Single Line
Telephones and/or analog voice mail
ports. Each ETU provides a built-in
ringer signal generator (RSG) and
Message Waiting (MW) LED voltage
to Single Line Telephones.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8
in any B64-U20 KSU. The maximum
number depends on other station
ETUs installed. This ETU shares the
total number of station ports in the
system.
6
22
Notes 1, 6
SLIB(4)-U( ) ETU
This 4-Port Single Line Interface ETU
supports four Single Line
Telephones. Each ETU provides a
built-in ringer signal generator (RSG)
and Message Waiting (MW) LED
voltage to Single Line Telephones.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8
in any B64-U20 KSU. The maximum
number depends on other station
ETUs installed. This ETU shares the
total number of station ports in the
system.
12
22
Notes 1, 6
SLIB(4)-U( ) ETU with
SLIE(4)-U( ) ETU
installed
These ETUs are an 8-Port Single
Line Interface. The SLIE ETU is
installed on the SLIB ETU, and they
support eight Single Line Telephones
with built-in ringer signal generator
(RSG) and Message Waiting (MW)
LED voltage to Single Line
Telephones.
This combination ETU is installed in
slots S1~S8 in any B64-U20 KSU.
The maximum number depends on
other station ETUs installed. This
ETU shares the total number of
station ports in the system.
6
22
Notes 1, 6
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3-9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-2 Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Station Interface
Units
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port
Package
Notes
VMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU
This 2- or 4-Port Digital Voice Mail
System is installed in any Interface
slot. It has two or four channels of
built-in voice mail. The system
recognizes this ETU as a VMS(4)-U( )
ETU. This ETU shares the total
number of station ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1~4, 6
VMS(8)-U( ) ETU
This 8-Port Digital Voice Mail System
is installed in any Interface slot. It
has eight channels of built-in voice
mail. The system recognizes this
ETU as a VMS(8)-U( ) ETU. This
ETU shares the total number of
station ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1, 3, 4,
6
VP(4)/(8)-U( )
(System) ETU
This 4- or 8-Port Digital Voice Mail
System has ports that support
TeLANophy, inbound/outbound
faxing, and Hospitality/HVM
applications.
It is installed in any interface slot and
shares the total number of station
ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1, 3, 4, 6
VP(12)/(16)-U( )
(Daughter) ETU
This ETU and the 4- or 8-port ETU
provide a 12- or 16-port Digital Voice
Mail System with ports that support
TeLANophy, inbound/outbound
faxing, and Hospitality/HVM
applications.
It is installed in any interface slot and
shares the total number of station
ports in the system.
1
1
Notes 1,3~6,
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 10
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-2 Maximum System Capacities for Station Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Station Interface
Units
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port
Package
Notes
Note 1:
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface
(ESI) ports, four trunk ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Note 2:
When 2-port Station Interface ETUs are installed, the system uses four ports from its maximum port capacity.
Note 3:
Only one CMS, FMS, VMS, VP, CTI, CTP, IVR system can be installed in one Electra Elite IPK II system.
Note 4:
A maximum of 32 Digital Voice Mail ports are available.
Note 5:
Two physical Interface Slots are used for the EliteMail VP 12/16-port system and the EliteMail CTI 12/16-port
system.
Note 6:
Refer to the KSU Power-Based Calculator Chart.
Note 7:
When the DSPII-U10 Unit with an In-Mail 2- or 4-port Compact Flash is installed on the CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, it
uses eight ports from the maximum station port capacity.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-3 Maximum System Capacities for Trunk Interface ETUs
Maximum Capacities
Trunk Interface
ETUs
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port Package
Notes
BRT(4)-U( ) ETU
This 4-Port Basic Rate Interface for
eight trunks provides four channels
(eight voice channels) for an
ISDN-Basic Rate Interface. Caller ID
is supported. This ETU is installed in
slots S1~S4 in the basic or first
expansion B64-U20 KSU. The
maximum number depends on other
trunk ETUs installed. This ETU shares
the total number of CO/PBX lines in
the system.
7
23
Notes 1, 6
COI(4)-U( ) ETU
This 4-Port CO/PBX Line Interface has
built-in fuses (posistors), supports four
outside (CO/PBX) lines, and provides
circuitry for ring detection, holding and
dialing. The outside lines must be Loop
Start DTMF trunks. This ETU is
installed in slots S1~S8 in the basic or
expansion B64-U20 KSU. The
maximum number depends on other
trunk ETUs installed. This ETU can
provide an E911 CAMA trunk.
This ETU shares the total number of
CO/PBX lines in the system.
14
23
Note 1
COI(8)-U( ) ETU
This 8-Port CO/PBX Line Interface has
built-in fuses (posistors), supports
eight outside (CO/PBX) lines, and
provides circuitry for ring detection,
holding and dialing. The outside lines
must be Ground Start DTMF trunks.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8 in
the basic or expansion B64-U20 KSU.
The maximum number depends on
other trunk ETUs installed. This ETU
can provide an E911 CAMA trunk.
This ETU shares the total number of
CO/PBX lines in the system.
7
23
Note 1
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 12
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-3 Maximum System Capacities for Trunk Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Trunk Interface
ETUs
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port Package
Notes
COIB(4)-U( ) ETU
This 4-Port CO/PBX Line Interface can
function the same as the COI(4) or
COID(4) ETU to provided a Central
Office Interface. When set for COID
mode, Loop Start DTMF trunks and/or
Caller ID trunks are supported, and the
ETU supports loop start only. When
the ETU is set for COI mode, loop start
or ground start DTMF trunks are
supported, but Caller ID is not
supported. Connections for ground
start trunks are polarity sensitive. This
ETU can provide an E911 CAMA
trunk. For COID mode, Caller ID
trunks must be installed in slots
S1~S4. This ETU shares the total
number of CO/PBX lines in the system.
Tip and Ring electrical fuses are
provided to comply with UL 1459
requirements.
14
23
Notes 1, 3
COIB(8)-U( ) ETU
8-Port CO/PBX Line Interface can
function the same as the COI(4) or
COID(4) ETU to provided a Central
Office Interface. When set for COID
mode, Loop Start DTMF trunks and/or
Caller ID trunks are supported, and the
ETU supports loop start only. When
the ETU is set for COI mode, loop start
or ground start DTMF trunks are
supported, but Caller ID is not
supported. Fax CO Branch is not
supported. Connections for ground
start trunks are polarity sensitive. Only
DTMF signaling is supported. This
ETU can provide an E911 CAMA
trunk. For COID mode, Caller ID
trunks must be installed in slots
S1~S4. This ETU shares the total
number of CO/PBX lines in the system.
Tip and Ring electrical fuses are
provided to comply with UL 1459
requirements.
7
23
Note 1
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-3 Maximum System Capacities for Trunk Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Trunk Interface
ETUs
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port Package
Notes
DID(4)-U( ) ETU
This 4-Port Direct Inward Dialing
Interface supports four DID or four
two-way DID lines. Each ETU requires
one interface slot in the KSU.
Immediate, wink start, second dial
tone, and delay dial signaling can be
combined on this ETU.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8 in
any B64-U20 KSU. The maximum
number depends on other trunk ETUs
installed. This ETU shares the total
number of CO/PBX lines in the system.
14
23
Notes 1,4
DTI-U40 ETU for
DTI Function
DTI-U40 ETU for
PRI Function
This T1/FT1 Trunk Interface or
ISDN-Primary Rate digital trunk
terminates Fractional T1 trunks (Up to
24 DS-0 channels). This ETU
supports K-CCIS, ANI/DNIS trunks,
and CSU less function on T1. A
combination of ground start and loop
start signaling can be used on the
DTI-U40 ETU. Dial pulse dialing,
DTMF, Tie Line (E&M), and DID are
supported. This ETU has 24 built-in
DTMF detectors. Trunks are assigned
in groups of four.
When channels are assigned to ANI,
Feature Group D is supported.
Feature Group D incoming MF/
outgoing DTMF signaling and K-CCIS
signaling with point-to-point E&M Tie
lines are also supported.
This ETU is installed in slots S1~S8 in
any B64-U20 KSU. The maximum
number depends on other trunk ETUs
installed. This ETU shares the total
number of CO/PBX lines in the system.
2
11
Notes 1, 5, 7.
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 14
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-3 Maximum System Capacities for Trunk Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Trunk Interface
ETUs
TLI (2)-U( ) ETU
Description
This 2-Port Tie Line Interface ETU
supports the termination and operation
of two E&M tie lines (4-wire, type I and
type V, and 10/20 pps Dial Pulse or
DTMF). Immediate, wink start, second
dial tone, and delay dial signaling can
be combined on this ETU. This ETU is
installed in slots S1~S8 in any
B64-U20 KSU. The maximum number
depends on other trunk ETUs installed.
This ETU shares the total number of
CO/PBX lines in the system.
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port Package
14
23
Notes
Note 2
Note 1:
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface
(ESI) ports, four Trunk ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Note 2:
When 2-port Trunk Interface ETUs are installed, the system uses four ports from its maximum port capacity.
Note 3:
With the Electra Elite IPK II Expanded Port Package, a maximum of 14 COIB(4)-U( ) ETUs can be installed as
COID(4)-U( ) ETUs.
Note 4:
Refer to the KSU Power-Based Calculator Chart.
Note 5:
Firmware 5.0 or higher is required.
Note 6:
Firmware 3.0 or higher is required.
Note 7:
The first four DTI/PRI ETUs are assigned 24 Channels, the next six are assigned 16 Channels, and the eleventh
is assigned eight channels.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-4 Maximum System Capacities for Application Interface ETUs
Maximum Capacities
Application
Interface ETUs
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port Package
Notes
BSU(4M)-U20 ETU
The Master 4-Base Station Unit for
Wireless – DECT provides
connections for up to 16 Base Stations
when using two BSU(6S) ETUs. This
ETU is installed in slots S1~S8 (S2~S8
when using one slave ETU or S3~S8
when using two slave ETUs) in any
B64-U20 KSU.
1
1
Notes 1, 2
BSU(2S)-U20 ETU
This Slave 2-Base Station Unit for
Wireless – DECT has connections for
two Base Stations and must be used
with the BSU(4M)-U20 ETU. This ETU
is installed in the first or second slot to
the left of the BSU(4)-U20 ETU.
2
2
Notes 1, 2
BSU(6S)-U20 ETU
This Slave 6-Base Station Unit for
Wireless – DECT has connections for
six Base Stations and must be used
with the BSU(4M)-U20 ETU. This ETU
is installed in the first or second slot to
the left of the BSU(4)-U20 ETU.
2
2
Notes 1, 2
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU
This 4-Channel - Common Channel
Handler (CCH) for K-CCIS provides
four K-CCIS routes to coordinate
receiving common channel data from a
distant system or to coordinate
sending it to a distant system.
1
1
HUB(8)-U( ) ETU
This 8-Port Switching HUB is an
optional Ethernet interface that
supports eight internet ports. Each
port has two LEDs that indicate status
and activity. One port can be a source
port, and another port can be used to
mirror source and monitor data traffic.
One ETU can be installed in slots
S1~S8 in each cabinet. This ETU
cannot be installed in a KSU that
contains EliteMail VP and IVR or CTI
and IVR systems.
1
1
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU
configured for ESI
For Megaco Station
3
14
Note 1
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 16
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-4 Maximum System Capacities for Application Interface ETUs (Continued)
Maximum Capacities
Application
Interface ETUs
Description
Basic Port
Package
Expanded
Port Package
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU
configured for
CCISoIP
For CCISoIP
6
22
PVA(X)-U( ) as an
IP Station
(MEGACO)–MG16
For Megaco Station
2
13
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU
as CCISoIP
For CCISoIP
Version 1500 or higher – 4-port
license registration provides users with
the flexibility of adding CCISoIP Ports
in increments of four (4, 8, 12, 16, 20
or 24) or (MG16) DSP Resources in
increments of four (4, 8, 12, or 16).
Version 2000 or higher – Using the
MG_CCIS Combo Package 4-port
license registration provides user with
the flexibility of adding CCISoIP ports
in increments of four (4, 8, 12, 16, 20
or 24) or (MG16) DSP resources in
increments of four (4, 8, 12, 16, 20 or
24).
2
11
Notes
Note 3
Note 4
Note 1:
Refer to the KSU Power-Based Calculator Chart.
Note 2:
A maximum of three Wireless – DECT BSU(4M)/(2S)/(6S) ETUs can be installed.
Note 3:
The IAD(8)-U( ) ETU is assigned as a CCISoIP ETU and counts as eight trunk ports when installed with the IP
CCH ETU application loaded.
Note 4:
The PVA(X)-U( ) ETU is assigned as a CCISoIP ETU and counts as 24 trunk ports when installed with the
CCISoIP application package.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 4
KSU POWER-BASED CALCULATOR CHART
The Card Calculator on the next page allows you to determine the maximum power
consumption for the Power supply in each cabinet under the following conditions:
J
J
J
J
Each basic cabinet can contain a maximum of 10 cards.
Each expansion cabinet can contain a maximum of nine cards.
The total point value cannot exceed 1000 points for +5V.
The total point value cannot exceed 1000 points for -24V.
To calculate the two values (+5V and -24V) for a card:
1.
Pick the card type in the chart below.
2.
Calculate the +5V total point value by multiplying the number of cards by
the +5V value in the chart.
3.
Calculate the -24V total point value by multiplying the number of cards by
the -24V value in the chart.
An example is shown below:
J
+5V
Five ESIB(8)-U10 ETUs multiplied by a table value of 21 is 105 points toward a
possible 1000 (895 points remaining).
J
-24V
Five ESIB(8)-U10 ETUs multiplied by a table value of 83 is 415 points toward a
possible 1000 (585 points remaining).
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 18
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-5 KSU Power-Based Calculator Chart
Package Name
Power Consumption
+5V
-24V
Number
of ETUs
Equivalent Total
Power Point
+5V
-24V
Common
CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
200
0
CF ETU
7
0
EXP-U10 ETU
6
0
MOD-U10 Unit
25
0
Trunk
BRT(4)-U( ) ETU
67
0
COI(4)-U10 ETU
48
5
COI(8)-U10 ETU
82
9
COID(8)-U( ) ETU
55
9
COIB(4)-U20 ETU
29
5
COIB(4)-U30 ETU
29
5
COIB(8)-U30 ETU
54
9
DID(4)-U( ) ETU
24
30
DTI-U10/20/30 ETU
84
0
DTI-U40 ETU
73
0
IAD(8) ETU
31
110
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU
15
10
Station
CNF(16)-U20 ETU
17
52
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU,
21
83
ESIB(8)-U10 ETU,
21
83
ESIB(8) plus ESIE(8)-U10 ETU (16 Ports,)
32
166
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU
22
30
SLI(4)-U( ) ETU
29
25
SLI(8)-U( ) ETU
52
29
SLIB(4)-U( ) ETU
30
17
SLIE(4)-U( ) ETU
17
12
Voice Mail
CMS(2)-U10 ETU
62
54
CMS(4)-U10 ETU
62
54
FMS(2)-U10 ETU
62
54
FMS(4)-U10 ETU
62
54
VMS(2)/(4)-U10 ETU
60
57
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-5 KSU Power-Based Calculator Chart (Continued)
Package Name
Power Consumption
+5V
-24V
VMS(8)-U10 ETU
64
84
FMS(2)/(4)-U20 ETU
75
97
FMS(8)-U20 ETU
100
97
VMS(2)-U20 ETU
74
100
VMS(4)-U20 ETU
74
100
VMS(8)-U20 ETU
99
101
CMS(2)-U30 ETU
55
68
CMS(4)-U30 ETU
55
68
FMS(2)-U30 ETU
55
68
FMS(4)-U30 ETU
55
68
FMS(8)-U30 ETU
81
68
VMS(4)-U30 ETU
55
96
VMS(8)-U30 ETU
80
100
VMS(4)-U40 ETU
55
96
VMS(8)-U40 ETU
80
100
FMS(2)-U40 ETU
55
68
FMS(4)-U40 ETU
55
68
FMS(8)-U40 ETU
81
68
VP/CTI/IVR(8)-U10 ETU
155
193
VP/CTI/IVR(16)-U10 ETU
274
193
CTP( )-U10 ETU
120
288
Number
of ETUs
Equivalent Total
Power Point
+5V
-24V
XXX
XXX
Optional
BSU(4M)-U20 ETU
77
47
BSU(2S)-U20 ETU
35
26
BSU(6S)-U20 ETU
47
69
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU
50
0
HUB-U10 ETU
250
0
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU
17
52
VMP( )-U40 ETU
55
96
Total Points
,
XX
No More than 80 ESI Ports are supported in a single KSU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 20
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
An example of KTS Configuration with a Basic and Expansion Cabinet using the
Calculator Chart is shown below.
SAMPLE CALCULATION USING KSU POWER-BASED CALCULATOR CHART
Package
Quantity
Total Power Consumption
+5V value from Chart
Total Power Consumption
24V value from Chart
Basic Cabinet
CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
1
200
0
ESIB/E(8)-U10 ETU
3
96
498
ESIB(8)-U10 ETU
1
21
83
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU
3
90
51
SLIE(4)-U( ) ETU
3
51
36
CTP(8)-U10 ETU
1
120
288
Totals
10
578
956
Expansion Cabinet
EXP-U10 ETU
1
6
0
DTI-U30 ETU
1
84
0
DTI-U40 ETU
1
73
0
CCH(4)-U10 ETU
1
50
0
ESIB/E(8)-U10 ETU
4
128
664
COIB(4)-U30 ETU
1
29
5
Totals
9
370
669
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 21
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 5
SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS AND SPECIFICATIONS
5.1
Cabling Requirements and Specifications
The KSU is connected with each Multiline Terminal and Single Line
Telephone by a separate twisted 1-pair cable or 2-pair cable (only for Multiline
Terminals). Refer to Figure 3-2 Connecting the ESI Using Twisted 2-Pair
Cable.
Refer to Table 3-6 Dterm Series i or Dterm IP Terminal Loop Resistance and
Cable Length.
Refer to Table 3-7 Electra Elite/Dterm Series E Multiline Terminal Loop
Resistance and Cable Length.
Refer to Table 3-8 Cable Connection Between the Analog Port and the Single
Line Equipment.
Refer to Table 3-9 Cabling Requirements.
Table 3-6 Dterm Series i or Dterm IP Terminal Loop Resistance and Cable Length
Maximum
Loop
Resistance
(without
AC
Adapter)
(Ohms)
By
Twisted
1-Pair
Cable
(without
AC
Adapter)
24 AWG
By
Twisted
2-Pair
Cable
(without
AC
Adapter)
24 AWG
Maximum
Loop
Resistance
(with AC
Adapter)
(Ohms)
By
Twisted
1-Pair
Cable
(with AC
Adapter)
24 AWG
By
Twisted
2-Pair
Cable
(with AC
Adapter)
24 AWG
DTH-8-1 TEL
DTR-8-1 TEL
37
700
1400
107
2000
2000
DTH-8D-1 TEL
DTR-8D-1 TEL
ITH-8D-2/3 TEL
37
700
1400
107
2000
2000
DTH-16-1 TEL
DTR-16-1 TEL
35
660
1320
107
2000
2000
DTH-16D-1 TEL
DTR-16D-1 TEL
ITH-16D-2/3 TEL
35
660
1320
107
2000
2000
DTH-32D-1 TEL
DTR-32D-1 TEL
26
500
1000
107
2000
2000
DTH-16LD-1 TEL
37
700
1400
107
2000
2000
DCR-60-1
Console,
—
—
—
107
2000
2000
Terminal or
Adapter
,
An AC Adapter is required.
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 22
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-7 Electra Elite/Dterm Series E Multiline Terminal Loop Resistance and Cable
Length
Maximum
Loop
Resistance
(Ohms)
Maximum
Feet by
Twisted 1-Pair
Cable
24 AWG
Maximum
Feet by
Twisted 2-Pair
Cable
24 AWG
DTU-8-1 TEL
DTP-8-1 TEL
35
600
1000
DTU-8D-2 TEL
DTP-8D-1 TEL
35
600
1000
DTU-16-1 TEL
DTP-16-1 TEL
26
450
900
DTU-16D-2 TEL
DTP-16D-1 TEL
26
450
900
DTP-16HC-1 TEL,
57
DTU-32-1 TEL
DTP-32-1 TEL
21
360
720
DTU-32D-2 TEL
DTP-32D-1 TEL
21
360
720
DTR-2DT-1 TEL
35
600
1000
DTR-4D-1 TEL
37
700
1400
DTR-4R-1/2 TEL
N/A
650
1000
DTH-4R-1/2 TEL
N/A
650
1000
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP,,
35
600
1000
DP-D-1
20
410
820
Terminal or Adapter
,
,,
1083
An AC Adapter is required for the DTP-16HC-1 TEL.
The length for the specified SLTII(1)-U10 ADP is the length between the SLTII(1)-U10 ADP and
the ESI.
Twisted 2-Pair Cable
ESI
RJ11
Multiline Terminal
Figure 3-2 Connecting the ESI Using Twisted 2-Pair Cable
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 23
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-8
Cable Connection Between the Analog Port and
the Single Line Equipment
Cable
Maximum Distance or
Impedance Between
Equipment and Telephone
AD(A)-R/AD(A)-2R Unit
Twisted Pair
10 feet
ADA(2)-W Unit
Twisted Pair
10 feet
AP(A)-R or AP(R)-R Unit
Twisted Pair
50 feet
APA-U Unit or APR-U Unit
Twisted Pair
50 feet
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU
Twisted Pair
1,600 ohms
SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
Twisted Pair
300 ohms
SLIB(4)/SLIE(4)-U10 ETU
Twisted Pair
300 ohms
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP
Twisted Pair
50 feet
Connected Equipment
Mixing digital and analog ports through the same 25-pair cable runs
is not recommended.
Table 3-9 Cabling Requirements
Connected Equipment
5.2
Cable
External Amplifier
Hi-Fi Shielded Audio Cable
Music on Hold and Background Music
Sources
Hi-Fi Shielded Audio Cable
ITH Cabling
Cat 5 Straight Data Network cable
100 meters maximum distance
Cabling Precautions
5.2.1
Cable Placement
When selecting cables and Main Distribution Frame (MDF), future
expansion or assignment changes should be considered. Avoid
running cables in the following places:
J
J
J
A place exposed to wind or rain.
A place near heat radiating equipment or where the quality of
station cable covering could be affected by gases and
chemicals.
An unstable place subject to vibration.
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 24
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.2.2
Environmental Conditions
Temperature
J
J
Operating:
+32°F ~ +104°F (0°C ~ 40°C)
Long Term:
+50°F ~ +90°F (10°C ~ 32.2°C)
Humidity
J
5.3
Operating:
10% ~ 90% noncondensing
Power Requirements
5.3.1
Power Supply Inputs
AC input requirements for the system are listed below.
AC Input [P64-U( ) PSU]
J
J
J
J
J
5.3.2
117 Vac ± 10%
60 Hz ± 10%
Single Phase
7.5A circuit
A dedicated outlet, separately fused and grounded
Power Supply Consumption
The power consumption for the Electra Elite IPK II system is listed in
Table 3-10 Power Consumption.
Table 3-10 Power Consumption
Maximum
RMS
Current
Watts
Used
(Idle)
Watts
Used
(Maximum)
Basic KSU – B64-U20 KSU
2.5 A
120
230
Basic KSU + Expansion KSU
5.0 A
240
460
Basic KSU + 2 Expansion KSUs
7.5 A
360
690
KSU
When replacing fuses, refer to the specifications in Table 3-11 Fuse
Replacement.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 25
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-11 Fuse Replacement
Unit
Fuse
Number
Specifications
Description
Dimensions
P64-U( ) PSU
F1
125V, 6.0A
AC Input
1/4” x 1 1/4”
P64-U( ) PSU
F101
250V, 10A
Battery Input
1/4” x 1 1/4”
All fuses are normal blown glass tube.
Do not use slow blow fuses. Replace with a fuse of the same type and
rating.
5.4
Outside Line Types
The following outside lines can be used with the Electra Elite IPK II system:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
2-wire, Loop Start or Ground Start Trunks
2-wire, 2-way DID Lines (Dial Pulse or DTMF)
4-wire, E&M Tie Lines (Type I or V, Dial Pulse, or DTMF)
Digital Trunk T1/FT1 (Loop Start, Ground Start, Tie Line (E&M), or DID
Signaling)
ISDN-BRI Trunks
ISDN-PRI Trunks
VoIP Trunks (Internet Protocols)
Refer to Table 1-1 FIC, REN, SOC, and Jacks for Electra Elite IPK II System
ETUs in the Regulatory Information section in this manual for a detailed list of
Facility Interface Codes, Ringer Equivalence Numbers, Service Order Codes
and Jack Types.
5.5
Transmission, Network, and Control Specifications
5.5.1
Transmission
J
Data Length:
From Multiline Terminal to ESI(8)-U( ) ETU: 23 bits
From ESI(8)-U( ) ETU to Multiline Terminal: 23 bits
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 26
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
Data Transmission Rates:
Between ESI(8)-U( ) ETU and Multiline Terminal: 184K bps
(voice and signaling)
J
5.5.2
Scanning Time for each Multiline Terminal: 32 ms.
Network
Time Division Multiplexing (TDM) allows transmission of a number of
separate data and voice simultaneously over one communications
medium. The information below indicates the specifications the
Electra Elite IPK II system uses for switching, clock, data bus,
timeframe:
J
J
J
J
5.5.3
TDM Switching:
PCM (µ Law)
TDM Clock:
2.048 MHz
TDM Data Bus:
8 bit
TDM Timeframe: 125 µs.
Control
This section indicates the speed or capacity:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
5.5.4
Control: Stored program with distributed processing
Central Processor:
32-bit microprocessor
Clock:
32.768 MHz
Interface ETU:
8-bit or 16-bit microprocessor
Optional ETUs:
16- or 32-bit microprocessor
Multiline Terminal (TDM):
8-bit microprocessor
Multiline Terminal (IP):
32-bit microprocessor
IP Adapter:
32-bit microprocessor
Attendant Console:
4-bit microprocessor
SLT Adapter:
8-bit microprocessor
PGD Adapter
8-bit microprocessor
Electra Elite IPK Terminals and Equipment
The voltage, current, ring signal information for the Electra Elite IPK
Multiline Terminals, Single Line Telephone equipment, and AP(A)-R/
AP(R)-R Units are listed below:
J
Multiline Terminal
Voltage:
-11 ~ -26 Vdc
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 27
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Maximum Current:
J
J
J
J
5.5.5
250 mA
Acoustical characteristics meet Electronic Industry Association
(EIA) standard proposal SP-1286 and standard EIA RS-470.
Single Line Telephone
Standard 2500 Set:
500 type network
Nominal Current:
35 mA
Ring Signal:
56 Vac RMS @ 20 Hz
SLT(1)-U( ) ADP
Standard 2500 Set:
500 type network
Nominal Current:
30 mA
Ring Signal:
56 Vac RMS @ 20 Hz
AP(A)-R Unit
Standard 2500 Set:
500 type network
Nominal Current:
30 mA
AP(R)-R Unit
Standard 2500 Set:
500 type network
Nominal Current:
30 mA
Ring Signal:
56 Vac RMS @ 20 Hz
Series i Terminals
The voltage and current information for the Dterm Series i Multiline
Terminals are listed below:
J
Multiline Terminal (Series i)
Voltage:
-11 ~ -48 Vdc
Maximum Current:
250 mA
J
Acoustical characteristics meet Electronic Industry Association
(EIA) standard proposal SP-1286 and standard EIA RS-470.
Voltage, current, and ring signal information for Single Line
Telephone equipment, AP(A)-R Unit, and AP(R)-R Unit are the
same as those listed in the previous paragraph.
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 28
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.6
Dialing Specifications
5.6.1
Dial Pulse Address Signaling
Dial Pulse address Signaling uses dial pulses (regular momentary
interruptions) to signal the equipment. In the Electra Elite IPK II
system, the following Dial Pulse specifications are used:
J
J
J
5.6.2
Pulse Rate:
10 ± 0.5 pps/20 ± 1.0 pps
Percent Break: 60 ± 1.5%
Interdigit Interval: 0 pps/20 pps 500 ms. ~ 800 ms.
Dual-Tone Multifrequency (DTMF) Address Signaling
DTMF signaling describes push button or Touchtone dialing. When a
key on a telephone is pushed, two tones (one high frequency and
one low frequency) are provided. In the Electra Elite IPK II system,
the following DTMF specifications are used:
J
Frequencies
Two sinusoidal frequencies are provided, one from the high
frequency group and one from the low frequency group.
J
J
Frequency Deviation: Less than ±1.0%
Signal Level:
Nominal level per frequency:-6 ~ -4 dBm
Minimum level per frequency:
Low Group:
-10 dBm
High Group:
-8 dBm
Maximum level per frequency:0 dBm
J
J
Rise Time: Within 5 ms.
Duration of Dual Frequency Signal:
110 ms. default/60 ms. minimum
J
Interdigital Time: 80 ms. default/70 ms. minimum
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 29
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Nominal High Group
Frequencies (Hz)
1209
Nominal Low Group
Frequencies (Hz)
5.7
1336
1477
697
1
2
3
770
4
5
6
852
7
8
9
941
,
0
#
Battery Backup
The Electra Elite IPK II system has battery backup functions for system
backup and for memory backup.
5.7.1
System Backup
During power failure, the system is backed up using a rechargeable
battery. This battery backup supports all of the system operations for
approximately 30 minutes.
5.7.2
Memory Backup
The CPUII( )-U( ) ETU battery retains the Clock/Calendar and Last
Number Redial (LNR) buffers for each station when the CPUII( )-U( )
ETU encounters a power loss. With a fully charged battery, the
settings are retained for about three years. The system programmed
memory (Customer Database) is stored in non-volatile Memory and
can be erased only by a First Initialization.
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 30
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.8
Weights and Dimensions
Table 3-12 Weights and Dimensions indicates the shipping weight, height,
width, and depth of each Electra Elite IPK II KSU, ETU, Multiline Terminal, or
adapter.
Table 3-12 Weights and Dimensions
Shipping
Weight1
Height
Width
Depth
ACA-U Unit
22.5 oz
(638 g)
3.4”
(86 mm)
4.2”
(107 mm)
5.2”
(133 mm)
AD(A)-R Unit
4.0 oz
(113 g)
2.25”
(56.25 mm)
2.75”
(68.75 mm)
5.5”
(137.5 mm)
AD(A)-2R Unit
4.0 oz
(113 g)
2.25”
(56.25 mm)
2.75”
(68.75 mm)
5.5”
(137.5 mm)
AP(A)-R Unit
5.6 oz
(158 g)
2.25”
(56.25 mm)
2.75”
(68.75 mm)
5.5”
(137.5 mm)
AP(R)-R Unit
5.6 oz
(158 g)
2.25”
(56.25 mm)
2.75”
(68.75 mm)
5.5”
(137.5 mm)
B64-U20 KSU
460.8 oz
(13063 g)
13.0”
(328.7 mm)
14.0”
(354 mm)
10.25”
(259 mm)
BRT(4)-U10 ETU
14.6 oz
(414 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
BRT(4)-U20 ETU
11.3 oz
(320 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
BSU(4M)-U20 ETU
14.8 oz
(419 g)
1.97”
(50mm)
8.27”
(210 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
BSU(2S)-U20 ETU
13.4 oz
(381 g)
1.97”
(50mm)
8.27”
(210 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
BSU(6S)-U20 ETU
15 oz
(423 g)
1.97”
(50mm)
8.27”
(210 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU
12.0 oz
(340 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU
102.4 oz
(2903 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
CMS/FMS/VMS-U30 ( ) ETU
102.4 oz
(2903 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU
12.0 oz
(340 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
CNF(16)-U20 ETU
12.3 oz
(349 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 31
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-12 Weights and Dimensions (Continued)
Shipping
Weight1
Height
Width
Depth
COI(4)-U( ) ETU
13.6 oz
(385 g
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
COI(8)-U( ) ETU
16.6 oz
(471 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
COIB(4)-U( ) ETU
14.4 oz
(408 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
COIB(8)-U( ) ETU
16.6 oz
(471 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
COID(4)-U( ) ETU
14.4 oz
(408 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
COID(8)-U( ) ETU
16.6 oz
(471 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
13.4 oz
(380 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
CT(A)-R Unit
4.0 oz
(113 g)
2.25”
(56.25 mm)
2.75”
(68.75 mm)
5.5”
(137.5 mm)
CTA-U Unit
4.3 oz
(122 g)
2.4”
(60 mm)
2.3”
(59 mm)
4.8”
(121 mm)
CTI/VP(4)/(8)/(12)/(16)-U( ) ETU
192 oz 2
(5443 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
CTP-U10 ETU
20 oz 3
(580 g)
.8”
(20 mm)
7.5”
(190 mm)
7.5”
(190 mm)
CTU(C)-U Unit
9.5 oz
(270 g)
2.4”
(60 mm)
4.3”
(110 mm)
4.4”
(112 mm)
CTU(S)-U Unit
9.5 oz
(270 g)
2.4”
(60 mm)
4.3”
(110 mm)
4.4”
(112 mm)
CT(U)-R Unit
8.4 oz
(239 g)
2.25”
(56.25 mm)
2.75”
(68.75 mm)
5.5”
(137 mm)
DCR-60-1 Console
53 oz
(1503 g)
4.2”
(107 mm)
12.8”
(326 mm)
7.14”
(182 mm)
DID(4)-U( ) ETU
15.5 oz
(439 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
DP-D-1A Doorphone
8.4 oz
(238 g)
1.5”
(38 mm)
5.5”
(140 mm)
4.6”
(121 mm)
DTH-16D-1 TEL
DTR-16D-1 TEL
43.5 oz
(1233 g)
4.78”
(122 mm)
10.2”
(260 mm)
9.8”
(250 mm)
DTH-8-1 TEL
DTR-8-1 TEL
41.0 oz
(1163 g)
4.78”
(122 mm)
10.2”
(260 mm)
9.8”
(250 mm)
Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 32
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-12 Weights and Dimensions (Continued)
Shipping
Weight1
Height
Width
Depth
DTH-8D-1 TEL
DTR-8D-1 TEL
43.5 oz
(1233 g)
4.78”
(122 mm)
10.2”
(260 mm)
9.8”
(250 mm)
DTH-32D-1 TEL
DTR-32D-1 TEL
48 oz
(1361 g)
4.78”
(122 mm)
10.2”
(260 mm)
9.8”
(250 mm)
DTI-U( ) ETU
13.2 oz
(374 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
DTI-U40 ETU
5.99 oz
(170 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
DTP-1-1 TEL
DTP-1-2 TEL
DTP-1HM-1 TEL
DTP-1HM-2 TEL
26.8 oz
(760 g)
2.36”
(60 mm)
6.22”
(158 mm)
8.81”
(224 mm)
DTU-16-1 TEL
DTP-16-1 TEL
41 oz
(1162 g)
4.8”
(123 mm)
7.8”
(197 mm)
9.3”
(235 mm)
DTU-16D-2 TEL
DTP-16D-1 TEL
43.5 oz
(1233 g)
4.8”
(123 mm)
7.8”
(197 mm)
9.3”
(235 mm)
DTP-16HC-1 TEL
53 oz
(1503 g)
6.00”
(152 mm)
9.08”
(230 mm)
8.04”
(204 mm)
DTP-2DT-1 TEL
41 oz
(1163 g)
4.8”
(123 mm)
7.8”
(197 mm
9.3”
(235 mm)
DTU-32-1 TEL
DTP-32-1 TEL
46 oz
(1304 g)
4.8”
(123 mm)
8.7”
(220 mm)
9.3”
(235 mm)
DTU-32D-2 TEL
DTP-32D-1 TEL
48 oz
(1361 g)
4.8”
(123 mm)
8.7”
(220 mm)
9.3”
(235 mm)
DTU-8-1 TEL
DTP-8-1 TEL
41.0 oz
(1163 g)
4.8”
(123 mm)
7.8”
(197 mm)
9.3”
(235 mm)
DTU-8D-2 TEL
DTP-8D-1 TEL
43.5 oz
(1233 g)
4.8”
(123 mm)
7.8”
(197 mm)
9.3”
(235 mm)
DTR-1-1 TEL
DTR-1HM-1 TEL
26.8 oz
(760 g)
2.47”
(100 mm)
7.65”
(195 mm)
9.54”
(243 mm)
DTR-1R-1 TEL
14.4oz
(408 g)
4.5”
(114 mm)
6.1”
(153 mm)
8.62”
(218 mm)
DTR-2DT-1 TEL
41 oz
(1163 g)
2.47”
(100 mm)
7.65”
(195 mm)
9.54”
(243 mm)
DTR-4D-1 TEL
44 oz
(1250 g)
5.98”
(152 g)
8.54”
(217 g)
9.65”
(245 mm)
DTR-4R-1 TEL
15.4 oz
(437 g)
2.25”
(57 mm)
4.25”
(108 mm)
7.5”
(191 mm)
Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 33
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-12 Weights and Dimensions (Continued)
Shipping
Weight1
Height
Width
Depth
DTU-4R-1 TEL
15.4 oz
(437 g)
2.25”
(57 mm)
4.25”
(108 mm)
7.5”
(191 mm)
D16(LD)-R ADM
27 oz
(770 g)
4.33”
(110 mm)
10.24”
(260 mm)
7.09”
(180 mm)
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
14.5 oz
(411 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU
11.1 oz
(315 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU
9.9 oz
(280 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
EXP-U( ) ETU
14.6 oz
(414 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
102.4 oz 2
(2903 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
HF-R Unit
9.9 oz
(280 g)
2.9”
(74 mm)
4.2”
(106 mm)
5.6”
(141 mm)
HUB(8)-U( )ETU
10.4 oz
(294 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU
8.11 oz
(230 g)
7.5”
(190 mm)
6.3”
(160 mm)
0.87”
(22 mm)
ITH-8D-2/3 TEL
50.92 oz
(1445 g)
9.84”
(250 mm)
10.31”
(262 mm)
4.76”
(121 mm)
ITH-16D-2/3 TEL
50.92 oz
(1445 g)
9.84”
(250 mm)
10.31”
(262 mm)
4.76”
(121 mm)
IVR Application
VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU with IVR
HDD
14.6 oz
(414 g)
1.75”
(44 mm)
10.5”
(266 mm)
8.62”
(219 mm)
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU
13.4 oz
(380 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
PRT(1)-U( ) ETU
13.2 oz
(374 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU
8.0 oz
(230 g)
0.7”
(18 mm)
6.5”
(165 mm)
7.5”
(190 mm)
RAK-U( ) Unit
320 0z
(9072 g)
20”
(507 mm)
15”
(380 mm)
8.5”
(216 mm)
SLI(4)-U( ) ETU
13.0 oz
(370 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
SLI(8)-U( ) ETU
14.1 oz
(400 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
Unit
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 34
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-12 Weights and Dimensions (Continued)
Shipping
Weight1
Height
Width
Depth
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU
13.0 oz
(370 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
SLIE(4)-U10 ETU
10.7 oz
(303 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
SLT(1)-U( ) ADP
9 oz.
(255 g)
1.8”
(45 mm)
2.8”
(70 mm)
4.8”
(120 mm)
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU
13.8 oz
(391 g)
1.97”
(50 mm)
9.45”
(240 mm)
7.68”
(195 mm)
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
102.4 oz 2
(2903 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
VMP(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
102.4 oz 2
(2903 g)
1.89”
(48 mm)
11.47”
(290 mm)
8.46”
(214 mm)
Unit
1 Shipping weight includes the shipping carton.
2 Shipping weight includes the shipping carton and documentation.
3 Drive is shipped separately.
5.9
External Equipment Interface
Input signal levels, impedance, contact ratings, and connector types are listed
for externally connected equipment.
5.9.1
Music on Hold/Station Background Music
J
J
5.9.2
0.6V PPS Signal Level
Input Impedance:
600 Ω
Music for Station BGM using Analog CO Trunk ETU (COI, COIB, or
COID)
J
J
5.9.3
Auxiliary Input:
Auxiliary input:
0.6 V PPS Signal Level
Input Impedance:
600 Ω
External Paging (Audio)
J
J
J
Output Power:
-10 dBm Signal Level
Output Impedance:
600 Ω
Relay Contact Rating: 500 mA, 24 Vdc
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 35
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.9.4
External Tone Ringer/Night Chime Output
J
J
J
5.9.5
Female Connector (System Input/Output):
Standard DB-9 (straight)
Female Connector (System Output):
Standard DB-9 (straight)
Relay Contact
J
5.10
Female Connector (System Output):
Standard DB-9 (straight)
ACD/MIS Connector
J
5.9.8
Relay Contact Rating:500 mA, 24 Vdc
PC Connection
J
5.9.7
Output Impedance:600 Ω
SMDR Output
J
5.9.6
Output Power: -10 dBm
All Relay Contact Ratings:
500 mA, 24 Vdc
Audible and Visual Indications
The tables in this section provide the audible and visual indications used in the
Electra Elite IPK II systems.
5.10.1
Tone Patterns
Tones are used in the Electra Elite IPK II systems to inform the
station user of various system functions such as, dial tone, busy
tone, or ringback tone. Table 3-14 Tone Patterns lists the frequency
and the pattern for these tones.
5.10.2
LED Flash Patterns
The Electra Elite IPK II system has 2-color LEDs. Green is used
primarily for I-Use conditions and for outside calls. Red is used
primarily for Other Use conditions and internal calls. Refer to Table
3-14 Multiline Terminal LED Flash Patterns.
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 36
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-13 Tone Patterns
System Tone
(Fixed)
Frequency
(Hz)
(Fixed)
Intermit
(Default)
480/620
60 IPM
Cycle
0.5 sec
Busy Tone
0.5 sec
0.5 sec
Call Waiting Tone
440
60 IPM
0.5 sec
0.25 sec
Second Dial Tone
350/440
120 IPM
0.25 sec
2400 Modulation
(16 Hz)
Continuous
Internal Dial Tone
350/440
Continuous
Internal Ringback Tone
440/480
1 sec On
2 sec Off
Howler Tone
LCR Dial Tone
440
Continuous
Reorder Tone
480/620
120 IPM
1 sec
2 sec
0.25 sec
0.25 sec
Service Set Tone
440
Continuous
Special Dial Tone
440
240 IPM
0.125 sec
0.125 sec
Tone Burst 1 Tone
440
Continuous
Tone Burst 2 Tone
620
Continuous
Tie/DID Ringback Tone
440/480
2 sec On
4 sec Off
Camp-On Tone
Call Alert Notification
Attendant Tone Override
440
Continuous
DIT Alert Tone
480/620
Continuous
Call Forward Alert Tone
Call Forward
Configuration Tone
350/440
120 IPM
1 sec
1 sec
2 sec
4 sec
0.7 sec
0.5 sec
0.25 sec ON x 2~3 bursts
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 37
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 3-14 Multiline Terminal LED Flash Patterns
LED
Condition
Color
I-Use
Busy
Incoming Call
I-Hold
Call Hold
Hold Recall
Transfer Recall
Live Monitoring Mode
Message Waiting on Line Key
Green
Red
Red
Green
Red
Green
Green
Green
Red
ON
Red
ON (Series i)
Red
I-Use
ICM Incoming Call
Voice Over Broker
Red
Red
Red
Incoming Internal Call
Incoming Outside Call
Message from Attendant
Voice Mail Message
Red
Green
Green
Red
ON
System Data Entry
Red
Red
D
Conference in Progress/Barge In
All Conference Circuits Used
Hold Conference Call
ICM Call Hold
SPD Confirmation
Red
Red
Red
Red
Red
F
Incoming Trunk
Exclusive Hold
User Ringing Line Preference
Voice Over with Broker’s Call
Red
Green
Red
Green
A
Callback Set
Auto Repeat Set
ON (to set function)
Call FWD - All Calls Set
Red
Red
Red
Red
Line Key
Microphone
I
ICM
Large LED
E
BLF or
DSS Key
Use, Hold
DND, Call FWD-All Calls Set
Special Mode (while pressing
or going off-line)
A
Flash Patterns
Red
Red
Red
0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0 sec.
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 38
System Specifications
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 6
TRAFFIC CAPACITY
Table 3-15 Traffic Capacity provides information about the traffic capacity for the
Basic Port Package and the Expanded Port Package.
Table 3-15 Traffic Capacity
Traffic Capacity
Basic Port Package
Expanded Port Package
Traffic Capacity (CPUII)
4800 BHCA
4800 BHCA
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
3 - 39
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
3 - 40
System Specifications
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 4
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ....................................................................................... 4-1
Section 2
Programming Stations ................................................................................... 4-1
Section 3
Attendant Stations ......................................................................................... 4-1
Section 4
Programming from a PC ................................................................................ 4-1
Section 5
Programming from a Multiline Terminal ...................................................... 4-2
Section 6
Electra Elite IPK II Remote PC Programming .............................................. 4-2
6.1
Section 7
Remote Programming ................................................................................. 4-2
Determining Required Equipment ................................................................ 4-2
7.1
Station Equipment ....................................................................................... 4-3
7.2
Interface ETUs ............................................................................................ 4-4
7.2.1
Determining Telephone and CO Port Numbers ................................................ 4-5
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List of Figures and Tables
Chapter 4
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 4-1
Interface Slot and System Port Numbers for an Electra Elite IPK II System .............. 4-4
Figure 4-2
Telephone and CO Port Numbering Example ............................................................ 4-5
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures and Tables
Hardware Requirements
Chapter 4
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
The technician should be familiar with the Electra Elite IPK II system before trying to
install it. Review this chapter carefully.
SECTION 2
PROGRAMMING STATIONS
Any multiline station can be a programming station in the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Station equipment connected to any port of an ESI(8)-U( ) ETU can be a
programming position, but requires a display multiline terminal.
SECTION 3
ATTENDANT STATIONS
Any display Multiline Terminal can be programmed as an Attendant position in the
Electra Elite IPK II system. An Attendant Position can have up to four DCR-60-1
Consoles attached. Each Attendant Console must be supported by an ESI(8)-U( )
ETU. A maximum of four Attendant Consoles can be installed in each Electra Elite
IPK II system.
SECTION 4
PROGRAMMING FROM A PC
Electra Elite IPK II systems can be programmed using a personal computer. The
available Graphical User Interface allows the technician/end-user easy access to all
information that can be programmed on the Electra Elite IPK II system. The PC must
be a Pentium III 600 MHz or higher PC and have a Windows operating system
compatible with the PC Programming (PCPro) application.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
4-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 5
PROGRAMMING FROM A MULTILINE TERMINAL
Programming can be accomplished using Multiline Terminals equipped with an LCD.
Programming should be used after the system is installed and initial assignments are
made. Using the Multiline Terminal is a quick way to access system data and make
changes. To program from a Multiline Terminal one of the following terminals is
required.
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
SECTION 6
DTH-8D-1( ) TEL
DTH-16D-1( ) TEL
DTH-16LD-1( ) TEL
DTH-32D-1( ) TEL
DTR-8D-1( ) TEL
DTR-16D-1( ) TEL
DTR-32D-1( ) TEL
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
DTU-8D-2 TEL
DTP-16D-1 TEL
DTU-16D-2 TEL
DTP-32D-1 TEL
DTU-32D-2 TEL
ITH-8D-2 TEL
ITH-16D-2 TEL
DTP-8D-1 TEL
ELECTRA ELITE IPK II REMOTE PC PROGRAMMING
The Electra Elite IPK II system can be programmed from a remote location using a
personal computer.
6.1
Remote Programming
To provide remote programming the following hardware is required:
J
J
SECTION 7
Internal Modem
MOD-U10 ETU installed on the CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
Available Trunk in the system
LAN Programming
CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
Available Network
DETERMINING REQUIRED EQUIPMENT
To determine equipment type and quantity to be installed, the technician must be
familiar with available station equipment and interface ETUs.
___________________________________________________________________________________
4-2
Hardware Requirements
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.1
Station Equipment
The station equipment that can be installed with the Electra Elite IPK II system
is listed below.
Equipment
Description
DCR-60-1 CONSOLE
Attendant Console with 60 programmable line
keys
DTP-2DT-1 TEL
DTR-2DT-1 TEL
2-line digital Multiline Terminal without LCD
DTU-8-1 TEL
DTP-8-1 TEL
DTH-8-1 TEL
DTR-8-1 TEL
8-line digital Multiline Terminal without LCD
DTP-8D-1 TEL
DTH-8D-1 TEL
DTR-8D-1 TEL
DTU-8D-2 TEL
ITH-8D-2 TEL
8-line digital Multiline Terminal with LCD and
softkeys
DTP-16-1 TEL
DTU-16-1 TEL
DTH-16-1 TEL
16-line digital Multiline Terminal without LCD
DTP-16D-1 TEL
DTH-16D-1 TEL
DTR-16D-1 TEL
DTU-16D-2 TEL
ITH-16D-2 TEL
16-line digital Multiline Terminal with LCD and
softkeys
DTH-16LD-1 TEL
16-line digital Multiline Terminal with three
LCDs (one for telephone information and two
areas for recording line key information)
DTP-16HC-1 TEL
16-line digital Multiline Terminal with LCD,
softkeys and a cordless handset
DTP-32-1 TEL
DTU-32-1 TEL
32-line digital Multiline Terminal without LCD
DTP-32D-1 TEL
DTH-32D-1 TEL
DTR-32D-1 TEL
DTU-32D-2 TEL
32-line digital Multiline Terminal with LCD and
softkeys
DTR-1-1 TEL
Single Line Telephone with Message Waiting
Indicator and data port
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
4-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Equipment
7.2
Description
DTR-1(HM)-1 TEL
Single Line Telephone with Message Waiting
Indicator and data port, eight programmable
speed dial buttons, and Hold and Monitor keys
DTR-1R-1 TEL
Dterm Multiline Cordless Telephone without
LCD
DTR-4R-1/2 TEL
Dterm Multiline Cordless Telephone with LCD
DTH-4R-1/2TEL
Dterm Multiline Cordless Telephone with LCD
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP
Single Line Telephone interface Adapter
Interface ETUs
Electra Elite IPK II KSU slots are flexible except for the CPU/EXP and AP slots
in the first cabinet. The CPU/EXP slot is reserved for the CPUII( )-U( ) ETU,
and the AP slot is not used at this time. Figure 4-1 Interface Slot and System
Port Numbers for an Electra Elite IPK II System shows the slot and port
numbers.
Basic and Expansion KSUs for CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
EXP
(KSU2)
EXP
(KSU1)
(BASIC
KSU)
CPUII
Not
Used
Not
Used
Not
Used
272
thru
257
288
thru
273
314
thru
289
330
thru
315
346
thru
331
352
thru
347
368
thru
353
384
thru
369
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
S8
144
thru
129
160
thru
145
176
thru
161
192
thru
177
208
thru
193
224
thru
209
240
thru
225
256
thru
240
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
S8
16
thru
1
32
thru
17
48
thru
33
64
thru
49
80
thru
65
96
thru
81
112
thru
97
128
thru
113
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
S8
Figure 4-1 Interface Slot and System Port Numbers for an Electra Elite IPK II System
___________________________________________________________________________________
4-4
Hardware Requirements
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.2.1
Determining Telephone and CO Port Numbers
Telephone and CO Ports numbers are provided with the Electra Elite
IPK II system to count the station numbers and trunk numbers when
programming System Data. The example below indicates how the
CO and trunk numbers can be used.
The following ETUs are installed for the Figure 4-2 Telephone and
CO Port Numbering Example.
Slot
ETU
S1
DTI-U( ) (All 24 channels count against the
system maximum capacity, even when only 8
or 16 are used).
S2
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU with ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU
S3
TLI(2)-U( )
S4
COI(8)-U( )
S5
SLI(8)-U( )
S6
DID(4)-U( )
S7
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU
S8
Open
Trunk
Ports
1 ~ 24
Telephone
Ports
1 ~ 16
Trunk
Ports
25 ~ 28
(See Note)
Trunk
Ports
29 ~ 36
Telephone
Ports
17 ~ 24
Trunk
Ports
37~40
Telephone
Ports
25~32
Open
S1
S2
S3
S4
S5
S6
S7
S8
The TLI(2)-U( ) ETU has two E&M Tie lines, however, four of the system Trunk
ports are used.
Figure 4-2 Telephone and CO Port Numbering Example
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
4-5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
4-6
Hardware Requirements
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 5
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ....................................................................................... 5-1
Section 2
Site Preparation and MDF/IDF Construction ............................................... 5-1
Section 3
2.1
Precautionary Information ........................................................................... 5-1
2.2
Surveying the Customer Site ...................................................................... 5-1
2.3
Selecting the Best Location for Proper Installation ..................................... 5-2
2.3.1
Selecting the KSU Installation Site ................................................................ 5-2
2.3.2
Selecting a Permanent MDF Location ........................................................... 5-2
2.3.3
Selecting a Site for Installing the Telephones ............................................... 5-3
2.4
Constructing the Main Distribution Frame (MDF) ........................................ 5-3
2.5
Power Failure Transfer ................................................................................ 5-8
2.6
Fax CO Branch Connection ........................................................................ 5-9
Installing Basic and Expansion KSUs .......................................................... 5-9
3.1
General Information .................................................................................. 5-10
3.1.1
Basic KSU ................................................................................................... 5-10
3.1.2
Expansion KSUs .......................................................................................... 5-10
3.2
Removing the KSU Cover ......................................................................... 5-10
3.3
Securing Cables Using the Velcro Strap ................................................... 5-11
3.4
Wall Mounting the Basic KSU ................................................................... 5-12
3.5
Wall Mounting the Expansion KSU ........................................................... 5-15
3.6
Rack Mounting the Basic KSU .................................................................. 5-16
3.7
Rack Mounting the Expansion KSU .......................................................... 5-18
3.8
Floor Mounting the Basic KSU .................................................................. 5-19
3.9
Cable Routing ........................................................................................... 5-20
3.9.1
Connecting the Battery Expansion Cables on the KSU ............................... 5-20
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.2
3.10
3.11
Grounding Requirements ............................................................................ 5-21
Replacing the Power Supply Unit in the KSU ........................................... 5-23
3.10.1
Connecting the Power Supply Unit to the Basic KSU .................................. 5-23
3.10.2
Connecting Battery Expansion Cables to the Expansion KSU .................... 5-25
3.10.3
Fuse Replacement
.................................................................................... 5-26
Installing Built-In and External Batteries in the KSU ................................ 5-27
3.11.1
Built-In Battery Installation ........................................................................... 5-27
3.11.2
External Battery Installation ......................................................................... 5-29
3.11.2.1
Basic KSU ................................................................................ 5-29
3.11.2.2
Expansion KSU ........................................................................ 5-32
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List of Figures and Tables
Chapter 5
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 5-1
Typical Full MDF Layout ............................................................................................. 5-4
Table 5-1
MDF Cable Connections ............................................................................................ 5-5
Table 5-2
PFT Connections ........................................................................................................ 5-7
Figure 5-2
Power Failure Transfer Connections .......................................................................... 5-8
Figure 5-3
Fax CO Branch Connection ....................................................................................... 5-9
Figure 5-4
Removing the Front Panel of the KSU ..................................................................... 5-11
Figure 5-5
Threading the Velcro Strap to Secure Amphenol Cables ......................................... 5-11
Figure 5-6
Threading the Velcro Strap to Secure Three Amphenol Cables .............................. 5-12
Figure 5-7
Attaching the Wall Mount Bracket ............................................................................ 5-12
Figure 5-8
Attaching the Wall Mount Bracket with Spacer ........................................................ 5-13
Figure 5-9
Hanging the Basic KSU on the Bracket ....................................................................5-13
Figure 5-10
Securing the Basic KSU to the Wall ......................................................................... 5-14
Figure 5-11
Attaching the Expansion Wall Mount Bracket
to the Basic Wall Mount Bracket .............................................................................. 5-15
Figure 5-12
RAK-U( ) Unit and KSU ............................................................................................ 5-16
Figure 5-13
Hanging the KSU on the Bracket ............................................................................. 5-17
Figure 5-14
Securing the KSU to the RAK-U( ) Unit ....................................................................5-17
Figure 5-15
Location for Rack Mounting the KSUs ..................................................................... 5-18
Figure 5-16
Floor Mounting the Basic KSU ................................................................................. 5-19
Figure 5-17
Securing the KSU to the Floor Mounting Bracket .....................................................5-19
Figure 5-18
Connecting DC Expansion Cables ........................................................................... 5-20
Figure 5-19
Attaching the Frame Ground Plate ........................................................................... 5-21
Figure 5-20
KSU Grounding ........................................................................................................ 5-22
Figure 5-21
Connecting Wires to the PSU ...................................................................................5-23
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 5-22
Mounting the PSU onto the KSU .............................................................................. 5-24
Figure 5-23
Connecting the PSU Power Cable to the Basic KSU ............................................... 5-24
Figure 5-24
Connecting Battery Expansion Cables to the Expansion KSU ................................ 5-25
Figure 5-25
Removing the PSU from the KSU ............................................................................ 5-26
Figure 5-26
PSU Fuse Replacement ........................................................................................... 5-27
Figure 5-27
Connecting Built-In Batteries .................................................................................... 5-27
Figure 5-28
Placing the Batteries into the KSU ........................................................................... 5-28
Figure 5-29
Connecting the Batteries to the Power Supply Unit ................................................. 5-28
Figure 5-30
Connecting Cables for External Batteries in the Basic KSU .................................... 5-29
Figure 5-31
Connecting the External Battery to the Basic KSU .................................................. 5-30
Figure 5-32
Threading Cables through Clamps on the Basic KSU ............................................. 5-31
Figure 5-33
Removing the Knockout on the Cover of the Basic KSU ......................................... 5-31
Figure 5-34
Leading the Battery Cables out of the Basic KSU .................................................... 5-32
Figure 5-35
External Battery Cable Installation ........................................................................... 5-33
Figure 5-36
Threading Cables through Clamps on Basic and Expansion KSUs ......................... 5-34
Figure 5-37
Removing the Knockouts on the Covers of Basic and Expansion KSUs ................. 5-35
Figure 5-38
Leading the Battery Cables out of the Basic and Expansion KSUs ......................... 5-36
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures and Tables
Installing KSUs
Chapter 5
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
This chapter contains information to help the technician install the KSUs for the
Electra Elite IPK II system. The technician should be familiar with this section before
installing any equipment.
SECTION 2
SITE PREPARATION AND MDF/IDF CONSTRUCTION
Preinstallation planning is essential. Advanced planning minimizes installation time,
cost, and disruption of the customer business activities.
2.1
Precautionary Information
Observe the following warnings during installation.
2.2
1.
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.
2.
Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is
specifically designed for wet locations.
3.
Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the
telephone line is disconnected at the network interface.
4.
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.
Surveying the Customer Site
In most cases, a survey of the customer site is necessary to determine the
proper placement of the Main Distribution Frame (MDF), the exact dimensions
of the area selected for the MDF, cabling requirements, and possible
Intermediate Distribution Frame (IDF) locations.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
The information obtained at the customer site can permit the installer to
partially assemble the MDF before installation at the customer premise. This
can reduce the time spent installing at the customer site and reduce
downtime.
2.3
Selecting the Best Location for Proper Installation
2.3.1
Selecting the KSU Installation Site
When selecting an installation site for the KSU, consider the
following conditions to ensure proper installation.
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
2.3.2
KSUs are normally wall mounted to protect against accident or
flooding.
The KSU should not be located directly beneath pipes. Leaks
or condensation could damage the Electra Elite IPK II system
equipment.
The area where the KSU is located must be free of corrosive
and inflammable gases, excessive chemical or industrial dusts,
and other materials that could cause a hazard to personnel or
to the proper functioning of the equipment.
The operating ambient temperature and humidity must be
within the limits specified in 5.2.2 Environmental Conditions in
Chapter 3 System Specifications.
The operation of the system is virtually noiseless and allows
wide selection of installation sites. Take care to ensure the
KSUs do not present a hazard to office traffic. To minimize
cabling costs, a centralized location must be chosen.
Locate the KSU at a site where a dedicated AC power source
can be easily accessed.
Connect the KSU to a dedicated AC receptacle that is not
being used for any other device such as a computer, copier, or
facsimile machine.
Selecting a Permanent MDF Location
When selecting a permanent site for the MDF, the technician may
encounter some of the following conditions:
J
J
J
Limited space is available but must be used.
The available space may pose one or more environmental
hazards.
The proposed location has limitations such as insufficient
lighting or the lack of a suitable ground for the KSUs.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5-2
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
2.3.3
The technician that encounters these conditions must provide
the best possible solution for installing the equipment. This
document cannot cover all possible situations, precautions,
and actions.
Selecting a Site for Installing the Telephones
When a site is being selected for telephone installation, consider the
following conditions to ensure proper installation.
J
J
2.4
Ensure that the cable length and line resistance (loop),
between the KSU and the telephones, comply with the
specifications listed in Table 3-6 Dterm Series i or Dterm IP
Terminal Loop Resistance and Cable Length on page 3-22 and
Table 3-7 Electra Elite/Dterm Series E Multiline Terminal Loop
Resistance and Cable Length on page 3-23.
Select a place where devices that require an external power
supply can be easily connected to an AC outlet.
Constructing the Main Distribution Frame (MDF)
The Main Distribution Frame (MDF) has two different standard quick-connect
terminal blocks that are mounted on a 3/4” plywood backboard. Mounting
these blocks on standoffs for ease of access is recommended. The
recommended blocks are 66B50 for termination of the MDF Cable Assembly
and 66M50 for termination of the station cables.
The Intermediate Distribution Frame (IDF) requires the 66M50 blocks only.
Both the MDF and the IDF use standard bridging clips for each terminal block.
The bridging clips mate the left half of the terminal block (terminated cable
run) to the right half of the terminal block (crossconnection wire) to the
terminal block (crossconnection wire). The bridging clips are also useful during
troubleshooting to help isolate the cable runs and terminals/telephones from
the central equipment and the Central Office Network from the system. Refer
to Figure 5-1 Typical Full MDF Layout.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
66B50
Type
66M50
Type
Telco
RJ21X
4 Feet
3 Feet
Figure 5-1 Typical Full MDF Layout
The Electra Elite IPK II KSU is connected to each of the Multiline Terminals,
Single Line Telephones, optional equipment, CO/PBX, DID, ISDN, 4-wire
E&M Tie lines (Types I and V), and FT1 digital trunks by separate twisted-pair
cable through the MDF. The 4-wire E&M Tie lines, FT1 lines, and ISDN lines
require multiple twisted-pair cabling. Table 5-1 MDF Cable Connections
provides the necessary cabling information.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5-4
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 5-1 MDF Cable Connections
MDF
Pin
N0.
Running
Cable
Station
Cable
DTH
ESI
SLI
(8)
SLI
(4)
OPX
COI/
COIB/
(8)
COI/
COIB/
(4)
DID
TLI
DTI/
PRT
BRT
First ETU
26
WH–BL
GN
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
GND
TA
TA-1
1
BL–WH
RD
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
—
TB
TB-1
27
WH–OR
GN
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
E-1
RA
RA-1
2
OR–WH
RD
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
M-1
RB
RB-1
28
WH–GN
GN
T
T
T
—
T
T
T
T-1
—
TA-2
3
GN–WH
RD
R
R
R
—
R
R
R
R-1
—
TB-2
29
WH–BR
GN
T
T
T
—
T
T
T
T1-1
—
RA-2
4
BR–WH
RD
R
R
R
—
R
R
R
R1-1
—
RB-2
30
WH–SL
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
GND
—
TA-3
5
SL–WH
RD
R
R
—
—
R
—
—
—
—
TB-3
31
RD—BL
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
E-2
—
RA-3
6
BL–RD
RD
R
R
—
—
R
—
—
M-2
—
RB-3
32
RD-OR
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
T-2
—
TA-4
—
—
R-2
—
TB-4
Fax
Brnch
—
T1-2
—
RA-4
—
R1-2
—
RB-4
GND
TA
TA-1
7
OR–RD
RD
R
R
—
—
R
33
RD–GN
GN
T
T
—
—
T
8
GN–RD
RD
R
R
—
—
R
Second ETU
34
RD–BR
GN
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
9
BR–RD
RD
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
—
TB
TB-1
35
RD–SL
GN
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
E-1
RA
RA-1
10
SL–RD
RD
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
M-1
RB
RB-1
36
BK–BL
GN
T
T
T
—
T
T
T
T-1
—
TA-2
11
BL–BK
RD
R
R
R
—
R
R
R
R-1
—
TB-2
37
BK–OR
GN
T
T
T
—
T
T
T
T1-1
—
RA-2
12
OR–BK
RD
R
R
R
—
R
R
R
R1-1
—
RB-2
38
BK–GN
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
GND
—
TA-3
13
GN–BK
RD
R
R
—
—
R
—
—
—
—
TB-3
39
BK–BR
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
E-2
—
RA-3
14
BR–BK
RD
R
R
—
—
R
—
—
M-2
—
RB-3
40
BK–SL
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
T-2
—
TA-4
15
SL–BK
RD
R
R
—
—
R
—
—
R-2
—
TB-4
41
YL–BL
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
T1-2
—
RA-4
16
BL–YL
RD
R
R
—
—
R
Fax
Brnch
—
R1-2
—
RB-4
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5-5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 5-1 MDF Cable Connections (Continued)
MDF
Pin
N0.
Running
Cable
Station
Cable
DTH
ESI
SLI
(8)
SLI
(4)
OPX
COI/
COIB/
(8)
COI/
COIB/
(4)
DID
TLI
DTI/
PRT
BRT
GND
TA
TA-1
Third ETU
42
YL–OR
GN
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
17
43
OR–YL
RD
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
—
TB
TB-1
YL–GN
GN
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
E-1
RA
RA-1
18
GN–YL
RD
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
M-1
RB
RB-1
44
YL–BR
GN
T
T
T
—
T
T
T
T-1
—
TA-2
19
BR–YL
RD
R
R
R
—
R
R
R
R-1
—
TB-2
45
YL–SL
GN
T
T
T
—
T
T
T
T1-1
—
RA-2
20
SL–YL
RD
R
R
R
—
R
R
R
R1-1
—
RB-2
46
VI–BL
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
GND
—
TA-3
21
BL–VI
RD
R
R
—
—
R
—
—
—
—
TB-3
47
VI–OR
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
E-2
—
RA-3
22
OR–VI
RD
R
R
—
—
R
—
—
M-2
—
RB-3
48
VI–GN
GN
T
T
—
—
T
—
—
T-2
—
TA-4
23
GN–VI
RD
R
R
—
—
R
—
—
R-2
—
TB-4
49
VI–BR
GN
T
T
—
—
T
T1-2
—
RA-4
24
BR–VI
RD
R
R
—
—
R
Fax
Branch
—
—
R1-2
—
RB-4
50
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
25
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PFT circuits are only connected to AMP3.
AMP1 is connected to S1, S2, and S3.
AMP2 is connected to S4, S5, and S6.
AMP3 is connected to S7 and S8.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5-6
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 5-2 PFT Connections
MDF Pin
Number
PFT Connection
42
PFT1 – CO (Tip)
17
PFT1 – CO (Ring)
43
PFT1 – SLI (Tip)
18
PFT1 – SLI (Ring)
44
PFT1 – SLT (Tip)
19
PFT1 – SLT (Ring)
45
PFT2 – CO (Tip)
20
PFT2 – CO (Ring)
46
PFT2 – SLI (Tip)
21
PFT2 – SLI (Ring)
47
PFT2 – SLT (Tip)
22
PFT2 – SLT (Ring)
48
PFT3 – CO (Tip)
23
PFT3 – CO (Ring)
49
PFT3 – SLI (Tip)
24
PFT3 – SLI (Ring)
50
PFT3 – SLT (Tip)
25
PFT3 – SLT (Ring)
Power Failure Transfer
Relay 1
(Amp 3 Connections Only)
PFT circuits are only connected to AMP3.
AMP1 is connected to S1, S2, and S3.
AMP2 is connected to S4, S5, and S6.
AMP3 is connected to S7 and S8.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5-7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.5
Power Failure Transfer
The Power Failure Transfer relay is located in the KSU. When selecting a
Single Line Telephone for power failure transfer, make sure it matches the CO
line dialing type (10 pps, 20 pps, or DTMF) where it is connected. A Single
Line Telephone with a ground button must be used with Ground Start Trunks.
Figure 5-2 Power Failure Transfer Connections is a relay diagram. The relay is
shown with the power ON.
T
E
L
C
O
SLT
Tip
M
D
F
M
D
F
There are three PFT Circuits for each B64-U( ) KTU.
C
O
I
Relay 1
Ring
Tip
S
L
I
Ring
Figure 5-2 Power Failure Transfer Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
5-8
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.6
Fax CO Branch Connection
This connection is made via the fourth port on any four port analog ETU (COI,
COIB, or COID). Refer to Figure 5-3 Fax CO Branch Connection. The
facsimile machine is connected to the eighth port for the specified slot where
the Analog CO ETU is installed.
Demark
T1
R1
T2
R2
T3
R3
T4
R4
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
CO
T8
R8
FAX
RJ-11
Figure 5-3 Fax CO Branch Connection
SECTION 3
INSTALLING BASIC AND EXPANSION KSUS
The compact design of the Electra Elite IPK II KSU provides easy installation. The
KSUs can be floor mounted or rack mounted. Only the Basic KSU can be floor
mounted. The floor mounting option is for demonstration purposes only. The
information in this section provides detailed instructions for installing the KSU.
Before installing the system; observe the following precautions.
J
J
Before beginning installation, ensure that the Power Supply Unit (PSU) is OFF
and that the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet.
Do not touch the soldered surfaces of the ETUs.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5-9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.1
General Information
3.1.1
Basic KSU
The B64-U20 KSU provides service for outside lines, Attendant
Consoles, and interconnection of the station terminals. The B64-U20
KSU has two fixed and eight flexible slots. The first fixed slot is
reserved for the CPUII( )-U( ) ETU in the basic KSU or for the
EXP-U( ) ETU in expansion KSUs. The second fixed slot is not used
in the Electra Elite IPK II KSU. The P64-U10 PSU (power supply
unit), backup batteries, and three PFT relays are included with each
KSU.
3.1.2
Expansion KSUs
The B64-U20 KSU is also used as the expansion unit that can be
attached to the basic KSU to provide additional ports. Two expansion
units can be added to the Electra Elite IPK II system. Each
expansion KSU provides eight flexible slots and accommodates
8-, 16-, or 24-channel interface cards. The P64-U10 PSU (power
supply unit), backup batteries, and three PFT relays are included
with each KSU.
The installation instructions provided in this chapter apply to the
basic B64-U20 KSU and the expansion B64-U20 KSUs unless
otherwise specified.
3.2
Removing the KSU Cover
To access the battery, cables, and ETU slots, the front cover must be
removed.
1.
Loosen the screw that is located near the ON/OFF switch, on the right
side of the KSU. Do not remove the screw from the unit.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 10
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
To remove the front panel, slide it to the right and pull.
Figure 5-4 Removing the Front Panel of the KSU
3.3
Securing Cables Using the Velcro Strap
Amphenol cables attached to the side of the KSU can be secured using the
provided velcro strap. When wall mounting, this should be done prior to
attaching the KSU to the wall mount bracket.
1.
When one or two amphenol cables are attached to the KSU, the velcro
strap can be threaded around the cable and through the hooks to secure
the cables.
Velcro
Cable
Hooks
Figure 5-5 Threading the Velcro Strap to Secure Amphenol Cables
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
When all three amphenol cables are used, the velcro strap is threaded
around the cables, instead of through the hooks, and attached to the
KSU.
Figure 5-6 Threading the Velcro Strap to Secure Three Amphenol Cables
3.4
Wall Mounting the Basic KSU
1.
Before wall mounting the KSU, use the four (locally provided) screws to
attach the wall mount bracket to the wall as shown in Figure 5-7
Attaching the Wall Mount Bracket.
Figure 5-7 Attaching the Wall Mount Bracket
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 12
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
After the bracket is mounted to the wall, peel off the spacer backing.
Place and adhere the spacer to the position shown in Figure 5-8
Attaching the Wall Mount Bracket with Spacer.
All wall and rack mounted KSUs must have the Spacer Bracket added to
the Wall Mount Bracket.
2.17 in.
Spacer
2.56 in
.
Figure 5-8 Attaching the Wall Mount Bracket with Spacer
3.
Hang the KSU on the two hooks protruding from the wall mount bracket
as shown in Figure 5-9 Hanging the Basic KSU on the Bracket.
Figure 5-9 Hanging the Basic KSU on the Bracket
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Secure the KSU to the wall by placing a locally provided screw and
washer in the hole in the center of the wall mount bracket as shown in
Figure 5-10 Securing the Basic KSU to the Wall.
Figure 5-10 Securing the Basic KSU to the Wall
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 14
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.5
Wall Mounting the Expansion KSU
1.
Fit the bottom of the Expansion Wall Mount Bracket to the top of the
Basic Wall Mount Bracket. Refer to Figure 5-11 Attaching the Expansion
Wall Mount Bracket to the Basic Wall Mount Bracket.
Figure 5-11 Attaching the Expansion Wall Mount Bracket
to the Basic Wall Mount Bracket
2.
Hang the KSU on the two hooks protruding from the expansion wall
mount bracket as shown in Figure 5-9 Hanging the Basic KSU on the
Bracket.
3.
To secure the KSU to the wall, install a locally provided screw in the hole
in the center of the wall mount bracket as shown in Figure 5-10 Securing
the Basic KSU to the Wall on page 5-14.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.6
Rack Mounting the Basic KSU
The RAK-U( ) Unit is a 19 inch unit used to simplify installation by rack
mounting the Electra Elite IPK II system.
1.
Mount the RAK-U( ) Unit to the equipment rack using the six provided
screws. Refer to Figure 5-12 RAK-U( ) Unit and KSU. Use three screws
on the right side (at 1, 2, and 3) and three screws on the left side.
A
1
A1
2
3
RAK-U10 Unit
Figure 5-12 RAK-U( ) Unit and KSU
2.
Mount the Wall Mount Bracket onto the RAK-U( ) Unit using the four
provided screws. Install two screws in the upper holes (at A) and two
screws in the lower holes (at A1).
3.
After the bracket is mounted to the RAK-U( ) Unit, hang the KSU on the
two hooks protruding from the Wall Mount Bracket, as shown in Figure
5-13 Hanging the KSU on the Bracket.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 16
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 5-13 Hanging the KSU on the Bracket
4.
Secure the KSU to the RAK-U( ) Unit by installing a provided screw into
the KSU tab and bracket hole A2. Refer to Figure 5-14 Securing the KSU
to the RAK-U( ) Unit.
Figure 5-14 Securing the KSU to the RAK-U( ) Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.7
Rack Mounting the Expansion KSU
1.
Refer to Figure 5-15 Location for Rack Mounting the KSUs, for the
proper location of rack mounting the Basic KSU and the Expansion
KSUs.
C
C
C
C
C
2nd Exp.
KSU
B
B
B
B
B
1st Exp.
KSU
A
A
A
A
A
Basic
KSU
RAK-U( ) Unit
Figure 5-15 Location for Rack Mounting the KSUs
2.
The Basic KSU is installed in the lower position of the rack mounting
bracket. The Basic KSU is secured using the five threaded screw holes
marked A.
3.
The 1st Expansion KSU is installed in the center position and is secured
using the five threaded screw holes marked B.
4.
The 2nd Expansion KSU is installed in the upper position and is secured
using the five threaded screw holes marked C.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 18
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.8
Floor Mounting the Basic KSU
Only the B64-U( ) KSU with no expansion KSU can be floor mounted.
1.
Use the four locally provided screws to attach the floor mount bracket to
the floor.
2.
Slide the KSU over the four hooks protruding from the floor mount
bracket as shown in Figure 5-16 Floor Mounting the Basic KSU.
Figure 5-16 Floor Mounting the Basic KSU
3.
To secure the KSU to the floor mounting bracket, install the two screws
as indicated in Figure 5-17 Securing the KSU to the Floor Mounting
Bracket.
Figure 5-17 Securing the KSU to the Floor Mounting Bracket
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9
Cable Routing
3.9.1
Connecting the Battery Expansion Cables on the KSU
1.
Use the DC Expansion Cable (included with the EXP-U ETU) to
connect the BATTERY EXT on the Basic KSU to the
BATTERY EXT of the Expansion KSU.
Figure 5-18 Connecting DC Expansion Cables
2.
To connect an Expansion KSU, use the two screws to attach
the FG plate to the Basic and Expansion KSUs. Refer to Figure
5-19 Attaching the Frame Ground Plate. (When installing a
second Expansion KSU, another FG plate is required.)
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 20
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 5-19 Attaching the Frame Ground Plate
3.9.2
Grounding Requirements
The KSUs must be properly grounded. The Electra Elite IPK II KSUs
are provided with a typical AC third-wire ground. When this ground is
questionable, an alternative ground must be provided.
1.
Connect the grounding cable (green wire) to the ground
terminal on the right side of the Basic KSU. The locally
provided grounding cable AWG must be greater than #16.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 21
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 5-20 KSU Grounding
2.
Provide a suitable ground inside of a building in accordance
with local telephone company procedures.
3.
When no suitable ground is available, a ground rod should be
installed in accordance with the operating procedures of the
local telephone company.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 22
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.10
Replacing the Power Supply Unit in the KSU
The Electra Elite IPK II system has a P64-U( ) PSU for each KSU. The Power
Supply Unit has a battery backup interface and accepts 117 Vac and outputs
+5V and –24V to the system.
The Power Supply Unit is included with the B64-U20 KSU.
Before replacing the PSU, remove the defective PSU and verify that
the power cord on the replacement PSU is unplugged.
3.10.1
Connecting the Power Supply Unit to the Basic KSU
1.
Connect the 8-wire cable from the PSU to the connector on the
backplane of the KSU.
Cable
Connections
Figure 5-21 Connecting Wires to the PSU
2.
Install the P64-U( ) PSU into the bottom space of the KSU and
attach it to the KSU using the two provided screws.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 23
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 5-22 Mounting the PSU onto the KSU
3.
Lead the KSU power cable through the clamp and connect the
PSU as shown in Figure 5-23 Connecting the PSU Power
Cable to the Basic KSU.
Power Cable
Figure 5-23 Connecting the PSU Power Cable to the Basic KSU
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 24
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.10.2
Connecting Battery Expansion Cables to the Expansion KSU
1.
Lead the Battery Expansion Cables (included with the
EXP-U( ) ETU) through the clamps and tie them to the KSU
with a tie wrap on the expansion KSU.
Figure 5-24 Connecting Battery Expansion
Cables to the Expansion KSU
2.
When using two expansion KSUs, connect the PSU of each
expansion KSU with the Battery expansion cables, lead the
cables through the clamps, and tie them with a tie wrap.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 25
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.10.3
Fuse Replacement
For continued protection against risk of fire, replace
fuses with the same type and rating originally
installed.
1.
Turn off the power switch and remove the front cover on the
KSU. (Refer to Figure 5-4 Removing the Front Panel of the
KSU.)
2.
Pull out the drawer that holds the PSU and disconnect the
cable as shown in Figure 5-25 Removing the PSU from the
KSU.
Cable
Connections
Fuse
Figure 5-25 Removing the PSU from the KSU
3.
Replace the fuses as necessary and return the PSU to the
KSU. Fuse F1 is a 125V, 6A fuse for AC input. Fuse F101 is a
125V, 6.0A fuse for DC input.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 26
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
F101 (DC In)
F1 (AC In)
Figure 5-26 PSU Fuse Replacement
3.11
Installing Built-In and External Batteries in the KSU
3.11.1
Built-In Battery Installation
1.
Connect the two batteries in series as shown in Figure 5-27
Connecting Built-In Batteries. The red cord attaches to the red
terminal and the black cord attaches to the black terminal.
Be careful, and properly connect the
terminals of the batteries.
Figure 5-27 Connecting Built-In Batteries
2.
Install the batteries into the bottom space at the left side the
KSU. Refer to Figure 5-28 Placing the Batteries into the KSU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 27
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Install the battery cover as illustrated in Figure 5-28 Placing the
Batteries into the KSU.
Figure 5-28 Placing the Batteries into the KSU
4.
Connect the cable to the BATTERY INT connector of the PSU
as shown in Figure 5-29 Connecting the Batteries to the Power
Supply Unit.
Figure 5-29 Connecting the Batteries to the Power Supply Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 28
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.11.2
External Battery Installation
Batteries that are purchased locally can be connected to the system
as external batteries.
When installing external batteries, disconnect the
battery cable for the built-in batteries from the
BATTERY INT connector of each KSU. When the
built-in batteries are connected with the external
batteries, a large charging current could flow from
the external batteries to the built-in batteries and
burn the battery cables.
3.11.2.1
Basic KSU
1.
Connect cabling to the external batteries as shown
in Figure 5-30 Connecting Cables for External
Batteries in the Basic KSU.
Figure 5-30 Connecting Cables for External
Batteries in the Basic KSU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 29
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Connect the external batteries to the KSU in the
location shown in Figure 5-31 Connecting the
External Battery to the Basic KSU. Connect the
external battery cable to the EXT connector on the
PSU of the Basic KSU. Bundle any extra cabling
together.
Figure 5-31 Connecting the External
Battery to the Basic KSU
3.
Route the cables through the clamps on the KSU as
shown in Figure 5-32 Threading Cables through
Clamps on the Basic KSU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 30
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 5-32 Threading Cables through
Clamps on the Basic KSU
4.
Before putting the cover on the Basic KSU, remove
the knockout (indicated by the arrow). Refer to
Figure 5-33 Removing the Knockout on the Cover of
the Basic KSU.
Figure 5-33 Removing the Knockout on the
Cover of the Basic KSU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 31
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.
Lead the battery cables through the knockout and
secure the front cover on the Basic KSU. Refer to
Figure 5-34 Leading the Battery Cables out of the
Basic KSU.
Figure 5-34 Leading the Battery Cables
out of the Basic KSU
3.11.2.2
Expansion KSU
When connecting batteries to the Expansion KSUs,
connections that must also be made to the Basic KSU
are noted in the following instructions. Although a
3-cabinet drawing is not provided, the third KSU draws
its external battery power by connecting a cable to the
EXT connection of the second KSU. This provides a
daisy-chain connection between all three KSUs.
1.
Connect cabling provided by NEC to the external
batteries as shown in Figure 5-30 Connecting
Cables for External Batteries in the Basic KSU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 32
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Connect the external battery cable to the EXT
connector on the PSU of the Basic KSU and the
Expansion KSUs as shown in Figure 5-35 External
Battery Cable Installation. Bundle any extra cabling
together.
Connecting this cable to PSU EXT
connector solves voltage
drop problems.
Figure 5-35 External Battery Cable Installation
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 33
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Route the cables through the clamps on the Basic
and Expansion KSUs as shown in Figure 5-36
Threading Cables through Clamps on the Basic and
Expansion KSUs.
Figure 5-36 Threading Cables through Clamps
on the Basic and Expansion KSUs
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 34
Installing KSUs
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Before putting the covers on the Basic and
Expansion KSUs, remove the knockouts (indicated
by the arrows). On the Basic KSU, knockouts must
be removed from the top and the bottom of the KSU
cover. On the Expansion KSU, only the bottom
knockout is removed. Refer to Figure 5-37
Removing the Knockouts on the Covers of Basic
and Expansion KSUs.
Figure 5-37 Removing the Knockouts on the Covers
of Basic and Expansion KSUs
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
5 - 35
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.
Lead the battery cables through the knockouts on
the Basic and Expansion KSUs and secure the front
covers on the KSUs. Refer to Figure 5-38 Leading
the Battery Cables out of the Basic and Expansion
KSUs.
Figure 5-38 Leading the Battery Cables out of the
Basic and Expansion KSUs
___________________________________________________________________________________
5 - 36
Installing KSUs
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 6
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ....................................................................................... 6-1
Section 2
Installation ...................................................................................................... 6-2
2.1
Installation Precautions ............................................................................... 6-2
2.2
Inserting an ETU into the KSU Slots ........................................................... 6-4
2.3
Removing an ETU from the KSU ................................................................ 6-6
Section 3
Powering Up the Elite IPK II .......................................................................... 6-7
Section 4
Common Control ETUs .................................................................................. 6-8
4.1
CPUII( )-U10 ETU ...................................................................................... 6-8
4.1.1
Description ........................................................................................................ 6-8
4.1.2
Installation ......................................................................................................... 6-8
4.1.3
Switch Settings ................................................................................................. 6-9
4.1.4
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-10
4.1.5
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-11
4.1.6
Replacing Memory Backup ............................................................................. 6-12
4.1.7
DSPII-U10 Daughter Board ............................................................................ 6-12
4.1.8
MOD-U10 Unit ................................................................................................ 6-13
4.1.9
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-13
4.1.10 Upgrading the CPUII( )-U10 ETU .................................................................. 6-13
4.2
PKUII-U (Port Key Unit) ............................................................................ 6-17
4.3
EXP-U( ) ETU ........................................................................................... 6-18
4.3.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-18
4.3.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-19
4.3.3
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-19
4.3.4
MOD-U10 Unit ................................................................................................ 6-19
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 5
Trunk ETUs ................................................................................................... 6-20
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
BRT(4)-U( ) ETU ..................................................................................... 6-20
5.1.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-20
5.1.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-21
5.1.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-21
5.1.4
Jumpers .......................................................................................................... 6-21
5.1.5
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-22
5.1.6
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-23
5.1.7
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-23
BRT(4)-U20 ETU ...................................................................................... 6-24
5.2.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-24
5.2.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-25
5.2.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-25
5.2.4
Jumpers .......................................................................................................... 6-25
5.2.5
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-26
5.2.6
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-26
5.2.7
Connections ................................................................................................... 6-27
COI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU ................................................................................. 6-28
5.3.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-28
5.3.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-29
5.3.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-29
5.3.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-30
5.3.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-30
5.3.6
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-31
COIB(4)-U(10) ETU .................................................................................. 6-32
5.4.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-32
5.4.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-33
5.4.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-33
5.4.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-34
5.4.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-34
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.4.6
5.5
5.6
5.7
5.8
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-34
COIB(4)-U20 ETU ..................................................................................... 6-35
5.5.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-35
5.5.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-36
5.5.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-36
5.5.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-37
5.5.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-37
5.5.6
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-38
5.5.7
ETU Feature Chart ......................................................................................... 6-38
COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU ............................................................................. 6-39
5.6.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-39
5.6.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-40
5.6.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-40
5.6.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-41
5.6.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-41
5.6.6
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-42
5.6.7
ETU Feature Chart ......................................................................................... 6-42
COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU ............................................................................... 6-43
5.7.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-43
5.7.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-44
5.7.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-44
5.7.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-44
5.7.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-45
5.7.6
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-45
DID(4)-U( ) ETU ....................................................................................... 6-46
5.8.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-46
5.8.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-47
5.8.3
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-47
5.8.4
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-47
5.8.5
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-48
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.9
5.10
DTI-U40 ETU ............................................................................................ 6-49
5.9.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-49
5.9.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-50
5.9.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-51
5.9.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-54
5.9.5
Alarm Conditions ............................................................................................ 6-54
5.9.6
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-55
5.9.7
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-55
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU ....................................................................................... 6-57
5.10.1 Description ...................................................................................................... 6-57
5.10.2 Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-58
5.10.3 Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-58
5.10.4 LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-59
5.10.5 Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-59
5.10.6 Connections .................................................................................................... 6-59
Section 6
Station ETUs ................................................................................................. 6-60
6.1
6.2
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU ....................................................................................... 6-60
6.1.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-60
6.1.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-61
6.1.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-61
6.1.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-61
6.1.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-61
6.1.6
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-62
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU .................................................................................... 6-63
6.2.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-63
6.2.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-64
6.2.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-64
6.2.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-64
6.2.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-65
6.2.6
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-65
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
Table of Contents
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.3
6.4
6.5
6.6
6.7
ESIB(8)-U20 ETU ...................................................................................... 6-66
6.3.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-66
6.3.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-67
6.3.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-67
6.3.4
ETU Compatibility ........................................................................................... 6-68
6.3.5
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-68
6.3.6
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-68
6.3.7
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-69
ESIE(8)-U10 ETU ...................................................................................... 6-70
6.4.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-70
6.4.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-71
6.4.3
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-71
6.4.4
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-72
6.4.5
Pin Assignments ............................................................................................. 6-72
ESIE(8)-U20 ETU ...................................................................................... 6-74
6.5.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-74
6.5.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-75
6.5.3
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-75
6.5.4
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-76
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU ...................................................................................... 6-77
6.6.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-77
6.6.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-78
6.6.3
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-78
6.6.4
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-79
6.6.5
Connections ................................................................................................... 6-79
SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU ................................................................................... 6-80
6.7.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-80
6.7.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-81
6.7.3
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-81
6.7.4
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-81
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
v
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.7.5
6.8
6.9
Section 7
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-82
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU ..................................................................................... 6-83
6.8.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-83
6.8.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-83
6.8.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-84
6.8.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-85
6.8.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-86
6.8.6
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-86
SLIE(4)-U10 ETU ..................................................................................... 6-87
6.9.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-87
6.9.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-88
6.9.3
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-88
6.9.4
Connections .................................................................................................... 6-89
Voice Mail ETUs ........................................................................................... 6-90
7.1
7.2
CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETUCMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU .............................................. 6-90
7.1.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-90
7.1.2
Installation ....................................................................................................... 6-92
7.1.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................... 6-93
7.1.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................... 6-94
7.1.5
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-96
7.1.6
Jumper Settings .............................................................................................. 6-96
7.1.7
Connectors ..................................................................................................... 6-96
CTI/VP(4)/(8)/(12)/(16)-U( ) ETU ............................................................. 6-97
7.2.1
Description ...................................................................................................... 6-97
7.2.1.1
System Board Components ........................................................ 6-99
7.2.1.2
Daughter Board Components ................................................... 6-101
7.2.1.3
Port Expansion Board ............................................................... 6-102
7.2.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-102
7.2.3
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-102
___________________________________________________________________________________
vi
Table of Contents
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.3
CTP( )-U10 ETU ..................................................................................... 6-103
7.3.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-103
7.3.2
Checklist of Components .............................................................................. 6-103
7.3.3
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-105
7.3.4
Installing Drive on CTP( )-U10 ETU ............................................................. 6-106
7.3.5
Removing the Drive ...................................................................................... 6-108
7.3.6
Installing DSPs on the CTP( )-U10 ETU ....................................................... 6-109
7.3.7
Installing and Removing the CTP( )-U10 ETU ............................................. 6-110
7.3.8
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-111
7.3.9
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-111
7.3.10 Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-111
7.4
7.5
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)- U( ) ETU ........................................................................ 6-112
7.4.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-112
7.4.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-115
7.4.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-116
7.4.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-117
7.4.5
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connectors ........................................................... 6-120
7.4.6
FMS-U30 ETU Jumper Settings ................................................................... 6-120
7.4.7
FMS-U30 ETU Connectors ........................................................................... 6-120
VMP( )-U40 ETU ..................................................................................... 6-121
7.5.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-121
7.5.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-122
7.5.3
Installing Flash Drive on the VMP( )-U40 ETU ............................................. 6-123
7.5.4
Installing Hard Drive on the VMP( )-U40 ETU ............................................. 6-125
7.5.5
Installing DSP( )-U30 on VMP( )-U40 ETU ................................................... 6-129
7.5.6
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-132
7.5.7
Jumper Settings ............................................................................................ 6-133
7.5.8
VMP( )-U40 LED Indications ......................................................................... 6-133
7.5.9
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-134
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
vii
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.6
Section 8
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU ........................................................................ 6-135
7.6.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-135
7.6.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-138
7.6.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-138
7.6.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-140
7.6.5
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connectors ........................................................... 6-142
7.6.6
VMS-U30 ETU Jumper Settings ................................................................... 6-142
7.6.7
VMS-U30 ETU Connectors ........................................................................... 6-142
Optional ETUs ............................................................................................ 6-143
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
BSU(4M)-U20 ETU ................................................................................. 6-143
8.1.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-143
8.1.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-144
8.1.3
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-145
8.1.4
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-145
BSU(2S)-U20 ETU ................................................................................. 6-146
8.2.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-146
8.2.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-146
8.2.3
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-148
8.2.4
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-148
BSU(6S)-U20 ETU ................................................................................. 6-149
8.3.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-149
8.3.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-150
8.3.3
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-151
8.3.4
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-151
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU ................................................................................... 6-152
8.4.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-152
8.4.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-153
8.4.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-153
8.4.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-153
8.4.5
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-154
___________________________________________________________________________________
viii
Table of Contents
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.4.6
8.5
8.6
8.7
8.8
8.9
Connections .................................................................................................. 6-154
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU .................................................................................... 6-155
8.5.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-155
8.5.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-156
8.5.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-156
8.5.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-157
8.5.5
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-158
CNF(16)-U20 ETU .................................................................................. 6-159
8.6.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-159
8.6.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-161
8.6.3
Configuring ................................................................................................... 6-161
8.6.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-163
8.6.5
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-164
HUB(8)-U( ) ETU .................................................................................... 6-165
8.7.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-165
8.7.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-166
8.7.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-166
8.7.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-166
8.7.5
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-166
IAD(8)-U( ) ............................................................................................... 6-167
8.8.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-167
8.8.2
Boot Up Sequence Status Identification ....................................................... 6-168
8.8.3
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-168
8.8.4
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-169
8.8.5
Ethernet Status ............................................................................................ 6-169
8.8.6
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-169
IVR Application ........................................................................................ 6-170
8.9.1
Description .................................................................................................... 6-170
8.9.2
Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-171
8.9.3
Switch Settings ............................................................................................. 6-171
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
ix
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.10
8.9.4
LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-172
8.9.5
Jumper Settings ............................................................................................ 6-173
8.9.6
Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-174
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU ................................................................................... 6-175
8.10.1 Description .................................................................................................... 6-175
8.10.2 License ......................................................................................................... 6-176
8.10.3 Installation ..................................................................................................... 6-176
8.10.4 Applications Removal Procedure .................................................................. 6-177
8.10.5 Configuring ................................................................................................... 6-177
8.10.6 LED Indications ............................................................................................. 6-178
8.10.7 Connectors ................................................................................................... 6-180
___________________________________________________________________________________
x
Table of Contents
List of Figures
Chapter 6
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-1
Inserting the ETU into the KSU .................................................................................. 6-2
Figure 6-2
Inserting or Removing ETUs from the KSU ................................................................ 6-3
Figure 6-3
Handling an ETU ........................................................................................................ 6-3
Figure 6-4
Safety Precautions when Setting Switches on an ETU .............................................. 6-4
Figure 6-5
Sliding the ETU into the KSU Slot .............................................................................. 6-5
Figure 6-6
Lifting the Ejector Tabs on the ETU ........................................................................... 6-6
Figure 6-7
CPUII( )-U10 ETU ..................................................................................................... 6-9
Figure 6-8
EXP-U( ) ETU .......................................................................................................... 6-18
Figure 6-9
MOD-U10 Unit .......................................................................................................... 6-19
Figure 6-10
BRT(4)-U10 ETU ...................................................................................................... 6-20
Figure 6-11
BRT(4)-U( ) ETU Connections ................................................................................ 6-23
Figure 6-12
BRT(4)-U20 ETU ...................................................................................................... 6-24
Figure 6-13
BRT(4)-U20 ETU Connections ................................................................................. 6-27
Figure 6-14
COI(8)-U( ) ETU ...................................................................................................... 6-28
Figure 6-15
COI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connections ............................................................................ 6-31
Figure 6-16
COIB(4)-U(10) ETU .................................................................................................. 6-32
Figure 6-17
COIB(4)-U(10) ETU Connections ............................................................................. 6-34
Figure 6-18
COIB(4)-U20/U30 ETU ............................................................................................. 6-35
Figure 6-19
COIB(4)-U20 ETU Connections ...............................................................................6-38
Figure 6-20
COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU ............................................................................................. 6-39
Figure 6-21
COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Connections ........................................................................6-42
Figure 6-22
COID(8)-U( ) ETU .................................................................................................... 6-43
Figure 6-23
COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connections ......................................................................... 6-45
Figure 6-24
DID(4)-U( ) ETU ...................................................................................................... 6-46
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
xi
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-25
DID(4)-U( ) ETU Connections ................................................................................. 6-48
Figure 6-26
DTI-U40 ETU ........................................................................................................... 6-49
Figure 6-27
DTI-U40 ETU Connectors ........................................................................................ 6-55
Figure 6-28
ISDN PRI Connectors .............................................................................................. 6-56
Figure 6-29
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU ....................................................................................................... 6-57
Figure 6-30
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU Connections .................................................................................. 6-59
Figure 6-31
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU ....................................................................................................... 6-60
Figure 6-32
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU Connection ................................................................................... 6-62
Figure 6-33
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU .................................................................................................... 6-63
Figure 6-34
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU Connection ................................................................................. 6-65
Figure 6-35
ESIB(8)-U20 ............................................................................................................. 6-66
Figure 6-36
ESIB(8)-U20 Connection .......................................................................................... 6-69
Figure 6-37
ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU .................................................................................................... 6-70
Figure 6-38
ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU Connection ................................................................................. 6-72
Figure 6-39
ESIE(8)-U20 ............................................................................................................. 6-74
Figure 6-40
ESIE(8)-U20 Connection .......................................................................................... 6-76
Figure 6-41
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU ..................................................................................................... 6-77
Figure 6-42
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU CN1 Connection ......................................................................... 6-79
Figure 6-43
SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU .................................................................................................. 6-80
Figure 6-44
SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connections ............................................................................. 6-82
Figure 6-45
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU ..................................................................................................... 6-83
Figure 6-46
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU Connections ................................................................................ 6-86
Figure 6-47
SLIE(4)-U10 ETU ..................................................................................................... 6-87
Figure 6-48
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU Connections ................................................................................ 6-89
Figure 6-49
CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU ............................................................................................... 6-91
Figure 6-50
CMS-U30 ETU ......................................................................................................... 6-92
Figure 6-51
EliteMail CTI System Board ..................................................................................... 6-98
Figure 6-52
EliteMail CTI Daughter Board ................................................................................ 6-100
___________________________________________________________________________________
xii
List of Figures
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-53
EliteMail CTI Port Expansion Board ....................................................................... 6-101
Figure 6-54
CTP( )-U10 ETU (Front View) ............................................................................... 6-104
Figure 6-55
CTP( )-U10 ETU (Back View) ................................................................................ 6-105
Figure 6-56
Before Installing the Drive ...................................................................................... 6-106
Figure 6-57
Line up Four Screws .............................................................................................. 6-107
Figure 6-58
Slide Drive Toward Connector ............................................................................... 6-107
Figure 6-59
Loosen the Four Screws ........................................................................................ 6-108
Figure 6-60
Push Drive Toward Backplane ............................................................................... 6-108
Figure 6-61
Lift up and Remove Drive from ETU ...................................................................... 6-109
Figure 6-62
Insert Brass Connector End ................................................................................... 6-109
Figure 6-63
Push Other End Down Until it Locks ...................................................................... 6-110
Figure 6-64
FMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU ............................................................................................... 6-113
Figure 6-65
FMS(8)-U( ) ETU .................................................................................................... 6-114
Figure 6-66
FMS-U30 ETU ........................................................................................................ 6-115
Figure 6-67
VMP( )-U40 ETU ................................................................................................... 6-122
Figure 6-68
Installing the Flash Drive on the VMP( )-U40 ETU ................................................ 6-123
Figure 6-69
Flash Drive Seated on VMP( )-U40 ETU ................................................................ 6-124
Figure 6-70
Connecting the Hard Drive ..................................................................................... 6-125
Figure 6-71
Plus Sign on Battery Displayed Up ........................................................................ 6-126
Figure 6-72
Connecting the Ribbon Cable ................................................................................ 6-127
Figure 6-73
Leaving Four Pins Unconnected ............................................................................ 6-128
Figure 6-74
Placing the Hard Drive on the ETU ........................................................................ 6-128
Figure 6-75
Placing the Four Mounting Screws ......................................................................... 6-129
Figure 6-76
Installing the DSP-U30 on the VMP( )-U40 ETU .................................................... 6-131
Figure 6-77
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU ........................................................................................ 6-136
Figure 6-78
VMS-U30 ETU ........................................................................................................ 6-137
Figure 6-79
BSU(4M)-U20 ETU ................................................................................................. 6-143
Figure 6-80
BSU(2S)-U20 ETU ................................................................................................. 6-146
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
xiii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-81
BSU(6S)-U20 ETU ................................................................................................. 6-149
Figure 6-82
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU ................................................................................................... 6-152
Figure 6-83
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU ................................................................................................... 6-155
Figure 6-84
CNF(16)-U20 ETU ................................................................................................. 6-160
Figure 6-85
HUB(8)-U( ) ETU ................................................................................................... 6-165
Figure 6-86
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU ..................................................................................................... 6-167
Figure 6-87
VMP(4)-U( ) ETU With IVR Compact Flash ........................................................... 6-170
Figure 6-88
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU ................................................................................................... 6-175
___________________________________________________________________________________
xiv
List of Figures
List Of tables
Chapter 6
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-1
CPUII( )-U10 Default Switch Settings ....................................................................... 6-10
Table 6-2
CPUII( )-U10 LED Indications .................................................................................. 6-11
Table 6-3
CPUII( )-U10 Status ................................................................................................ 6-11
Table 6-4
PKUII-U Unit Configuration ...................................................................................... 6-17
Table 6-5
BRT(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications ........................................................................... 6-22
Table 6-6
BRT(4)-U20 ETU LED Indications ............................................................................ 6-26
Table 6-7
COI(8)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings ................................................................6-29
Table 6-8
COI(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications ............................................................................ 6-30
Table 6-9
COIB(4)-U(10) ETU Default Switch Settings ............................................................ 6-33
Table 6-10
COIB(4)-U(10) ETU LED Indications ........................................................................6-34
Table 6-11
COIB(4)-U20 ETU Default Switch/Jumper Settings ................................................. 6-36
Table 6-12
COIB(4)-U20 ETU LED Indications .......................................................................... 6-37
Table 6-13
COIB(4)-U20 ETU Feature Chart ............................................................................. 6-38
Table 6-14
COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Default Switch/Jumper Settings ..........................................6-40
Table 6-15
COIB(8)-U20/30 ETU LED Indications ..................................................................... 6-41
Table 6-16
COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Feature Chart ..................................................................... 6-42
Table 6-17
COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications ....................................................................6-44
Table 6-18
DID(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications ............................................................................. 6-47
Table 6-19
DTI-U40 Default Switch Settings .............................................................................. 6-51
Table 6-20
DTI-U40 ETU LED Indications ................................................................................. 6-54
Table 6-21
DTI Configurations ................................................................................................... 6-56
Table 6-22
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings ................................................................. 6-58
Table 6-23
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU LED Indications .............................................................................. 6-59
Table 6-24
ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU MJ1 Pin Assignments .................................................................. 6-72
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
xv
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-25
ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU MJ2 Pin Assignments .................................................................. 6-73
Table 6-26
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU SW2 Switch Settings ................................................................... 6-84
Table 6-27
SW2-2/SW2-3 Details .............................................................................................. 6-85
Table 6-28
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU SW3 Switch Settings ................................................................... 6-85
Table 6-29
Configuration Support Table .................................................................................... 6-90
Table 6-30
CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Functions ............................................................ 6-93
Table 6-31
CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indicators ....................................................................... 6-94
Table 6-32
CMS-U30 ETU LED Indications ............................................................................... 6-95
Table 6-33
Configuration Support .............................................................................................. 6-98
Table 6-34
System Board Components ..................................................................................... 6-99
Table 6-35
Daughter Board Components ................................................................................ 6-101
Table 6-36
Port Expansion Board Components ....................................................................... 6-102
Table 6-37
Configuration Support Table .................................................................................. 6-112
Table 6-38
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Switch Settings .............................................................. 6-116
Table 6-39
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Functions ..................................................... 6-117
Table 6-40
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications ............................................................... 6-117
Table 6-41
FMS-U30 ETU LED Indications ............................................................................. 6-118
Table 6-42
VMP( )-U40 ETU Switch Settings .......................................................................... 6-132
Table 6-43
VMP( )-U40 ETU Jumper Settings ......................................................................... 6-133
Table 6-44
VMP( )-U40 ETU LED Indications (on back of ETU) .............................................. 6-133
Table 6-45
VMP( )-U40 ETU Connectors ................................................................................. 6-134
Table 6-46
Configuration Support Table .................................................................................. 6-135
Table 6-47
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Settings ....................................................... 6-138
Table 6-48
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Functions ..................................................... 6-139
Table 6-49
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications ............................................................... 6-140
Table 6-50
VMS-U30 ETU LED Indications ............................................................................. 6-141
Table 6-51
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings ............................................................. 6-153
Table 6-52
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications ......................................................................... 6-153
___________________________________________________________________________________
xvi
List of Tables
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-53
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU Reset Switch ............................................................................. 6-156
Table 6-54
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU Maximum Conference Time Switch .......................................... 6-157
Table 6-55
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU Party Size Switch ...................................................................... 6-157
Table 6-56
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications .......................................................................... 6-157
Table 6-57
Default Network Settings for TCP/IP Addressing ................................................... 6-161
Table 6-58
CNF(16)-U20 ETU Dip Switch SW1 ....................................................................... 6-162
Table 6-59
CNF(16)-U20 ETU Rotary Switch SW3 .................................................................. 6-162
Table 6-60
CNF(16)-U20 ETU LED Indications ....................................................................... 6-163
Table 6-61
HUB(8)-U( ) LEDS .................................................................................................. 6-166
Table 6-62
IAD(8)-U( ) Configurations ...................................................................................... 6-168
Table 6-63
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU LED Boot Sequence Indications .................................................. 6-168
Table 6-64
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU Switches ...................................................................................... 6-169
Table 6-65
Switch Settings for VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU ................................................................ 6-171
Table 6-66
VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications .................................................................... 6-172
Table 6-67
VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Ready LED Indications ......................................................... 6-173
Table 6-68
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU Configurations ........................................................................... 6-177
Table 6-69
Default Network Settings for TCP/IP Addressing ................................................... 6-177
Table 6-70
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU Rotary Switch SW3 ................................................................... 6-178
Table 6-71
Default Boot Sequence: In Active PVA(X)-U( ) ETU
without IP Application Loaded ................................................................................ 6-179
Table 6-72
Active PVA(X)-U( ) ETU with IP Application Loaded ............................................. 6-179
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
xvii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
xviii
List of Tables
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Chapter 6
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
Each Electronic Telephone Unit (ETU) is installed in a slot in the Basic or Expansion
KSU.
The B64-U20 KSU has 10 slots that are divided into three categories:
J
J
J
CPU/EXP Slot
AP Slot (Not Used)
Interface (IF) Slot
CPU/EXP Slot
This is the first slot from the left in the KSU. A CPUII( )-U10 ETU must be installed in
this slot in the Basic KSU and an EXP-U10 ETU must be installed in this slot in the
Expansion KSU.
The CPUII( )-U10 ETU can be damaged when installed in
slots S1~S8!
AP Slot
The AP slot (second slot from the left in the KSU), is not used at this time in the
Electra Elite IPK II KSU.
Do not install a CPU or EXP ETU in this slot in the Expansion
KSU!
Interface Slots (S1~S8)
Any interface ETU can be installed in these slots.
The remainder of this chapter describes installation procedures for each ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 2
INSTALLATION
2.1
Installation Precautions
Observe the following precautions when installing the
ETUs to avoid static electricity damage to hardware or
exposure to hazardous voltages.
J
J
J
CMOS technology that is very susceptible to static is extensively used in
the ETUs in this system; therefore, extreme care must be taken to avoid
static discharge when handling ETUs.
Make all switch setting changes on the ETU before inserting it in the
KSU.
When installed, the component side of all ETUs must face the left side of
the KSU. Ejector tabs are always on top. Refer to Figure 6-1 Inserting
the ETU into the KSU.
Figure 6-1 Inserting the ETU into the KSU
J
J
Carry an ETU in a conductive polyethylene bag to prevent static
electricity.
The ETU installer must wear a grounded wrist strap to protect the ETU
from static electricity.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6-2
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
When you insert or remove an ETU, be sure the wrist strap is connected
to the Frame Ground Terminal on the KSU.
Frame
Ground
Terminal
Figure 6-2 Inserting or Removing ETUs from the KSU
J
When you hold an ETU, do not touch the components or the soldered
surfaces with bare hands. Place one hand under the bottom corner of
the ETU and with the other hand hold the ejector tab (located in the top
corner of the ETU).
Ejector
Tab
Figure 6-3 Handling an ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
When you set switches on the ETU, wear a wrist strap and stand on a
grounded conductive work surface to avoid static electricity.
ETU
Wrist
Strap
Grounded
Conductive
Surface
Figure 6-4 Safety Precautions when Setting Switches on an ETU
J
2.2
Do not touch the surface of the ETU. A small screw driver can be used
to change the switch settings when the installer follows the
recommended safety precautions.
Inserting an ETU into the KSU Slots
1.
To unlock the ETUs slots, move the slide bar to the left.
2.
Slide the ETU into the proper slot in the KSU.
3.
After the ETU is pushed all the way to the back of the KSU, move the
slide bar to the right to lock the ETU slots.
If inserting multiple ETUs, wait approximately 15 seconds between each ETU
and move the slide bar right after the last one is installed.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6-4
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-5 Sliding the ETU into the KSU Slot
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6-5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.3
Removing an ETU from the KSU
1.
To unlock the ETUs, move the slide bar to the left.
2.
Lift the ejector tab on the ETU and pull the ETU out of the slot.
Figure 6-6 Lifting the Ejector Tabs on the ETU
3.
To secure remaining ETUs, move slide bar to the right.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6-6
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 3
POWERING UP THE ELITE IPK II
CPU comes from the factory with a pre-installed test database. The following
procedure must be completed to ensure proper operation.
Powering Up the Elite IPK II System for the First Time
1.
Insert the CPUII( )-U10 ETU into the CPU slot.
It is important to note that ETUs for slots 1~24 are not installed at this time.
2.
When starting system for the first time, press and hold the LOAD button on
the CPUII( )-U10 ETU. Turn the system power ON while continuing to hold the
LOAD button.
3.
After approximately five seconds or when the Live LED starts to flash, release
the LOAD button. This performs a cold start on the Elite IPK II system to ensure
you are starting with a defaulted system.
4.
Wait about five minutes for the system to boot.
5.
After the system finishes booting, you can start slotting the remaining ETUs one
at a time. Wait until LED 2 stops flashing before inserting the next ETU.
Powering Up the Elite IPK II System with an In-Skin Voice Mail
1.
While the system is powered OFF, remove the In-Skin Voice Mail ETU.
2.
Power up the system.
3.
After the system finishes booting, reinsert the In-Skin Voice Mail ETU and turn
the Voice Mail power ON.
This procedure does not apply to CTP-U10, VMP-U30, or VMP-U40 based
systems.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6-7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 4
COMMON CONTROL ETUS
The Electronic Telephone units described in this section control the common
functions of the KSU.
4.1
CPUII( )-U10 ETU
4.1.1
Description
The CPUII( )-U10 ETU is the Central Processing Unit for the system.
This ETU has a Central Processing Unit and a Microprocessing Unit
(MPU).
A 32-bit microprocessor executes the programs stored on the Flash
ROM ICs of the MPU unit. This controls the entire system when data
is transferred to and from other ETUs.
This ETU provides the following items:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
4.1.2
Time Switch Control 512 CH
Digital Phase Lock Loop (DPLL)
Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
DSPII-U10 (Daughter Board)
32-bit Processor
25 MHz Clock
64-channel DTMF Push Button Receiver (PBR)
Two blocks of 32 Conference Circuits with any number of
parties as long as the block limit is not exceeded.
External Music-on-Hold input (also used for station background
music)
Flash ROM (FROM)
Call Progress and DTMF Tone Generator
Memory Backup Battery (Retains memory for approximately
three years when fully charged)
Key Function (KF)/Multifunction (MF) Registration
Compact Flash Memory – 128MB maximum, Compact Flash
Type 1 only (must be FAT 16 format)
Installation
Each system must have this ETU installed in the CPU/EXP slot of
the basic B64-U20 KSU. Each system has one CPUII( )-U10 ETU.
Refer to Figure 6-7 CPUII( )-U10 ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6-8
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
The CPUII( )-U10 ETU can be severely
damaged when installed in slots S1~S8.
Figure 6-7 CPUII( )-U10 ETU
4.1.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-1 CPUII( )-U10 Default Switch Settings.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6-9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-1 CPUII( )-U10 Default Switch Settings
Description
SW1
Momentary
Switch
Load
SW2
Up
Default/Normal State
Down
System Reset
SW3-1
4.1.4
Description
Description
SW3-2
On (Up)
RS-232C
Monitor On
On (Up)
Off
RS-232C
Monitor Off
Off
Description
Not Used
Not Used
Connectors
Before programming System Data, the battery must be installed in
CN6 to allow memory retention when a power failure or brownout
occurs. When a brownout or power failure occurs, and the battery
backup circuit is not activated, Time and Date, Terminal status (e.g.,
MIC), and SMDR Data are reset. System data is not lost due to the
battery backup circuit.
When a CPUII( )-U10 ETU is installed and the system or battery
backup fails for any reason, the clock/calendar must be set. The fully
charged battery retains memory for approximately three years.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 10
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.1.5
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-2 CPUII( )-U10 LED Indications.
Table 6-2 CPUII( )-U10 LED Indications
LED
Description
LED1
On indicates that Compact Flash is installed
LED2
Indicates system alarms – Refer to Table 6-3 CPUII( )-U10
Status
LED3
Indicates system alarms – Refer to Table 6-3 CPUII( )-U10
Status
LED4
Indicates system alarms – Refer to Table 6-3 CPUII( )-U10
Status
LED5
(LIVE)
On indicates the PKG is operating.
The LEDs are on the back of the ETU in the following order top
to bottom:
LED5 (LIVE)
LED4
LED3
LED2
LED1
Table 6-3 CPUII( )-U10 Status
LED Indication
Status
LED5
LED4
LED3
LED2
LED1
On
Off
Off
Off
On
System starting up
Off
Off
Off
Off
On
System initializing
Off
On
Off
Access
blink
On
Initializing disk or
formatting
Off
Off
On
On
On
Boot program initializing in
flash memory
Off
On
On
Access
blink
On
Reading system software
On
Blinking
Blinking
Blinking
On
Upgrading system
software
On
Blinking
Off
Off
On
Upgrading boot software
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-3 CPUII( )-U10 Status
LED Indication
Status
LED5
LED4
LED3
LED2
LED1
On
Blinking
Blinking
Off
On
Finish format (SRAM,
Flash)
Blinking
Off
Off
Off
On
DRAM error
Blinking
Off
Off
On
On
FPGA version error
Blinking
Off
On
Off
On
SRAM error
Blinking
Off
On
On
On
Flash memory boot error
Blinking
On
On
On
On
Flash memory data error
Blinking
Blinking
Blinking
Blinking
On
System Program reading
error
Blinking
Off
Off
Off
On
System starting up
4.1.6
Replacing Memory Backup
The battery on the CPUII( )-U10 ETU is used to retain the Clock/
Calendar and Last Number Redial (LNR) buffers for each station
when the CPU encounters a power loss. When the battery is fully
charged, the settings are retained for approximately three years.
The Lithium (CR2032) battery should be replaced every two years.
The system programmed memory (Customer Database) is stored in
Non-Volatile Memory and can only be erased by a First Initialization.
4.1.7
1.
Turn off the KSU power.
2.
Remove the CPUII( )-U10 ETU from the KSU.
3.
Remove the battery from connector CN6.
4.
Install new CR2032 battery in CN6.
5.
Install the CPUII( )-U10 ETU in the KSU.
6.
Turn on the KSU power.
DSPII-U10 Daughter Board
Systems that use VRS or In-Mail require the daughter board. VRS
and In-Mail are provided on a Compact Flash card that plugs into the
daughter board. The DSPDBU plugs into the CN7 connector on the
CPUII( )-U10 ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 12
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.1.8
MOD-U10 Unit
The MOD-U10 Unit provides a Modem and is installed on the
CPUII( )-U10 ETU using connectors J1~J4. The pins of the
MOD-U10 Unit and the sockets on the CPUII( )-U10 ETU are
numbered the same. Line up MOD connector J1 with socket J1 on
the CPUII and carefully plug in the unit.
4.1.9
Connectors
The CPUII( )-U10 ETU has the following connectors:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
4.1.10
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN2
Connects to the AP bus.
CN3
Connects to CN2 on the EXP-U( ) ETU using an
expansion cable.
CN4
LAN connector
CN5
Compact Flash connector
CN6
Holds the Lithium (CR2032) Battery.
CN7
DSPII-U10 (Daughter Board) connector
CN8
Used for FPGA Programming.
CN9
Normal Operation: Pins 1 and 2 shorted.
CPU Debug: Pins 2 and 3 shorted.
CN10
Used for CPU Debug.
CN11
Used for DSP Debug.
J1~J4
Socket Modem connectors
Upgrading the CPUII( )-U10 ETU
You should backup the database before upgrading the CPUII( )-U10
ETU. This can be done with a download from PCPro and saving the
file. Refer to the Electra Elite IPK II PC Programming Manual for
more information.
Upgrading from Compact Flash
1.
Insert the Compact Flash that has the new firmware files in the
CN5 connector on front of the CPUII( )-U10 ETU.
2.
Press and hold the SW1 load switch.
3.
While continuing to hold the SW1 load switch, toggle the SW2
reset switch, and hold the SW1 switch down for five seconds.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
When the firmware has finished copying, LED 1 is on solid,
and LEDs 2~4 blink in unison. You can now remove the
Compact Flash Card, and toggle the SW2 reset switch.
5.
After the system boots, check that the firmware was upgraded
by pressing the Feature key +3.
Remote Upgrade of the CPUII( )-U10 ETU Using PCPro
1.
Before starting, make certain a Compact Flash is installed in
the CPU CN5 connector. Refer to the Installing a Compact
Flash section for more information.
2.
Launch PCPro by selecting Start → Programs → Electra
Elite IPK II PCPro → Electra Elite IPK II PCPro.
3.
Login to PCPro. The default login is tech with a password of
12345678.
4.
Connect to IPK II by selecting Connect from the toolbar or
selecting Connect from the Communications Menu.
5.
Define the connection information and click Connect.
6.
From the Communications Menu, select Firmware Update.
The Firmware Update window displays.
7.
In the Firmware File field, browse out to the location where you
stored the Firmware Package file provided by NEC.
8.
Select the time when you want the update to be applied. After
PCPro uploads the Firmware Package file the system can reset
and switch to the new version immediately or at a scheduled
date and time.
The time specified is relative to the time on the KTS, not the PC
that PCPro was run from. Technicians must consider time
zones when scheduling updates.
9.
Click Start to begin uploading the Firmware Package file. The
progress bar indicates the progress of the upload.
10.
When the upload is complete, the progress bar indicates
Operation Complete.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 14
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
11.
If you selected immediately after upload, the system resets and
switches to the new firmware version after one minute. If you
selected a time and date, the system resets and switches to the
new firmware on the time and date you specified.
12.
Click Close to close the firmware window.
13.
After a remote upgrade, the Compact Flash must remain in the
system. The CPUII( )-U10 ETU now boots from the Compact
Flash, not the onboard flash. If the Compact Flash is removed,
the system boots off the older version that is in the onboard
flash.
14.
Up to two versions of firmware are kept on the Compact
Flash. One version is the current version that the CPU used to
boot from. The other version is the new version that is used on
the next boot up. If boot up fails, the CPU can revert back to
the older version.
To verify if the system was upgraded to the new firmware
version, reconnect with PCPro and check the version number
of the KTS in the lower right corner. The on site technician can
press the Feature Key +3 from any Multiline Terminal.
Remote Upgrade of the CPUII( )-U10 ETU Using WebPro
1.
Prior to starting, make sure a Compact Flash is installed in the
CPU CN5 connector. Refer to Compact Flash section for more
information.
2.
Select Start → Programs → Internet Explorer to launch
WebPro.
3.
From the File Menu, select Open and enter HTTP://
xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx where xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx is the IP address of the
CPUII( )-U10 ETU.
4.
From the logon page, log into WebPro. The default login is
tech with a password of 12345678.
5.
From the Administration section of the Home Page, Click the
Firmware Update icon.
6.
In the Firmware File field, browse to the location where the
Firmware Package file provided by NEC is stored.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.
Select the time to apply the update. After WebPRo uploads
the Firmware Package file, the system can reset and switch to
the new version immediately or at a scheduled time and date.
The time specified is relative to the time on the KTS instead of
the PC that WebPro was run from. The technician must
consider time zone differences when scheduling updates.
8.
Click Start to begin uploading the Firmware Package file. The
progress bar indicates the progress of the upload.
9.
Click OK when asked if you are sure you want to proceed.
10.
The update procedure may take a few minutes to complete.
Do not interact with the browser window until the update is
complete. Do not reset the CPU until the update is complete.
11.
After the upload is complete, a complete message is displayed
in the WebPro browser window.
12.
When immediately is selected for the Schedule Update section,
reset and switching versions takes place at the beginning of the
next minute (e.g., if upload completes at 4:36:29 PM, reset
takes place at 4:37:00 PM).
After a remote upgrade, the Compact Flash must remain in the
system. The CPUII( )-U10 ETU now boots up from the
Compact Flash, not the onboard Flash memory. If the
Compact Flash is removed, the system boots from the old
version in the onboard Flash.
Two versions of firmware are kept on the Compact Flash.
One version is the current version that the CPU booted from.
The other version is the new version to be used at the next
bootup. If bootup fails, the system can revert to the older
version.
13.
Connect with WebPro again and go to the System
Configuration section of the Home Page to verify that the
system upgraded to the new version.
14.
The Firmware version underneath Cabinet 1 should look like
the following: CPU: xx.xx(America). The on site technician
can press FEATURE +3 from any multiline terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 16
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Writing new Software from Compact Flash to Onboard FLash
As stated above the new software is on the CF after a remote
upgrade. If the CF is removed from the system, the next reset boots
from the old version. The following procedure describes how to write
the new version to the onboard permanent flash.
4.2
1.
Remove the Compact Flash and use a Compact Flash reader
to view the contents of the drive.
2.
Find the BATCH64.UP file.
3.
Rename this file to BATCH64.TXT.
4.
Perform the Upgrading from Compact Flash procedure.
PKUII-U (Port Key Unit)
When the Port Key Unit is installed, the system has an Expanded Port
Package. When the PKUII-U Unit is not installed, the system has a Basic Port
Package.
The PKUII-U Unit is installed in the IC11 socket of the CPUII( )-U10 ETU.
Table 6-4 PKUII-U Unit Configuration
Basic Port
Package
Expanded Port
Package
Basic Terminals (Telephones)
64
256,
Dedicated CAR/VE
256
256
Basic Terminals + CAR/VE
320,
512
Basic Trunks
64,
200
Universal Slots
24
24
Basic Terminals + Trunks
64,
416,
Description
, Sixteen port slots X 24 Universal slots (384) plus 32 common ports shared by all
three cabinets equals 416 ports.
The PKUII-U Unit cannot be removed after it is installed and the system has
been initialized. If it is removed, the CPUII( )-U10 ETU cannot boot up.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.3
EXP-U( ) ETU
4.3.1
Description
The EXP-U( ) ETU is the Expansion KSU Controller. This ETU
controls transmission between the CPUII( )-U10 ETU and the other
ETUs installed in the expansion KSU when it is installed.
Figure 6-8 EXP-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 18
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.3.2
Installation
Turn system power off, and install the EXP-U( ) ETU in the
CPU/EXP slot of the expansion KSU.
4.3.3
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN2
Connected to CN3 on the CPUII( )-U10 ETU or
CN3 on EXP-U( ) ETU (installed in the first
expansion cabinet) using an expansion cable.
CN3
Connected to CN2 on the EXP-U( ) ETU
installed in the third expansion cabinet using the
expansion cable.
4.3.4
Not used when the EXP-U( ) ETU is installed in
the last Expansion KSU.
MOD-U10 Unit
This unit is installed on the CPUII( )-U10 ETU to provide a modem
and must be installed in connectors J1, J2, J3, and J4.
Figure 6-9 MOD-U10 Unit
The MOD-U10 Unit pins and the sockets of the CPUII( )-U10 ETU
are labeled alike. Line up MOD unit connector J1 with CPUII ETU J1
and MOD unit J2 with CPUII ETU J2, and carefully plug in the unit.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 5
TRUNK ETUS
The Electronic Telephone Units described in this section provide a link between
trunks in the Electra Elite IPK II system and outside equipment. All ETUs are installed
in the interface slots of the KSU.
5.1
BRT(4)-U( ) ETU
5.1.1
Description
The Basic Rate Trunk (BRT) Interface ETU terminates ISDN Basic
Rate Trunk lines and supports four ISDN-BRI circuits. Each trunk
supports two B channels. These eight B channels can be used for
CO trunks with DTMF signaling. Tip and Ring electrical fuses are
provided to comply with UL 1459 requirements.
This ETU uses an S/T-type interface. When connecting to a CO, a
locally provided Network Termination unit (NT1) is required. Caller
ID is supported.
One BRT ETU provides a maximum of four ISDN circuits that
provide eight B channels to be used as trunks.
Figure 6-10 BRT(4)-U10 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 20
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.1.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of seven BRT(4)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in any
interface slot in the system. The system limitation is 64 trunks and
station ports combined.
The maximum number of BRT(4)-U( ) ETUs depends on other trunk
cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX lines
in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 BRT(4)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in any interface
slot in the system. The system limitation is 200 trunks.
The maximum number of BRT(4)-U( ) ETUs depends on other trunk
cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX lines
in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
5.1.3
Switch Settings
SW1 is the reset switch.
5.1.4
Jumpers
CN101 and CN102
J
Set the 100 Ω termination to On or Off for Circuit 1. Jumper
Pins 1 and 2 are shorted together at the factory to turn on the
100 Ω terminal.
CN201 and CN202
J
Set the 100 Ω termination to On or Off for Circuit 2. Jumper
Pins 1 and 2 are shorted together at the factory to turn on the
100 Ω terminal.
CN301 and CN302
J
Set the 100 Ω termination to On or Off for Circuit 3. Jumper
Pins 1 and 2 are shorted together at the factory to turn on the
100 Ω terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 21
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
CN401 and CN402
J
5.1.5
Set the 100 Ω termination to On or Off for Circuit 4. Jumper
Pins 1 and 2 are shorted together at the factory to turn on the
100 Ω terminal.
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-5 BRT(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-5 BRT(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LED 1
ETU status
Operation
stopped
(Power On)
Normal
Operation
No
Power
LED 2
L1 status - BRI
CKT1
L1 working
Not Used
L1 idle
LED 3
L1 status - BRI
CKT2
L1 working
Not Used
L1 idle
LED 4
L1 status - BRI
CKT3
L1 working
Not Used
L1 idle
LED 5
L1 status - BRI
CKT4
L1 working
Not Used
L1 idle
LED 6
B1 or B2 status
CKT 1
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 7
B1 or B2 status
CKT 2
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 8
B1 or B2 status
CKT 3
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 9
B1 or B2 status
CKT 4
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED
10
Communication
or self-diagnostics
Communication
error
or
Self-diagnostics
in progress
Not Used
Normal
LED
11
Communication
or self-diagnostics
Communication
error
or
Self-diagnostics
in progress
Not Used
Normal
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 22
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.1.6
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
5.1.7
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
Connections
MDF for BRT ETU
TELCO
Network
and CO
ST/4 Wire
TA 1
TB 1
RA 1
RB 1
NT1
ST/4 Wire
TA 2
TB 2
RA 2
RB 2
NT1
ST/4 Wire
TA 3
TB 3
RA 3
RB 3
NT1
ST/4 Wire
TA 4
TB 4
RA 4
RB 4
NT1
Circuit 1
U Interface / 2 Wire
Circuit 2
Circuit 3
Circuit 4
Figure 6-11 BRT(4)-U( ) ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 23
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.2
BRT(4)-U20 ETU
5.2.1
Description
The Basic Rate Trunk (BRT) Interface ETU terminates ISDN Basic
Rate Trunk lines and supports four ISDN-BRI circuits. Each trunk
supports two B channels. These eight B channels can be used for
CO trunks with DTMF signaling.
This ETU uses an S/T-type interface. When connecting to a CO, a
locally provided Network Termination unit (NT1) is required. Caller
ID is supported.
One BRT ETU provides a maximum of four ISDN circuits that
provide eight B channels to be used as trunks.
Figure 6-12 BRT(4)-U20 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 24
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.2.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of seven BRT(4)-U20 ETUs can be installed in any
interface slot in the system. The system limitation is 64 trunk and
station ports combined.
The maximum number of BRT(4)-U20 ETUs depends on other trunk
cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX lines
in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 BRT(4)-U20 ETUs can be installed in any interface
slot in the system. The system limitation is 200 trunks.
The maximum number of BRT(4)-U20 ETUs depends on other trunk
cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX lines
in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
5.2.3
Switch Settings
SW1 is the reset switch.
DSW1 is used for maintenance. Normal operation is all three Off.
Switches DSW1~3
5.2.4
ON: IPK II BRT Mode
OFF: IPK BRT Mode
Jumpers
CN101 and CN102
Set the 100 Ω termination to On or Off for Circuit 1. Jumper Pins 1
and 2 are shorted together at the factory to turn on the 100 Ω
terminal.
CN201 and CN202
Set the 100 Ω termination to On or Off for Circuit 2. Jumper Pins 1
and 2 are shorted together at the factory to turn on the 100 Ω
terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 25
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
CN301 and CN302
Set the 100 Ω termination to On or Off for Circuit 3. Jumper Pins 1
and 2 are shorted together at the factory to turn on the 1100 Ω
terminal.
CN401 and CN402
Set the 100 Ω termination to On or Off for Circuit 4. Jumper Pins 1
and 2 are shorted together at the factory to turn on the 100 Ω
terminal.
5.2.5
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-6 BRT(4)-U20 ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-6 BRT(4)-U20 ETU LED Indications
LED
5.2.6
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LED 1
ETU status
Operation
stopped
(Power On)
Normal
Operation
No
Power
LED 2
L1 status - BRI
CKT1
L1 working
Not Used
L1 idle
LED 3
L1 status - BRI
CKT2
L1 working
Not Used
L1 idle
LED 4
L1 status - BRI
CKT3
L1 working
Not Used
L1 idle
LED 5
L1 status - BRI
CKT4
L1 working
Not Used
L1 idle
LED 6
B1 or B2 status
Circuit 1
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 7
B1 or B2 status
Circuit 2
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 8
B1 or B2 status
Circuit 3
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 9
B1 or B2 status
Circuit 4
Busy
Not Used
Idle
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN3
DB9 Pin Male connector used for maintenance
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 26
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.2.7
Connections
MDF for BRT ETU
TELCO
Network
and CO
ST/4 Wire
TA 1
TB 1
RA 1
RB 1
NT1
ST/4 Wire
TA 2
TB 2
RA 2
RB 2
NT1
ST/4 Wire
TA 3
TB 3
RA 3
RB 3
NT1
ST/4 Wire
TA 4
TB 4
RA 4
RB 4
NT1
Circuit 1
U Interface / 2 Wire
Circuit 2
Circuit 3
Circuit 4
Figure 6-13 BRT(4)-U20 ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 27
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.3
COI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
5.3.1
Description
The COI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU is the Central Office interface. The COI
ETU contains circuitry for outside ring detection, holding, dialing, and
control functions.
This ETU can provide a CAMA trunk for Enhanced E911.
The COI(8)-U( ) ETU has identical circuits to serve up to eight CO
trunks that can be any combination of Loop Start or Ground Start
with DTMF signaling. The COI(4)-U( ) ETU is for Loop Start trunks
with DTMF signaling only. ETU Tip and Ring electrical fuses are
provided to comply with UL 1459 requirements.
Refer to Figure 6-14 COI(8)-U( ) ETU.
Figure 6-14 COI(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 28
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.3.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 14 COI(4)-U( ) ETUs or seven COI(8)-U( ) ETUs can
be installed in any interface slot. The system limitation is 64 trunk or
station ports combined.
The maximum number of COI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 COI(4)-U( ) ETUs or 23 COI(8)-U( ) ETUs can be
installed in any interface slot. The system limitation is 200 trunks.
The maximum number of COI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
5.3.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-7 COI(8)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings.
Table 6-7 COI(8)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings
Switch
Setting
Description
SW1~8
Set according to the
line type.
Default Setting: LP
Switches between Loop Start (LP)
or Ground Start (GS) Trunks on
Lines 1~8 of COI(8)-U10 ETU.
Reset
N/A
Resets the COI ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 29
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.3.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-8 COI(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-8 COI(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
5.3.5
Description
On
Flashing
Off
Operation
stopped
(Power On)
Normal
Operatio
n
No Power
LIVE
ETU status
LED 1
Line 1 status
COI(4)/COI(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 2
Line 2 status
COI(4)/COI(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 3
Line 3 status
COI(4)/COI(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 4
Line 4 status
COI(4)/COI(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 5
Line 5 status COI(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 6
Line 6 status COI(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 7
Line 7 status COI(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 8
Line 8 status COI(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 30
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.3.6
Connections
MDF
MDF
Demark
T1
R1
T2
R2
T3
R3
T4
R4
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
COI(4)-U( ) ETU
CO
T1
R1
T2
R2
T3
R3
T4
R4
T5
R5
T6
R6
T7
R7
T8
R8
Demark
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
CO
COI(8)-U( ) ETU
Figure 6-15 COI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 31
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.4
COIB(4)-U(10) ETU
5.4.1
Description
This ETU can function the same as the COI(4)-U( ) ETU or
COID(4)-U( ) ETU to provide a Central Office interface. When the
ETU is set for COID mode, Loop Start trunks and /or Caller ID trunks
are supported. When the ETU is set for COI mode, Loop Start or
Ground Start is supported. Caller ID is not supported in COI mode.
Connections for Ground Start trunks are polarity sensitive.
Fax CO Branch Support is provided on Port 4 only.
Only DTMF signaling is supported.
This ETU can provide an E911 CAMA trunk.
Tip and Ring electrical fuses are provided to comply with UL 1459
requirements.
Figure 6-16 COIB(4)-U(10) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 32
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.4.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 14 COIB(4)-U(10) ETUs can be installed in any
interface slot. The system is limited by 64 trunk and station ports
combined.
The maximum number of COIB(4)-U(10) ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 COIB(4)-U(10) ETUs can be installed in any
interface slot when configured as either a COI/COID ETU. The
system is limited by 200 trunks.
The maximum number of COIB(4)-U(10) ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
5.4.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-9 COIB(4)-U(10) ETU Default Switch Settings.
Table 6-9 COIB(4)-U(10) ETU Default Switch Settings
Switch
Setting
Description
SW100~400
Set for line type.
Default Setting: LP
Switches between Loop Start (LP)
or Ground Start (GS) Trunks.
S1
Open for COI
Shorted (default) for
COID
Selects the function for
COIB(4)-U10 ETU as COI or
COID mode
N/A
Resets the COIB(4)-U10 ETU
Reset
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 33
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.4.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-10 COIB(4)-U(10) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-10 COIB(4)-U(10) ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
ETU status
Operation
stopped
(Power On)
Normal
Operation
No Power
LED 1/
CH1
Channel 1
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 2/
CH2
Channel 2
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 3/
CH3
Channel 3
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 4/
CH4
Channel 4
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
FAX
FAX Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LIVE
5.4.5
Switch SW400 must be set to Loop Start for FAX CO function
to work.
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
5.4.6
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN2
Future
CN3
Future
Connections
Fax
Branch
MDF
Demark
T1
R1
T2
R2
T3
R3
T4
R4
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T8
R8
T
R
CO
Figure 6-17 COIB(4)-U(10) ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 34
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.5
COIB(4)-U20 ETU
5.5.1
Description
These ETUs functions are similar to the COI(4)-U( ) or COID(4)-U( )
ETU to provide a Central Office interface. Only the COIB(4)-U30 can
support the CO Message Waiting Indication feature. These ETUs
have transmit and receive pad controls. When the ETU is set for
COID mode, Loop Start trunks and Caller ID trunks are supported.
When the ETU is set for COI mode, Loop Start is supported.
Ground Start Trunks are not supported. Caller ID is not supported in
COI mode. Fax CO Branch support is provided on port 4 only.
Only DTMF signaling is supported.
This ETU can provide an E911 CAMA trunk on port 3 only.
Tip and RIng electrical fuses are provided to comply with UL 60950
requirements.
Figure 6-18 COIB(4)-U20/U30 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 35
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.5.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 14 COIB(4)-U20 ETUs can be installed in any
interface slot. The system is limited by 64 trunk and station ports
combined.
The maximum number of COIB(4)-U20 ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 COIB(4)-U20 ETUs can be installed in any
interface slot when configured as either a COI/COID ETU. The
system is limited by 200 trunks.
The maximum number of COIB(4)-U20 ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
5.5.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-11 COIB(4)-U20 ETU Default Switch/Jumper
Settings.
Table 6-11 COIB(4)-U20 ETU Default Switch/Jumper Settings
Switch/
Jumper
Setting
Description
JP100~400
Jumpers 1~2 shorted
6dB increase
Jumpers 2~3 shorted (default)
No Gain
Jumpers 3~4 shorted
6dB decrease
Receive pad for
related channel
JP101~401
Jumpers 1~2 shorted
6dB increase
Jumpers 2~3 shorted (default)
No Gain
Jumpers 3~4 shorted
6dB decrease
Transmit pad for
related channel
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 36
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-11 COIB(4)-U20 ETU Default Switch/Jumper Settings
Switch/
Jumper
5.5.4
Setting
Description
S1
Open for COI
Shorted (default) for COID
Selects COIB(4)-U20
ETU COI or COID
mode.
Reset
Toggle
Resets the
COIB(4)-U20 ETU
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-12 COIB(4)-U20 ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-12 COIB(4)-U20 ETU LED Indications
LED
5.5.5
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LIVE
ETU status
Operation
Stopped
(Power On)
Normal
Operation
No
Power
LED 1
Channel 1 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 2
Channel 2 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 3
Channel 3 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 4
Channel 4 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
FAX
FAX status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN2
Future
CN3
Future
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 37
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.5.6
Connections
Fax
Branch
MDF
Demark
T1
R1
T2
R2
T3
R3
T4
R4
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T8
R8
T
R
CO
Figure 6-19 COIB(4)-U20 ETU Connections
5.5.7
ETU Feature Chart
Refer to Table 6-13 COIB(4)-U20 ETU Feature Chart.
Table 6-13 COIB(4)-U20 ETU Feature Chart
ETU
Caller ID
(See
Note)
CO
Message
Waiting
Indicate
Pad
Control
Loop
Start
COI(4)-U10
X
COI(8)-U10
X
COID(4)-U10
X
X
COID(8)-U10
X
X
COIB(4)-U10
X
X
COIB(4)-U20
X
COIB(4)-U30
X
COIB(8)-U10
X
COIB(8)-U30
X
X
X
Ground
Start
Fax
Branch
CAMA
Trunk
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Caller ID is not supported for Ground Start trunks.
The COIB(4)-U20/U30 ETU supports CAMA trunks on port 3 and the
COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU supports CAMA trunks on ports 3 and 7. Other ETUs
listed in this table (with the exception of COIB(8)-U10, support CAMA trunks on
all ports.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 38
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.6
COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU
5.6.1
Description
These ETU functions are similar to the COI(8)-U( ) or COID(8)-U( )
ETU to provide Central Office Interface. Only the COIB(8)-U30 ETU
can support the CO Message Waiting Indication Feature. Transmit
and receive pad controls have been added to the COIB(8)-U20/U30
ETU. When the ETU is set for COID mode, Loop Start trunks and
Caller ID trunks are supported. When the ETU is set for COI mode,
Loop Start is supported. Ground Start Trunks are not supported.
Caller ID is not supported in COI mode. Fax CO Branch support is
provided on port 4 only. Only DTMF signaling is supported.
This ETU can provide a CAMA trunk for E911.
CAMA trunk support is provided on COIB(8)-U20/U30 ports 3 or 7
only.
Tip and Ring electrical fuses are provided to comply with UL 60950
requirements. Refer to Figure 6-20 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU.
Figure 6-20 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 39
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.6.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of seven COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETUs can be installed in any
interface slot. The system is limited by 64 trunk and station ports
combined.
The maximum number of COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETUs can be installed in any
interface slot. A maximum of 23 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETUs can be
installed in any interface slot when configured as COI ETUs. The
system is limited by 200 trunks.
The maximum number of COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
5.6.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-14 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Default Switch/Jumper
Settings.
Table 6-14 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Default Switch/Jumper Settings
Switch/
Jumper
Setting
JP100~800
Jumpers 1-2 shorted
6dB increase
Jumpers 2-3 shorted (default)No Gain
Jumpers 3-4 shorted
6dB decrease
Receive pad for
related channel
JP101~801
Jumpers 1-2 shorted
6dB increase
Jumpers 2-3 shorted (default)No Gain
Jumpers 3-4 shorted
6dB decrease
Transmit pad for
related channel
Open for COI
Shorted (default) for COID
Selects the function
for the COIB(8)-U20/
U30 ETU between
COI or COID mode.
S1
Description
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 40
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-14 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Default Switch/Jumper Settings
Switch/
Jumper
Setting
Reset
5.6.4
Description
N/A
Resets the
COIB(8)-U20/U30
ETU.
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-15 COIB(8)-U20/30 ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-15 COIB(8)-U20/30 ETU LED Indications
5.6.5
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LIVE
ETU status
Operation
Stopped (Power
On)
Normal
Operation
No
Power
LED 1
Channel 1 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 2
Channel 2 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 3
Channel 3 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 4
Channel 4 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 5
Channel 5 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 6
Channel 6 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 7
Channel 7 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 8
Channel 8 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 41
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.6.6
Connections
Demark
MDF
T1
R1
T2
R2
T3
R3
T4
R4
T5
R5
T6
R6
T7
R7
T8
R8
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
CO
Figure 6-21 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Connections
5.6.7
ETU Feature Chart
Refer to Table 6-16 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Feature Chart.
Table 6-16 COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU Feature Chart
ETU
Caller ID
(See
Note)
CO
Message
Waiting
Indicate
Pad
Control
Loop
Start
COI(4)-U10
X
COI(8)-U10
X
COID(4)-U10
X
X
COID(8)-U10
X
X
COIB(4)-U10
X
X
COIB(4)-U20
X
COIB(4)-U30
X
COIB(8)-U10
X
COIB(8)-U30
X
X
X
Ground
Start
Fax
Branch
CAMA
Trunk
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Caller ID is not supported for Ground Start trunks.
The COIB(4)-U20/U30 ETU supports CAMA trunks on port 3 and the
COIB(8)-U20/U30 ETU supports CAMA trunks on ports 3 and 7. Other ETUs
listed in this table (with the exception of COIB(8)-U10, support CAMA trunks on
all ports.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 42
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.7
COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
5.7.1
Description
The COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU is the Central Office interface for Caller ID
Detection. This ETU provides circuitry for outside ring detection,
hold, dialing, Caller ID detection, and control functions.
The COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU provides four/eight trunks that are Loop
Start with DTMF signaling only. Tip and Ring electrical fuses are
provided to comply with UL 1459 requirements.
Figure 6-22 COID(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 43
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.7.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 14 COID(4)-U( ) ETUs or seven COID(8)-U( ) ETUs
can be installed in any interface slot. The system limitation is 64
trunk or station ports combined.
The maximum number of COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 COID(4)-U( ) ETUs or 23 COID(8)-U( ) ETUs can
be installed in any interface slot. The system limitation is 200 trunks.
The maximum number of COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETUs depends on other
trunk cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX
lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
5.7.3
Switch Settings
The RESET switch resets the unit.
5.7.4
LED Indications
Table 6-17 COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LIVE
ETU status
Operation stopped
(Power On)
Normal Operation
No Power
LED 1
Line 1 status
COID(4)/COID(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 2
Line 2 status
COID(4)/COID(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 3
Line 3 status
COID(4)/COID(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 4
Line 4 status
COID(4)/COID(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 5
Line 5 status COID(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 44
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-17 COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LED 6
Line 6 status COID(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 7
Line 7 status COID(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 8
Line 8 status COID(8)
Busy
Not Used
Idle
5.7.5
Connectors
The COID( )-U( ) has one connector:
J
5.7.6
CN1
Connects to the backboard
Connections
MDF
MDF
T1
R1
T2
R2
T3
R3
T4
R4
Demark
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
COID(4)-U( ) ETU
CO
T1
R1
T2
R2
T3
R3
T4
R4
T5
R5
T6
R6
T7
R7
T8
R8
Demark
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
CO
COID(8)-U( ) ETU
Figure 6-23 COID(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 45
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.8
DID(4)-U( ) ETU
5.8.1
Description
The Direct Inward Dialing Interface Unit supports up to four DID or
four 2-way DID lines. Each DID(4)-U( ) ETU requires one interface
slot position in the KSU.
Immediate, wink start, second dial tone, and delay dial signaling can
be combined on this ETU.
Figure 6-24 DID(4)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 46
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.8.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 14 DID(4)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of DID(4)-U( ) ETU depends on other trunk
cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX lines
in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 DID(4)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of DID(4)-U( ) ETUs depends on other trunk
cards installed. This ETU shares the total number of CO/PBX lines
in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
5.8.3
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-18 DID(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-18 DID(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
5.8.4
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LIVE
ETU status
Operation
Stopped
(Power On)
Normal
Operation
No
Power
LED 1
Line 1 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 2
Line 2 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 3
Line 3 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 4
Line 4 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 47
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.8.5
Connections
MDF
Demark
T1
T
R1
R
T2
T
R2
R
T3
T
R3
R
T4
T
R4
R
CO
Figure 6-25 DID(4)-U( ) ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 48
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.9
DTI-U40 ETU
5.9.1
Description
The DTI-U40 ETU is a Digital Trunk ETU that terminates FT1 trunks
(up to 24 DS-0 channels). This ETU supports K-CCIS, ANI/DNIS
trunks, and CSU Less Function on T1. On-site firmware upgrade is
supported.
A combination of Loop Start and Ground Start signaling can be used
on the DTI-U40 ETU. Dial Pulse dialing, DTMF, Tie line (E&M) and
DID are supported. The DTI-U40 ETU has 24 built-in DTMF
detectors. Trunks are assigned in groups of four.
When channels are assigned to ANI, the DTI-U40 ETU supports
Feature Group D. The DTI-U40 ETU also supports Feature Group D
incoming MF/outgoing DTMF signaling.
The DTI-U40 ETU supports the K-CCIS common channel signaling
feature with point-to-point E&M Tie lines.
The Integrated Service Digital Network (ISDN) – Primary Rate
Interface (PRI) is a public switched Telephone Network (PSTN)
service that provides 23 B channels and one D (23+D) channel for
voice call trunking. The B channels provide 23 CO/DID connections.
Figure 6-26 DTI-U40 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 49
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.9.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of two DTI-U40 ETUs, configured as either DTI or PRT,
can be installed in any slot. The system is limited by 64 trunk and
system ports combined.
The maximum number of DTI-U40 ETUs depends on other trunk
cards installed. This ETU shares the CO/PBX lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 11 DTI-U40 ETUs, configured as either DTI or PRT,
can be installed in any slot. The system is limited by 200 trunks.
The maximum number of DTI-U40 ETUs depends on other trunk
cards installed. This ETU shares the CO/PBX lines in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
The maximum number of DTI-U40 ETUs and PRT(1)-U( ) ETUs that
can be installed is 11 per system.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 50
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.9.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-19 DTI-U40 Default Switch Settings.
Table 6-19 DTI-U40 Default Switch Settings
Switch
Setting
SW1–1
ON: Use channel indication by
LEDs 1~8
OFF: Line State indication by
LEDs 1~8 (Default)
SW1–2
SW1–3
When SW1-1 is ON:
SW1-2SW1-3
Used to assign LED
Indications
ON
ON
Not Applicable
OFF
OFF
CH1~ CH8 indication
(Default)
ON Used
ON
OFF
CH9~ CH16 indication
ON Used
OFF ON
SW1-4
Description
CH17~ CH24 indication
ON Used
ON: DS-1 Mode (T1 with CSU Function; external CSU not
required)
OFF: DSX-1 Mode (T1 without CSU Function; external CSU
required)
When the system is connected behind an external Channel
Service Unit (CSU), this switch must be ON.
DSX-1 interfaces T1 between the PBX and CSU.
Digital Signal Crossconnect Level 1 (DS-1)
interfaces T1 between the PBX and network with no
CSU (CSU less). Both are standard interfaces
accepted by Telco. Both have the same electrical
characteristics recommended by EIA/TIA 464, but
DSX-1 is preferred because most PBXs have a
CSU/DSU (DSX-1 interface) installed at the
customer site for T1 line protection and ease of
measurements and troubleshooting.
SW1-4 only applies to T1(SW3-1 is on). When the
PRI mode (SW3-1 is off), SW1-4 does not apply and
should be off. See program 10-03-12 for similar
setting for PRI.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 51
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-19 DTI-U40 Default Switch Settings (Continued)
Switch
SW1-5
SW1-6
Setting
When SW1-4 is ON
SW1-5SW1-6
OFF OFF
When LBO = 0dB
ON
When LBO = -7.5dB
When LBO= -15dB
ON
When LBO = -22.5dB
ON
LBO (Line Build Out) adds a combination of
induction, capacitance, and resistance to a cable
pair so its electrical length may be increased by a
desired level of impedance and loss characteristics.
When SW1-4 is ON
SW1-7SW1-8
OFF OFF
Normal Mode (Default)
ON
Line Loop Back Mode
OFF
OFF ON
DTE Loop Back Mode
ON
Local Loop Back Mode
SW2-1
SW2-2
OFF
OFF ON
SW1-7
SW18
Description
ON
In Local Loop Back, data goes through the entire
transmit and receive process. Line Loop Back
allows user to check transmission line continuity.
Select Running Mode
SW2-1SW2-2
ON
ON
Test program mode
ON
OFF
Not Used
OFF ON
F/W upgrade mode
(on-site upgrade)
OFF OFF
Normal mode (Default)
SW2-3
ON: To be determined
OFF: Normal mode (Default)
SW2-4
ON: Watch Timer OFF
OFF: Watch Timer ON (Default)
SW3-1
ON:
T1 mode (Default)
OFF: PRT Mode
Firmware Version 5.00
Firmware Version 1.00
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 52
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-19 DTI-U40 Default Switch Settings (Continued)
Switch
Setting
SW3-2
ON: To be determined
OFF: No operation (Default)
SW3-3
ON: To be determined
OFF: No operation (Default)
SW3-4
ON: To be determined
OFF: No operation (Default)
SW4/5
The DTI-U40 works only with the SW3-2~SW3-4
Default settings.
SW4 SW5
Termination mode
T1/J1 T1 120Ω
T1 mode (Default)
T1/J1 J1 75Ω
J1 mode
E1
T1 120Ω
E1 mode (120Ω
termination)
E1
J1 75Ω
E1 mode (75Ω
termination)
SW6
Description
E1 Services are not supported
Reset Switch
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 53
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.9.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-20 DTI-U40 ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-20 DTI-U40 ETU LED Indications
5.9.5
LED
SW1-1 OFF
With SW1-1 ON
LED 1
Link Indication
ON (Activated)
CH1 or CH9 or CH17 Indication
ON (Used)
LED 2
LSA Error Indication
ON (Error)
CH2 or CH10 or CH18 Indication
ON (Used)
LED 3
AIS Error Indication
ON (Error)
CH3 or CH11 or CH19 Indication
ON (Used)
LED 4
OOF Error Indication
ON (Error)
CH4 or CH12 or CH20 Indication
ON (Used)
LED 5
RAI Error Indication
ON (Error)
CH5 or CH13 or CH21 Indication
ON (Used)
LED 6
Loop Back Indication
ON (Loop Back
mode)
CH6 or CH14 or CH22 Indication
ON (Used)
LED 7
Self-Test Indication
ON (Testing)
CH7 or CH15 or CH23 Indication
ON (Used)
LED 8
Used CH Indication
ON (Using channel)
CH8 or CH16 or CH24 Indication
ON (Used)
LED 9
LIVE Indication
ON (Activated)
Alarm Conditions
A brief description of each alarm condition is given below.
J
Alarm Indication Signal (AIS) Detection
On red when the system is receiving an Alarm Indication Signal
from an FT1 trunk.
J
Controlled Slip Event Detection (SLIP)
On red when the timing difference between a synchronous
receiving terminal and the received signal exceeds the
buffering ability of the terminal.
J
Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) Error Event Detection
On red when a CRC Error occurs.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 54
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
Excessive Bipolar Violation (BPV) Detection
On red when excessive BPV is detected.
J
Line Synchronization Alarm (LSA) Detection
On red when an FT1 trunk loses frame synchronization.
J
Out-of-Frame (OOF) Condition Detection
On red when two of the four or five framing data bits received
are in error.
J
Remote Alarm Indication (RAI) Detection
On red when RAl is received.
5.9.6
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
J
5.9.7
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN3
Serial Port DB-9
Connections
Although the DTI-U40 ETU can connect directly to the Telco TI
Smart Jack, your Telco may require you to purchase and install a
separate Channel Service Unit (CSU) between the Smart Jack and
the DTI-U40 ETU.
MDF
TA
TELCO
T1
Provider
CSU/DSU
4-Wire
Cable
TB
RA
RB
MDF
TA
TELCO
T1
Provider
4-Wire
Cable
TB
RA
RB
Figure 6-27 DTI-U40 ETU Connectors
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 55
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
MDF
TA
ISDN
PRI
Provider
ISDN PRI
TB
CSU/DSU
RA
RB
The CSU may not always be required
Figure 6-28 ISDN PRI Connectors
Table 6-21 DTI Configurations
DTI-U(X)
E&M Tie
Lines
T-1 Trunking
K-CCIS
PRT Mode
DTI-U10
X
N/A
DTI-U20
X
N/A
DTI-U30
X
X
X
N/A
DTI-U40
X1
X1
X1
X2
X
Supported
N/A Not Supported
X1 When using 4.XX or lower firmware or 5.XX or higher, DIP Switch SW3-1
is set in the T-1 Mode.
X2 When using 5.XX or higher, DIP Switch SW3-1 is set in the PRT Mode.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 56
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.10
TLI(2)-U( ) ETU
5.10.1
Description
The Tie Line Interface ETU supports the termination and operation of
up to two E&M Tie lines (4-wire, Type I and Type V, and 10/20 pps
Dial Pulse or DTMF).
Immediate, wink start, second dial tone, and delay dial signaling can
be combined on this ETU.
CN1
LED 3
LED 2
LED 1
TYPE V
TYPE V
SW101
TYPE I
SW201
TYPE I
Figure 6-29 TLI(2)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 57
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.10.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 14 TLI(2)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of TLI(2)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other trunk cards installed. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed. When 2-port trunk interface
ETUs are installed the system uses four ports from its maximum port
capacity.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 TLI(2)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of TLI(2)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other trunk cards installed. The system is limited by 200
trunks.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed. When 2-port trunk interface
ETUs are installed, the system uses four ports from its maximum
port capacity.
5.10.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-22 TLI(2)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings.
Table 6-22 TLI(2)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings
Switch
Setting
Description
SW101
When lines provided by this unit are
used for back-to-back connections,
set to Type V.
When connection is to a Central
Office, set to Type I.
Default: Type V
Switch Type I or
Type V for Line 1
SW201
When lines provided by this unit are
used for back-to-back connections,
set to Type V.
When connection is to a Central
Office, set to Type I.
Default: Type V
Switch Type I or
Type V for Line 2
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 58
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.10.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-23 TLI(2)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-23 TLI(2)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
5.10.5
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LED 1
ETU status
Operation
Stopped
(Power On)
Normal
Operation
No
Power
LED 2
Line 1 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
LED 3
Line 2 status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
5.10.6
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
Connections
Side A
Telco
Side B
MDF
E
E
M
T
T R
M
T T
R
T R
R
R T
R
Figure 6-30 TLI(2)-U( ) ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 59
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 6
STATION ETUS
The station Electronic Telephone Units are installed in the interface slots of the KSU.
6.1
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
6.1.1
Description
The Electronic Station Interface ETU contains eight circuits. Each
circuit can support any Attendant Console, Multiline Terminal, or
Single Line Telephone adapter.
Figure 6-31 ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 60
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.1.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of seven ESI(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8.
The maximum number of ESI(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined. This ETU shares the total number
of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 ESI(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of ESI(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by
256 stations. This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the
system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
6.1.3
Switch Settings
SW1 resets the ETU.
6.1.4
LED Indications
Live LED indications are listed below.
J
J
J
Blinking Red Normal Operation
Steady Red
Operation Stopped (power On)
Off
No Power
LED1 indications are listed below.
J
J
6.1.5
Steady Red
Some port(s) busy
Off
All ports idle
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 61
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.1.6
Connections
BK
RD
To
MDF
GN
To Telephone
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-32 ESI(8)-U( ) ETU Connection
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 62
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.2
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU
6.2.1
Description
The ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU is the basic Electronic Station Interface ETU
that provides an 8-channel interface for Multiline Terminals,
Attendant Consoles, Single Line Telephone Adapter SLTII(1)-U10
ADP. This ETU can be expanded to 16 channels by installing the
ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU.
Figure 6-33 ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 63
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.2.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of seven ESIB(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8.
The maximum number of ESIB(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined. This ETU shares the total number
of Station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 ESIB(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8.
The maximum number of ESIB(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by
256 stations. This ETU shares the total number of Station ports in the
system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Refer to Chapter 3 System Specifications, Section 4 KSU
Power-Based Calculator Chart for Universal Slots.
6.2.3
Switch Settings
SW1 resets the ETU.
6.2.4
LED Indications
Live LED indications are listed below.
J
J
J
Blinking Red Normal Operation
Steady Red
Operation Stopped (power On)
Off
No Power
LED1 indications are listed below.
J
J
Steady Red
Some port(s) busy
Off
All ports idle
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 64
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.2.5
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
6.2.6
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
EXCN1
Connects to EXCN1 on the ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU.
EXCN2
Connects to EXCN2 on the ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU.
Connections
BK
RD
To
MDF
GN
To Telephone
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-34 ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU Connection
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 65
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.3
ESIB(8)-U20 ETU
6.3.1
Description
The ESIB(8)-U20 ETU is the basic Electronic Station Interface ETU
that provides an 8-channel interface for Multiline Terminals,
Attendant Consoles, and Single Line Telephone SLTII(1)-U( ) ADPs.
This ETU also provides one circuit (B1 channel) support for devices
such as the PGD(2)-U10 ADP (adapter) that can be used to connect
Door Boxes, External Speakers with Amplifiers, External Music
Sources, External Recording Systems, and External Ringing. This
ETU can be expanded to 16 channels by installing the ESIE(8)-U20
ETU. When an ESIE(8)-U20 is installed on the ESIB(8)-U20, the
combination can support two circuits (B1 and B2 channels) for
AP(R)-R units or the PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
Figure 6-35 ESIB(8)-U20
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 66
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.3.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of seven ESIB(8)-U20 ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8.
The maximum number of ESIB(8)-U20 ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station ETUs installed. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined. This ETU shares the total number
of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 23 ESIB(8)-U20 ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8.
The maximum number of ESIB(8)-U20 ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station ETUs installed. The system is limited by
256 stations. This ETU shares the total number of station ports in
the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Refer to Chapter 3 System Specifications, Section 4 KSU
Power-Based Calculator Chart for Universal Slots.
6.3.3
Switch Settings
SW1 resets the ETU.
Refer to the table below for ESIBSW functions.
Jumper
ESIBSW
Setting
Description
ESIB-U1X Mode:
ESIB ETU operates as an
ESIB-U10
No Ancillary device support
ESIB-U2X Mode:
ESIB ETU operates as an
ESIB-U20 with support for B1
and B2 channels.
B1 and B2 channel support
available. For B2 Channel
Function, the ESIE(8)-U20
must be installed.
When installed in an Electra Elite IPK, this jumper must be set to
U10 Mode (pins 2 and 3).
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 67
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.3.4
ETU Compatibility
ESIB(8)-U10/U20 ETUs and ESIE(8)-U10/U20 ETUs are compatible
as indicated by the table below.
Electra Elite IPK
ESIE(8)
U10
Electra Elite IPK II
ESIE(8)
U20
ESIE(8)
U10
ESIE(8)
U20
ESIB(8)-10
X
X
X1
X1
ESIB(8)-20 in U10 Mode
X
X
X1
X1
ESIB(8)-20 in U20 Mode
N/A
N/A
N/A
X2
X
Supported
N/A Not supported
X1 Does not support SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP, AP(A/R)-R Port Adapters,
PGD(2)-U10 ADP or Multiline Terminals with CT(U/A)-R units installed.
X2 Supports SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP, AP(A/R)-R Port Adapters, PGD(2)-U10 ADP
or Multiline Terminals with CT(U/A)-R units installed.
6.3.5
LED Indications
LIVE LED indications are listed below:
J
J
J
Blinking Red Normal Operation.
Steady Red
Operation Stopped (Power ON).
Off
No Power.
LED1 indications are listed below:
J
J
6.3.6
Steady Red
Some Port(s) are busy.
Off
All ports are idle.
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
EXCN1
Connects to EXCN1 on the ESIE(8)-U20 ETU.
EXCN2
Connects to EXCN2 on the ESIE(8)-U20 ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 68
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.3.7
Connections
BK
RD
GN
To Telephone
To
MDF
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-36 ESIB(8)-U20 Connection
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 69
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.4
ESIE(8)-U10 ETU
6.4.1
Description
The ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU is the expansion Electronic Station Interface
ETU that provides an additional 8-channel interface for Multiline
Terminals, Attendant Consoles, or the Single Line Telephone
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP (Adapter). This expansion ESI ETU is
piggybacked on the ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU.
Figure 6-37 ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 70
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.4.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of three ESIE(8)-U( ) ETUs, piggybacked on an
ESIB(8), can be installed in slots S1~S8. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined.
The maximum number of ESIE(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. This ETU shares the total
number of stations in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 15 ESIE(8)-U( ) ETUs, piggybacked on an ESIB(8),
can be installed in slots S1~S8. The system is limited by 256
stations.
The maximum number of ESIE(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. This ETU shares the total
number of stations in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Refer to Chapter 3 System Specifications, Section 4 KSU
Power-Based Calculator Chart for Universal Slots.
6.4.3
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J
EXCN1
Connects to EXCN1 on the ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU.
EXCN2
Connects to EXCN2 on the ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU.
MJ1
Connects to MDF RJ-61 (four ESI ports 1~4).
MJ2
Connects to MDF RJ-61 (four ESI ports 5~8).
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 71
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.4.4
Connections
BK
RD
To
MDF
GN
To Telephone
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-38 ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU Connection
6.4.5
Pin Assignments
The pin assignments are for connecting eight Multiline Terminals to
the ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU. Refer to Table 6-24 ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU MJ1
Pin Assignments and Table 6-25 ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU MJ2 Pin
Assignments.
Table 6-24 ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU MJ1 Pin Assignments
MJ1
Pin
(RJ-61)
Signal
Signal Name
Pin Color
1
T4
CH3–Tip
WHT–BRN
2
T3
CH2–Tip
WHT–GRN
3
T2
CH1–Tip
WHT–ORN
4
R1
CH0–Ring
BLU–WHT
5
T1
CH0–Tip
WHT–BLU
6
R2
CH1–Ring
ORN–WHT
7
R3
CH2–Ring
GRN–WHT
8
R4
CH3–Ring
BRN–WHT
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 72
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-25 ESIE(8)-U( ) ETU MJ2 Pin Assignments
MJ2
Pin
(RJ-61)
Signal
Signal Name
Pin Color
1
T8
CH7–Tip
WHT–BRN
2
T7
CH6–Tip
WHT–GRN
3
T6
CH5–Tip
WHT–ORN
4
R5
CH4–Ring
BLU–WHT
5
T5
CH4–Tip
WHT–BLU
6
R6
CH5–Ring
ORN–WHT
7
R7
CH6–Ring
GRN–WHT
8
R8
CH7–Ring
BRN–WHT
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 73
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.5
ESIE(8)-U20 ETU
6.5.1
Description
The ESIE(8)-U20 ETU is the expansion Electronic Station Interface
ETU that provides an additional 8-channel interface for Multiline
Terminals, Attendant Consoles, or the Single Line Telephone
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP (Adapter). This expansion ESI ETU is
piggybacked on the ESIB(8)-U( ) ETU for up to 16 channel support.
When an ESIE(8)-U20 is installed on the ESIB(8)-U20 ETU, a
second (B2) channel is available for such devices as the AP(R)-R
Unit or the PGD(2)-U10 ADP (adapter).
Figure 6-39 ESIE(8)-U20
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 74
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.5.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of three ESIE(8)-U20 ETUs, piggybacked on an
ESIB(8)-U20 ETU, can be installed in slots S1~S8. The system is
limited by 64 trunk and station ports combined.
The maximum number of ESIE(8)-U20 ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station ETUs installed. This ETU shares the total
number of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 15 ESIE(8)-U20 ETUs, piggybacked on an
ESIB(8)-U20 ETU, can be installed in slots S1~S8. The system is
limited by 256 stations.
The maximum number of ESIE(8)-U20 ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station ETUs installed. This ETU shares the total
number of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Refer to Chapter 3 System Specifications, Section 4 KSU
Power-Based Calculator Chart for Universal Slots.
6.5.3
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J
EXCN1
Connects to EXCN1 on the ESIB(8)-U20 ETU.
EXCN2
Connects to EXCN2 on the ESIB(8)-U20 ETU.
MJ1
Connects to MDF RJ-61 (ESI ports 1~4).
MJ2
Connects to MDF RJ-61 (ESI ports 5~8).
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 75
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.5.4
Connections
BK
RD
GN
To Telephone
To
MDF
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-40 ESIE(8)-U20 Connection
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 76
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.6
OPX(2)-U( ) ETU
6.6.1
Description
The OPX(2)-U( ) ETU is the interface for two off-premise extensions.
This ETU has a built-in ringing signal generator (RSG). A maximum
of 1600 Ω of loop resistance (including the Single Line Telephone) is
acceptable between the OPX(2)-U( ) ETU and a Single Line
Telephone.
This ETU also provides circuitry for loop status detection, talk
battery, sending ringing signals from the RSG unit to the Single Line
Telephones, and dial pulse detection.
Figure 6-41 OPX(2)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 77
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.6.2
Installation
The extension can be run up to approximately three miles (5 km)
using 24 AWG wiring.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of six OPX(2)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8.
The maximum number of OPX(2)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined. This ETU shares the total number
of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed. When 2-port trunk interface
ETUs are installed the system uses four ports from its maximum port
capacity.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 22 OPX(2)-U ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of OPX(2)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by
256 stations. This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the
system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed. When 2-port trunk interface
ETUs are installed the system uses four ports from its maximum port
capacity.
6.6.3
LED Indications
Live LED indications are listed below.
J
J
J
Blinking Red Normal Operation
Steady Red
Operation Stopped (power On).
Off
No Power
LED1 indications are listed below.
J
J
Steady Red
One port busy
Off
All ports idle
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 78
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.6.4
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
6.6.5
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
Connections
BK
RD
To
MDF
GN
Single Line
Telephone
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-42 OPX(2)-U( ) ETU CN1 Connection
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 79
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.7
SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
6.7.1
Description
SLI(4)-U( ) ETU
The Single Line Interface ETU supports a maximum of four Single
Line Telephones and/or analog voice mail ports. This ETU provides
Ringing Signal Generator (RSG), and Message Waiting (MW) LED
voltage to Single Line Telephones.
SLI(8)-U( ) ETU
The Single Line Interface ETU supports a maximum of eight Single
Line Telephones and/or voice mail ports. This ETU provides Ringing
Signal Generator (RSG), and Message Waiting (MW) LED voltage to
Single Line Telephones.
Figure 6-43 SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 80
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.7.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 12 SLI(4)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
A maximum of six SLI(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined. This ETU shares the total number
of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 22 SLI(4)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
A maximum of 22 SLI(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by
256 stations. This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the
system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
6.7.3
LED Indications
Live LED indications are listed below.
J
J
J
Blinking Red Normal Operation
Steady Red
Operation Stopped (power On).
Off
No Power
BUSY indications are listed below.
J
J
6.7.4
Steady Red
Some port(s) busy
Off
All ports idle
Connectors
The following connector is included:
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 81
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.7.5
Connections
BK
RD
GN
Single Line
Telephone
To
MDF
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-44 SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 82
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.8
SLIB(4)-U10 ETU
6.8.1
Description
The SLIB(4)-U10 ETU is the basic Single Line Interface ETU that
provides a 4-channel interface for a Single Line Telephone, and also
provides Ringing Signal Generator (RSG), Message Waiting (MW)
LED voltage, and Caller ID to Single Line Telephones.
This ETU can be expanded to eight channels by installing the
SLIE(4)-U10 ETU.
Figure 6-45 SLIB(4)-U10 ETU
6.8.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 12 SLIB(4)-U10 ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 83
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
The maximum number of SLIB(4)-U10 ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined. This ETU shares the total number
of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 22 SLIB(4)-U10 ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8
in any KSU.
The maximum number of SLIB(4)-U10 ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by
256 stations of which eight would be ESI ports. This ETU shares the
total number of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
6.8.3
When initially installing the SLIB(4)-U10 ETU, it may be necessary to
press the RESET switch for the ETU to boot up properly.
Switch Settings
Table 6-26 SLIB(4)-U10 ETU SW2 Switch Settings
Switch
Setting
Purpose
ON
4 Channels (Default)
OFF
8 Channels
1
ON
2
OFF
ON
SW2
See Table below for SW2-2 and
SW2-3 details
3
OFF
ON
SLI(4)/(8) -U10 Mode
(Caller-ID Disable) (Default)
OFF
SLIB/SLIE(4)-U( ) Mode
(Caller-ID Enable)
4
For the SLIB/E firmware to be recognized in the CPUII after
upgrade, SW2-4 must be ON and the ETU must be reset for
PGR 90-34-01 to recognize the new version.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 84
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-27 SW2-2/SW2-3 Details
SW 2-2
SW 2-3
Function
ON
ON
Factory Test
OFF
ON
Firmware Upgrade
ON
OFF
Not Used
OFF
OFF
Normal Operation
(Default)
Table 6-28 SLIB(4)-U10 ETU SW3 Switch Settings
SW 3-1
SW 3-2
SW 3-3
SW 3-4
ON
ON
ON
ON
North America (Default)
ON
OFF
OFF
ON
Multiple SLT Devices (One
Single Line Telephone and
one External Loud Ringer)
6.8.4
Country Selection
Firmware Version 1.72 or higher is required for the Multiple SLT
Devices setting.
LED Indications
LED 1 (LIVE) indications are:
J
J
J
Flashing Red Normal Operation
Steady Red
Operation Stopped (Power On).
Off
No Power
LED 2 (BUSY) indications are:
J
J
Steady Red
Some ports busy
Off
All ports idle
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 85
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.8.5
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
6.8.6
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN4
Connects to CN4 on the SLIE(4)-U( ) ETU.
CN5
Connects to CN5 on the SLIE(4)-U( ) ETU.
Connections
BK
RD
GN
Single Line
Telephone
To
MDF
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-46 SLIB(4)-U10 ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 86
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.9
SLIE(4)-U10 ETU
6.9.1
Description
The SLIE(4)-U10 ETU is the expansion Single Line Interface ETU
That plugs into the SLIB(4)-U10 ETU to provide an additional
4-channel interface for a Single Line Telephone, and also provides
Ringing Signal Generator (RSG) and Message Waiting (MW) LED
voltage to Single Line Telephones.
Figure 6-47 SLIE(4)-U10 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 87
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.9.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of six SLIB(4)-U10 ETUs with the SLIE(4)-U10 ETU
installed can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The maximum number of SLIB(4)-U10 ETUs with the SLIE(4)-U10
ETU installed depends on other station cards installed. The system
is limited by 64 trunk and station ports combined. This ETU shares
the total number of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 22 SLIB(4)-U10 ETUs with the SLIE(4)-U10 ETU
installed can be installed in slots S1~S8 in any KSU.
The maximum number of SLIB(4)-U10 ETUs with the SLIE(4)-U10
ETU installed depends on other station cards installed. The system
is limited by 256 stations. This ETU shares the total number of
station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
6.9.3
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
CN4
Connects to CN4 on the SLIB(4)-U( ) ETU.
CN5
Connects to CN5 on the SLIB(4)-U( ) ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 88
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.9.4
Connections
BK
RD
GN
Single Line
Telephone
To
MDF
YL
RJ-11
Figure 6-48 SLIB(4)-U10 ETU Connections
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 89
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 7
VOICE MAIL ETUS
7.1
CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETUCMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU
7.1.1
Description
This CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETUDigital Voice Mail system supports a
maximum of four ports.
This ETU is a PC platform installed in the Electra Elite IPK II that
contains Flash ROM data storage for voice recording and application
software. A digital signal processor/voice processing section
handles the following functions:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
DTMF detection
DTMF generation
General tone detection
FAX CNG tone detection
PCM compression for audio recording/playback
Automatic gain control (AGC)
A serial port (direct connect speeds up to 19.2 Kbps)
This ETU provides two or four ports for digital voice mail. Refer to
Table 6-29 Configuration Support Table.
Table 6-29 Configuration Support Table
Function
Configuration Support
Applications
Automated Attendant/Voice Mail with call
forwarding (release transfer)
Automated Attendant/Voice Mail without call
forwarding (await answer transfer)
Voice Mail only (No transfer)
Call Forwarding
Supported
Connections
Connects to backplane connector of the KSU.
Hardware
One CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU
Message Notification
Through message waiting lamp.
Operator Console
100 (default)
Positive disconnect: Digital Signal
MDM-F-20 Unit
Used for remote connection.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 90
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
COM1
Figure 6-49 CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 91
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-50 CMS-U30 ETU
7.1.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
Only one CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU or one CMS-U30 ETU can be
installed in slots S1~S8.
Expanded Port Package
Only one CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU or one CMS-U30 ETU can be
installed in slots S1~S8.
Each system can support only one CMS, CTI/VP, CTP, FMS, VMS,
or VMP ETU.
When installing this ETU, make all ETU DIP switch setting
changes before inserting it in the KSU. Ensure that KSU
is off.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 92
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.1.3
Switch Settings
For Revision Q00431 v 6.68 or higher, refer to Table 6-30 CMS(2)/
(4)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Functions.
Table 6-30 CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Functions
DIP
1
DIP
2
DIP
3
DIP
4
ON
ON
To enable HostKey and run Manufacturing
Test (NEC Production only)
ON
To enable HostKey with floppy disk redirection
and run Manufacturing Test (NEC Production
only)
ON
ON
ON
Description
To connect to CoSession using modem
instead of direct cable connection
ON
To start BRU Host with direct cable connection
ON
To start BRU Host with modem connection
ON
To connect to CoSession using direct cable
connection but not start voice mail software
(Troubleshooting or Maintenance Mode)
Used for Revision Q00431 v 6.68 or higher.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 93
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.1.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-31 CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indicators.
Table 6-31 CMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indicators
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LIVE
ETU status
Receiving
Power
Not Used
No Power
CH1
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH2
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH3
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH4
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
MB
MB Switch Status
ON
Not Used
OFF
BIOS Error
Not Used
No error
Red: DOS
started
(VM Not
Ready)
Not Used
Idle
BIOS
DOS Status
BCLR
Application Status
Green: VM
Running
Orange: Error
HD
If BCLR LED is orange, check error type on console screen.
After error is corrected, LED automatically changes to green.
Do Not connect link between console and ETU until BCLR turns
green during booting.
Flash Status
Not Used
Compact
Flash Disk
Active
Flash
Inactive
Do not reset the ETU while the HD LED is flashing.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 94
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-32 CMS-U30 ETU LED Indications
LED
Name
Description
LED 1
APP1
Indicates status of voice mail application software
Green Application running without errors
Amber Application running with errors
Red
Application not running
LED 2
APP 2
Not Used
LED 3
Drive
HDD active light is red when the hard drive is accessed
Do not reset the ETU while this switch is on.
LED 4
CF Power
On when SHUTDOWN switch in Run to indicate power on the
ETU
LED 5
ICGA
Live LED flashes every 125 ms during normal operation
LED 6
SHUTDOWN
Switch
Indicates that the switch has no software control.
On red only when SHUTDOWN switch is in Run
LED 7
Shutdown
On red when Switch S3 is in SHUTDOWN to indicate that
voice mail can be safely removed form the KSU
LED 8
Power
On red when ETU is receiving power from the KSU
LED 9
FED DSP
Used only for development purposes
LED 10
CH 1
On red when voice channel 1 is Off-Hook
LED 11
CH 2
On red when voice channel 2 is Off-Hook
LED 12
CH 3
On red when voice channel 3 is Off-Hook
LED 13
CH 4
On red when voice channel 4 is Off-Hook
LED 14
CH 5
On red when voice channel 5 is Off-Hook
LED 15
CH 6
On red when voice channel 6 is Off-Hook
LED 16
CH 7
On red when voice channel 7 is Off-Hook
LED 17
CH 8
On red when voice channel 8 is Off-Hook
The first four channel LEDs are also used during startup to show that the
BICOM driver is loaded (LED 1), Scan disk successfully completed (LED 2),
CoSession Host successfully Loaded (LED 3), and voice mail started
successfully (LED 4). After the system is up and running and all channels are
ready to receive calls, these LEDs are Off. When voice mail does not start
successfully, all eight channel LEDs and LED 1 are On.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 95
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.1.5
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J2 and J3
Used to install the MDM-F-20 Unit.
J
J9
Connects to the backplane.
J
9-pin RS-232 (COM2)
Connector is not used (MDM-F-20 Unit).
J
RJ-11 modem port (COM2)
Remote connector on serial interface (MDM-F-20 Unit).
J
9-pin RS-232 (COM1)
Local serial connector on main ETU for direct connection.
7.1.6
Jumper Settings
J1
7.1.7
Used only on FMS/CMS
Pin 1 to Pin 2
No external modem connected (default)
Pin 2 to Pin 3
External modem connected
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J
J
J2
Connects to the backplane.
J6
Used for Compact flash drive on FMS.
J10
Not used.
J11)
COM port for console programming connection
J12
Port expansion connector for DSP-U30
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 96
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.2
CTI/VP(4)/(8)/(12)/(16)-U( ) ETU
7.2.1
Description
The CTI/VP(4)/(8)/(12)/(16)-U( ) ETU is a 4-, 8-, 12-, or 16-port
Digital Voice Mail system that can support TeLANophy, inbound or
outbound faxing and Hospitality/HVM applications.
The EliteMail VP cannot support TeLANophy or faxing and
Hospitality/HVM applications, but it can be upgraded to EliteMail CTI
when these features are required.
For a 4- or 8-port system, only the System Board and one slot are
required. For the 12- or 16-port system, the Daughter Board that
attaches to the System board, and the Port Expansion Board that
requires another slot are also required.
This ETU is a PC platform, installed in the Electra Elite IPK II system,
that contains hard disk space for voice recording storage and
application software. A digital signal processor/voice processing
section handles the following functions:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
DTMF detection/generation
General tone detection
FAX CNG tone detection
PCM compression for audio recording/playback
Automatic gain control
A serial port (direct connect speeds up to 115,200 bps) used
for direct connection console programming and backup/restore
A LAN port with an RJ-45 connector (activated only with CTI)
Up to two fax ports (activated only with CTI)
A built-in modem for remote console programming that
supports up to 19.2 Kbps
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 97
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-33 Configuration Support
Function
Support
Applications
Automated Attendant/Voice Mail with call
forwarding (release transfer)
Automated Attendant/Voice Mail without call
forwarding (await answer transfer)
Voice Mail only (no transfer)
Call Forwarding
Supported
Connections
KSU backplane connection
RJ-45 LAN connection
RJ-11 Modem connection
VGA connection for monitor support
PS2 Keyboard and Mouse connections
Hardware
One CTI/VP(4)/(8)/(12)/(16)-U( ) ETU
Message Notification
Uses message waiting lamp
Operator Console
100 (default)
Positive connect: Digital signal
A
B
C
R
Q
P
O
N
M
L
K
J
I
H
G
F
E
D
Figure 6-51 EliteMail CTI System Board
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 98
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.2.1.1
System Board Components
The components identified in Figure 6-51 EliteMail CTI
System Board are listed and described in Table 6-34
System Board Components.
Table 6-34 System Board Components
Item
Description
A
Backplane connector
B
Switch SW2
Not used. Keep indicated default settings.
C
Switch SW1
Not used. Keep indicated default settings.
D
Port Expansion Board (PEB) cable
E
Modem connector
F
Hard Drive (HD) LED
G
Universal Serial Bus (USB) connector
H
Local Area Network (LAN) connector
I
Keyboard connector
J
Mouse connector
K
COM Serial Port connector
L
VGA Monitor connector
M
Switch SW3
DIP switch 1 default is Off so the voice messaging
application starts when the board is turned On. Set
this switch On to start OS/2 software only.
DIP switch 2 default is Off for direct serial remote
access connections. Set this switch On for modem
connections.
DIP switches 3 and 4 are not used and should be left
On.
N
The power button cuts the power to the board from
the PC and the hard drive and should not be used.
O
Voice messaging software LED
Green when software is active
Amber when active with possible application problem
Red when inactive or shut down
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 99
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-34 System Board Components (Continued)
Item
Description
P
Shutdown switch
Default is On. Place Off to shut down the software
and system board properly before turning off the
telephone system and disconnecting the system
board.
Place On before restarting – The board restarts only
when the switch is On.
Q
Shutdown LED
Red when switch is On.
Green when switch is Off.
After the LED goes off, turn off power to the KSU and
disconnect the board.
R
Make Busy switch and LED
Do not use. Must always be On with a red LED.
A
B
C
D
F
H
J
E
G
I
K
L
M
Figure 6-52 EliteMail CTI Daughter Board
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 100
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.2.1.2
Daughter Board Components
The components identified in Figure 6-53 EliteMail CTI
Port Expansion Board are listed and described inTable
6-35 Daughter Board Components.
Table 6-35 Daughter Board Components
Item
Description
A
F206 LED
B
CGA LED
C
Application LED
D~K
VM Channel LEDs 1~8 respectively
L, M
Fax Channel LEDs Channel 1, Channel 2
A
B
C
D
E
F
H
J
L
G
I
K
M
Figure 6-53 EliteMail CTI Port Expansion Board
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 101
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.2.1.3
Port Expansion Board
The components identified in Figure 6-53 EliteMail CTI
Port Expansion Board are listed and described in Table
6-36 Port Expansion Board Components.
Table 6-36 Port Expansion Board Components
Item
A
Backplane connector
B
MB LED – Always On when board is installed
C
MB switch – Do not use, leave On
D
F206 LED
E
CGA Live LED
F~M
7.2.2
Description
VM Channels 9~16, respectively
Installation
Basic Port Package
Only one CTI/VP(4)/(8)/(12)/(16)-U( ) ETU can be installed in a
system.
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system.
Expanded Port Package
Only one CTI/VP(4)/(8)/(12)/(16)-U( ) ETU can be installed in a
system.
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system.
Each system can support only one CMS, CTI/VP, CTP, FMS, VMS,
or VMP ETU.
When installing this ETU, make all ETU DIP switch setting
changes before inserting it in the KSU. Ensure that KSU
is off.
7.2.3
LED Indications
The HD LED flashes red when the hard drive is active.
Do not reset the ETU when the HD LED is flashing.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 102
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.3
CTP( )-U10 ETU
7.3.1
Description
This ETU is a multiplatform system that supports a maximum of 16
ports.
This ETU is a PC platform installed in the Electra Elite IPK II that
contains data storage for voice recording and application software.
A digital signal processor/voice processing section handles the
following functions:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
7.3.2
DTMF detection
DTMF generation
General tone detection
FAX CNG tone detection
PCM compression for audio recording/playback
Automatic gain control (AGC)
Two USB 1.0 ports for USB Keyboard and Mouse support
One 15-pin VGA connector for VGA monitor support
Checklist of Components
This section describes the steps for assembling a CTP( )-U10 ETU.
Confirm that you have all of the components for the installation. If
you did not receive all the components, call your sales
representative.
J
J
J
J
CTP( )-U10 ETU
Memory SO-DIMM 256M
DSPII-U10 Unit, two for 12- or 16-port installations
Drive
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 103
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-54 CTP( )-U10 ETU (Front View)
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 104
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-55 CTP( )-U10 ETU (Back View)
7.3.3
Installation
Basic Port Package
Only one CTP( )-U10 ETU can be installed in slots S1~S8.
Each system can support only one CMS, CTI/VP, CTP, FMS, VMS,
or VMP ETU.
Expanded Port Package
Only one CTP( )-U10 ETU can be installed in slots S1~S8.
Each system can support only one CMS, CTI/VP, CTP, FMS, VMS,
or VMP ETU.
This unit makes extensive use of CMOS technology that is very
susceptible to static; therefore, extreme care must be taken to avoid
static discharge when handling.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 105
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Handle the drive and DSP carefully! Do not drop the
drive or apply pressure to it. Do not touch the printed
circuit board unnecessarily. Doing so can make it
inoperable.
7.3.4
A 4-port CTP( )-U10 ETU must be programmed as an 8-port
CTP( )-U10 ETU. Ports 5~8 should not be assigned extension
numbers or included in the hunt group.
A 12-port CTP( )-U10 ETU must be programmed as a 16-port
CTP-U10 ETU. Ports 13~16 should not be assigned extension
numbers or included in the hunt group.
Installing Drive on CTP( )-U10 ETU
1.
Before installing the drive, make sure the four screws are
started, as shown in Figure 6-56 Before Installing the Drive.
They should not be tightened down all the way, as this prevents
mounting the drive on the ETU.
Figure 6-56 Before Installing the Drive
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 106
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Line up the four screws with the four slots in the drive mounting
bracket, then lower the drive into the bracket. Make sure all
four screws are seated in the bracket. Refer to Figure 6-57 Line
up Four Screws.
Figure 6-57 Line up Four Screws
3.
Slide the drive toward the connector, making sure all the pins
line up with the connector. Push until it is firmly seated in the
connector. There should be no exposed pins. Refer to
Figure 6-58 Slide Drive Toward Connector.
Figure 6-58 Slide Drive Toward Connector
4.
Carefully tighten the four screws.
5.
The ETU is now ready to be installed in the KSU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 107
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.3.5
Removing the Drive
1.
Loosen the four screws that hold the drive in place. Refer to
Figure 6-59 Loosen the Four Screws.
Figure 6-59 Loosen the Four Screws
2.
After the four screws are loosened, push the drive towards the
back plane connector until it is unplugged from the drive
connector. Refer to Figure 6-60 Push Drive Toward Backplane.
Figure 6-60 Push Drive Toward Backplane
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 108
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Carefully lift the drive up to remove it from the ETU. You can
now access the DSP Module slots. Refer to Figure 6-61 Lift up
and Remove Drive from ETU.
Figure 6-61 Lift up and Remove Drive from ETU
7.3.6
Installing DSPs on the CTP( )-U10 ETU
Slot DSP Module 1 is always used so 4-port and 8-port configurations
have a DSP8-U10 in this slot only. Slot DSP Module 2 is used only
for 12-port and 16-port configurations.
1.
Wear a grounding strap while handling the CTP( )-U10 ETU
and DSP, and lay both on a flat workspace.
2.
The DSPs are installed under the drive, so the drive must be
removed first. Refer to section 7.3.5 Removing the Drive for
instructions on removing the drive.
3.
Start by inserting the end with the brass connectors into the
DSP Module 1 slot first. Refer to Figure 6-62 Insert Brass
Connector End.
Figure 6-62 Insert Brass Connector End
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 109
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Push the other end down until the locks on both sides click to
hold it in place. Refer to Figure 6-63 Push Other End Down
Until it Locks
Repeat steps 2 and 3, using the slot labeled DSP Module 2, to
install another DSP. Otherwise, you are now ready to install the
drive.
Figure 6-63 Push Other End Down Until it Locks
7.3.7
Installing and Removing the CTP( )-U10 ETU
A 4-port CTP( )-U10 ETU must be programmed as an 8-port
CTP-U10 ETU. Ports 5~8 should not be assigned extension numbers
or included in the hunt group.
A 12-port CTP( )-U10 ETU must be programmed as a 16-port
CTP-U10 ETU. Ports 13~16 should not be assigned extension
numbers or included in the hunt group.
1.
Make sure the KSU power is off.
2.
Install the ETU in the KSU.
3.
Turn ON the KSU system power.
4.
Wait for the APP1 LED to turn green.
5.
Verify that all ports answer.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 110
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.
To shut down the voice mail, press the SHUTDOWN Switch
S3, and wait for the Shutdown LED to light green.
7.3.8
It may take several minutes for the voice mail to shutdown.
7.
Turn OFF the KSU power, and remove the ETU from the KSU.
8.
Make sure to transport the ETU in the original packaging.
Switch Settings
For switch setting information, refer to documentation for the Specific
application.
7.3.9
LED Indications
For LED indication information, refer to documentation for the
Specific application.
7.3.10
Connectors
The CTP( )-U10 ETU has the following connectors:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
USB
Connectors for USB mouse and Keyboard
DIMM1
Slot for SO-DIMM memory
Compact Flash
Flash drive slot
Hard Drive
Connection for drive media
LAN
RJ-45 LAN connector for network connection
DSP Module 1
Port expansion connector for first DSP8-U10; this slot should
be used for 4-and 8-port configurations.
DSP Module 2
Port expansion connector for second DSP8-U10; this slot
should be used when adding a second DSP8-U10 for 12-and
16-port configurations.
VGA
Connector for VGA type video monitor
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 111
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.4
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)- U( ) ETU
7.4.1
Description
The FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU is a Digital Voice Mail system that
supports a maximum of eight ports.
This ETU is a PC platform installed in the Electra Elite IPK II that
contains Flash ROM data storage for voice recording and application
software. A digital signal processor/voice processing section
handles the following functions:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
DTMF detection
DTMF generation
General tone detection
FAX CNG tone detection
PCM compression for audio recording/playback
Automatic gain control (AGC)
A serial port (direct connect speeds up to 19.2 Kbps)
This ETU provides 2-, 4-, or 8-ports for digital voice mail. Refer to
Table 6-37 Configuration Support Table.
Table 6-37 Configuration Support Table
Function
Configuration Support
Applications
Automated Attendant/Voice Mail with call
forwarding (release transfer)
Automated Attendant/Voice Mail without call
forwarding (await answer transfer)
Voice Mail only (No transfer)
Call Forwarding
Supported
Connections
Connects to backplane connector of the KSU.
Hardware
One FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
Message Notification
Through message waiting lamp
Operator Console
100 (default)
Positive disconnect: Digital Signal
MDM-F-20 Unit
Used for remote connection.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 112
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
COM1
Figure 6-64 FMS(2)/(4)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 113
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-65 FMS(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 114
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-66 FMS-U30 ETU
7.4.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
Only one FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU or one FMS-U30 can be installed
in slots S1~S8.
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system.
Expanded Port Package
Only one FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU or one FMS-U30 can be installed
in slots S1~S8.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 115
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system.
Each system can support only one CMS, CTI/VP, CTP, FMS, VMS,
or VMP ETU.
When installing this ETU, make all ETU DIP switch setting
changes before inserting it in the KSU. Ensure that KSU
is off.
7.4.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-38 FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Switch Settings, for
Revision Q26031 v 6.65 or lower. For Revision Q26031 v 6.68 or
higher, refer to Table 6-39 FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch
Functions.
Table 6-38 FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Switch Settings
Switch
Description
1
Normally Off.
(On to enable COM1.)
2
Normally Off.
When 1 and 2 are both On, COM1 is enabled for
HOSTKEY and the VM application is stopped for
Maintenance.
3
On to enable COM2 for remote RS-232/RJ-11.
Off to allow COM1 local connection.
4
Not Used.
Used for Revision Q26031 v 6.65 or lower.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 116
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-39 FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Functions
DIP
1
DIP
2
DIP
3
DIP
4
ON
ON
To enable HostKey and run Manufacturing
Test (NEC Production only).
ON
To enable HostKey with floppy disk redirection
and run Manufacturing Test (NEC Production
only).
ON
ON
ON
7.4.4
Description
To connect to CoSession using modem
instead of direct cable connection.
ON
To start BRU Host with direct cable
connection.
ON
To start BRU Host with modem connection.
ON
To connect to CoSession using direct cable
connection but not start voice mail software
(Troubleshooting or Maintenance Mode).
Used for Revision Q05631 v 6.68 or higher.
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-40 FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-40 FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LIVE
ETU status
Receiving
Power
Not Used
No Power
CH1
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH2
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH3
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH4
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH5
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH6
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 117
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-40 FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications (Continued)
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
CH7
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
CH8
Port Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not
Used
MB
MB Switch Status
ON
Not Used
OFF
BIOS Error
Not Used
No error
Red: DOS
started
(VM Not
Ready)
Not Used
Idle
BIOS
DOS Status
BCLR
Application Status
Green: VM
Running
Orange: Error
HD
When BCLR LED is orange, check error type on console
screen. After error is corrected, LED automatically changes to
green. Do Not connect link between console and ETU until
BCLR turns green during booting.
Flash Status
Not Used
Compact
Flash Disk
Active
Flash
Inactive
Do not reset the ETU while the HD LED is flashing.
Table 6-41 FMS-U30 ETU LED Indications
LED
Name
Description
LED 1
APP1
Indicates status of voice mail application software:
Green: Application running without errors.
Amber: Application running with errors.
Red:
Application not running.
LED 2
APP 2
Not Used
LED 3
Drive
HDD active light is red when the hard drive is
accessed.
LED 4
CF Power
Do not reset the ETU while this switch is
on.
On when SHUTDOWN switch is in RUN to indicate
power on the ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 118
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-41 FMS-U30 ETU LED Indications (Continued)
LED
Name
Description
LED 5
ICGA
Live LED flashes every 125 ms during normal
operation.
LED 6
SHUTDOWN
Switch
Indicates that the switch has no software control.
On red only when SHUTDOWN switch is in RUN.
LED 7
Shutdown
On red when Switch S3 is in SHUTDOWN to
indicate that voice mail can be safely removed form
the KSU.
LED 8
Power
On red when ETU is receiving power from the KSU.
LED 9
FED DSP
Used only for development purposes.
LED 10
CH 1
On red when voice channel 1 is Off Hook.
LED 11
CH 2
On red when voice channel 2 is Off Hook.
LED 12
CH 3
On red when voice channel 3 is Off Hook.
LED 13
CH 4
On red when voice channel 4 is Off Hook.
LED 14
CH 5
On red when voice channel 5 is Off Hook.
LED 15
CH 6
On red when voice channel 6 is Off Hook.
LED 16
CH 7
On red when voice channel 7 is Off Hook.
LED 17
CH 8
On red when voice channel 8 is Off Hook.
The first four channel LEDs are also used during startup to show that
the BICOM driver is loaded (LED 1), Scan disk successfully completed (LED 2), CoSession Host successfully Loaded (LED 3), and
voice mail started successfully (LED 4). After the system is up and
running and all channels are ready to receive calls, these LEDs are
Off. When voice mail does not start successfully, all eight
channel LEDs and LED 1 are On.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 119
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.4.5
FMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J2 and J3
Used to install the MDM-F-20 Unit.
J
J9
Connects to the backplane.
J
9-pin RS-232 (COM2)
Not used (MDM-F-20 Unit).
J
RJ-11 modem port (COM2)
Remote connector on serial interface (MDM-F-20 Unit)
J
9-pin RS-232(COM1)
Local serial connector on main ETU for direct connection
7.4.6
FMS-U30 ETU Jumper Settings
J1
7.4.7
Used only on FMS/CMS
Pin 1 to Pin 2
No external modem connected (default)
Pin 2 to Pin 3
External modem connected
FMS-U30 ETU Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J
J2
Connects to the backplane.
J6
Used for Compact flash drive on FMS.
J11
COM port for console programming connection
J12
Port expansion connector for DSP-U30
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 120
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.5
VMP( )-U40 ETU
7.5.1
Description
This ETU is a PC-platform that contains disk space for voice
recording storage and application software. It can be configured as
a 2-port, 4-port, or 8-port interface.
The 2- or 4-port interface includes one digital signal processor
(DSP); a DSP-U30 Unit must be installed for the 8-port interface.
During a CPU Power On, after the CPU is online, insert the VMP
ETU, wait five seconds, and then set switch SW3 to RUN.
Major features include:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
A faster running 486-based processor allows quicker boot and
faster operation.
CoSession direct connection speed of 57,000 baud is
supported as the only direct connection speed for all U40
ETUs.
Port upgrades are performed by replacing the Compact Flash
drive with another drive with the needed port configuration.
All ETUs have a built-in modem for remote console
programming. An external modem and single-line port can
also be used for remote programming. The internal modem is
accessed from the automated attendant by dialing the modem
extension ID that is only an ID used by voice mail, not an
extension on the telephone system.
The voice mail application efficiently shuts down after active
calls are completed, and the ETU turns off when the shutdown
switch is placed in SHUTDOWN (Q51231 or higher database is
required).
The system manager can select a special language for a
particular subscriber at the console, and the subscriber hears
the language when login is complete. The default language
must be the system default language (Q51231 or higher
database is required).
A database entity, the Language Selection Box, allows outside
callers to choose a language. Each database entity (e.g.,
personal message box) also has the selected language
associated with it (Q51231 or higher database is required).
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 121
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-67 VMP( )-U40 ETU
7.5.2
Installation
The VMP(2)-U40 ETU has two channels of built-in Voice Mail.
The VMP(4)-U40 ETU has four channels of built-in Voice Mail.
The VMP(8)-U40 ETU has eight channels of built-in Voice Mail.
Only one VMP(2)/(4)/(8)-U40 ETU can be installed in any interface
slot in the Basic or Expanded Port Package of the Electra Elite IPK II
system.
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system.
When installing this ETU, make all ETU DIP switch setting
changes before inserting it in the KSU. Ensure that the
KSU is Off.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 122
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.5.3
Installing Flash Drive on the VMP( )-U40 ETU
Use the following instructions to install the Flash Drive.
1.
Remove the VMP( )-U40 ETU and selected Flash Drive from
the box.
2.
Locate slot CN6 on VMP( )-U40 ETU.
3.
The side with the SanDisk name in large red letters should be
facing up, as shown in Figure 6-68 Installing the Flash Drive on
the VMP( )-U40 ETU.
Figure 6-68 Installing the Flash Drive on the VMP( )-U40 ETU
The Flash Drive goes in only one way, and does not take much
force to insert it.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 123
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Push the drive in until it is fully seated, as shown in Figure 6-69
Flash Drive Seated on VMP( )-U40 ETU.
Figure 6-69 Flash Drive Seated on VMP( )-U40 ETU
5.
Ensure that jumper J1 is set across pins 1 and 2.
6.
Ensure that jumper J7 is set across pins 1 and 2.
7.
Insert Sony battery CR-2032 into BATT1 connector with the +
sign facing up as shown in Figure 6-69 Flash Drive Seated on
VMP( )-U40 ETU on page 6-124. When an eight port ETU is
used go to 7.5.5 Installing DSP( )-U30 on VMP( )-U40 ETU on
page 6-129, otherwise your voice mail ETU is ready for
installation.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 124
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.5.4
Installing Hard Drive on the VMP( )-U40 ETU
Warning! Handle the hard drive carefully! Do not drop the drive or
apply pressure to it! Do not touch the printed circuit board of the
drive or ETU unnecessarily. Doing so can make a drive inoperable!
This unit makes extensive use of CMOS technology that is very
susceptible to static; therefore, extreme care must be taken to avoid
static discharge when handling.
1.
Before mounting the drive make note of the connection to the
hard drive, notice the four pins to the left of the drive. These
pins are not connected for normal operation. Refer to
Figure 6-70 Connecting the Hard Drive.
Figure 6-70 Connecting the Hard Drive
2.
Check jumper J-7 and make sure it is on pins 2-3. Refer to
Figure 6-71 Plus Sign on Battery Displayed Up.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 125
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Check jumper J-1 and make sure it is on pins 1-2. Refer to
Figure 6-71 Plus Sign on Battery Displayed Up.
4.
Insert Sony battery CR-2032 into BATT1 connector, the + sign
should be facing up as shown in Figure 6-71 Plus Sign on
Battery Displayed Up.
J-1 — make sure
it is set to pins
2-3.
BATT1 Connector
— install battery
with the + facing
up.
J-7 — make sure
it is set to pins 23 for hard drive.
Figure 6-71 Plus Sign on Battery Displayed Up
5.
Insert keyed end of ribbon cable into connector CN8, the keyed
connector only goes into connector CN8 one way and should
not be forced. The red stripe of the cable is towards the bottom
of the ETU as shown in Figure 6-72 Connecting the Ribbon
Cable on page 6-127.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 126
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Notice the four pins to
the left of the drive.
These pins are not
connected for normal
operation.
Red Stripe
Figure 6-72 Connecting the Ribbon Cable
6.
Place hard drive on table with printed circuit board side up and
the pins facing the card as shown in Figure 6-72 Connecting
the Ribbon Cable.
7.
Connect the hard drive to the cable making sure that the four
pins on right side of the drive are not connected as shown in
Figure 6-73 Leaving Four Pins Unconnected.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 127
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Notice the four pins to
the left of the drive.
These pins are not
connected for normal
operation.
Figure 6-73 Leaving Four Pins Unconnected
8.
Carefully place the hard drive on the ETU as shown below in
Figure 6-74 Placing the Hard Drive on the ETU.
Figure 6-74 Placing the Hard Drive on the ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 128
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
9.
Holding the drive so it does not move turn the ETU over and
put the four mounting screws in place as shown in Figure 6-75
Placing the Four Mounting Screws. The screws only need to be
lightly torque down. Tightening the screws too much can
damage the ETU.
Figure 6-75 Placing the Four Mounting Screws
7.5.5
Installing DSP( )-U30 on VMP( )-U40 ETU
For an 8-port VMP( )-U40 ETU, the DSP-U30 must be installed.
Refer to Figure 6-76 Installing the DSP-U30 on the VMP( )-U40 ETU.
1.
Wearing a grounding strap, remove the VMP( )-U40 and
DSP-U30 from the box and lay on a flat work surface.
2.
Locate connector CN12 in the center of the ETU and position
the DSP-U30 over it. Press down firmly on the DSP-U30 unit
until a secure connection is made. Ensure that all the standoffs
are snapped completely.
3.
Place Switch SW3 in RUN.
4.
Install the ETU in the KSU.
5.
Turn ON the KSU system power.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 129
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.
Wait for the APP1 LED to turn green, then connect the support
PC to the VMP(8)-U40 ETU.
7.
Verify that eight ports are shown on the banner screen.
8.
When the unit is to be installed at another location, shutdown
the voice mail application by pressing the ESC key.
9.
Enter Y for yes, and enter the password (default is nec).
10.
From the Utility menu enter x to exit to DOS.
11.
Disconnect from the system.
12.
Place SW3 in SHUTDOWN.
13.
Wait for the shutdown LED to light red.
14.
Turn OFF the KSU power and remove the ETU from the KSU.
15.
Make sure to transport the ETU in the original packaging.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 130
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
DSP-U30
Piggybacked on ETU
Auxiliary DSP
Figure 6-76 Installing the DSP-U30 on the VMP( )-U40 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 131
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.5.6
Switch Settings
Table 6-42 VMP( )-U40 ETU Switch Settings
Reset Power Switch SW1
Used for development only
DIP Switch SW2
1
2
3
4
Enable HostKey and run Manufacturing Test (NEC
Production use only.
ON
ON
Description
Enable HostKey with floppy disk redirection and run
Manufacturing Test (NEC Production use only).
ON
Connect to Cosession using modem instead of direct
cable.
ON
ON
ON
ON
Start BRU host with direct cable connection
ON
Start BRU host with modem connection
ON
Connect to Cosession using direct cable connection,
but do not start voice mail software (for
troubleshooting and maintenance only).
Switch SW3 Positions
Used to identify ETU operation
RUN
LED 6 is on red.
SHUT DOWN
LED 7 is on red.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 132
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.5.7
Jumper Settings
Table 6-43 VMP( )-U40 ETU Jumper Settings
J1
1-2
External modem not connected (default)
2-3
External modem connected
J7
7.5.8
1-2
Compact Flash is master drive
2-3
HDD is master drive (default)
VMP( )-U40 LED Indications
Table 6-44 VMP( )-U40 ETU LED Indications (on back of ETU)
LED No.
Name
On
Flashing
Off
1
AP1
Application
Software
Green (Run no
errors)
Amber (Run
with errors)
Red (Not
running)
Not Used
Not Used
2
AP2
Not Used
Not Used
Not Used
3
DRIVE access
Red for access
Not Used
Not accessed
4
CF POWER
Red
(Receiving
ETU power)
Not Used
No ETU power
5
LIVE
6
SW3 in RUN
Red (don’t
remove ETU)
Not Used
Not in RUN
7
SW3 in
SHUTDOWN
Red (ETU can
be removed)
Not Used
Not
SHUTDOWN
8
Power
Red (ETU
Receiving KSU
power)
Not Used
No KSU power
9
Development
only
Not Used
Not Used
Not Used
10
CH1
Red (Off-Hook)
Not Used
On-Hook
11
CH2
Red (Off-Hook)
Not Used
On-Hook
Not Used
Red every
125ms during
operation
Operation
shutdown
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 133
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-44 VMP( )-U40 ETU LED Indications (on back of ETU)
LED No.
Name
On
Flashing
Off
12
CH3
Red (Off-Hook)
Not Used
On-Hook
13
CH4
Red (Off-Hook)
Not Used
On-Hook
14
CH5
Red (Off-Hook)
Not Used
On-Hook
15
CH6
Red (Off-Hook)
Not Used
On-Hook
16
CH7
Red (Off-Hook)
Not Used
On-Hook
17
CH8
Red (Off-Hook)
Not Used
On-Hook
CH LEDs 1~4 light during startup to indicate:
LED1
BICOM driver loaded.
LED2
Scandisk completed successfully.
LED3
CoSession Host loaded successfully.
LED4
Voice Mail started successfully.
7.5.9
After the system is up and running these LEDs are off, and channels
can receive calls.
When Voice Mail fails to start, all CH LEDs and the AP1 LED are on.
Connectors
Table 6-45 VMP( )-U40 ETU Connectors
Connector
CN2
Backplane connector
CN4
SO-MIDD memory connector
CN6
Compact Flash Connector
CN8
Hard Drive connector
CN9
Ethernet Port
CN11
COM port for console programming connection
CN12
Port expansion connector for DSP-U30 Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 134
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.6
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
7.6.1
Description
The VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU is a 2-, 4-, or 8-port Digital Voice Mail
system.
This ETU is a PC platform installed in the Electra Elite IPK II and
contains hard disk space for voice recording storage and application
software. A digital signal processor/voice processing section handles
the following functions:
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
DTMF detection
DTMF generation
General tone detection
FAX CNG tone detection
PCM compression for audio recording/playback
Automatic gain control (AGC)
A serial port (direct connect speeds up to 19.2 Kbps) to
connect external modem
This ETU provides 2-, 4-, or 8-ports for digital voice mail. The 2- and
4-port require the included digital signal processor (DSP); the 8-port
configuration requires a DSP-F-21 Unit. This ETU provides 2-, 4-, or
8-ports for digital voice mail. The 2- and 4-port require the included
digital signal processor (DSP); the 8-port configuration requires a
DSP-F-21 Unit. Refer to Table 6-46 Configuration Support Table.
Table 6-46 Configuration Support Table
Function
Applications
Configuration Support
Automated Attendant/Voice Mail with call
forwarding (release transfer)
Automated Attendant/Voice Mail without call
forwarding (await answer transfer)
Voice Mail only (No transfer)
Call Forwarding
Connections
Hardware
Message Notification
MDM-F-20 Unit
Supported.
Connects to backplane connector of the KSU.
One VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
Through message waiting lamp
Used for remote connection.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 135
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8-port VMS(8)-U( ) ETU shown
with 4-port auxiliary DSP installed.
For VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU, the
auxiliary is not required.
Option Kit required for remote
maintenance is purchased
separately.
DIP Switch
Up = Off
Down = On
9-pin RS-232
COM 2 Ports
Modem Port RJ-11
Make Busy Switch
COM 1
Local Connection
Figure 6-77 VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 136
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 6-78 VMS-U30 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 137
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.6.2
Installation
The VMS(2)-U10 ETU has two channels of built-in Voice Mail.
The VMS(4)-U10 ETU has four channels of built-in Voice Mail.
The VMS(8)-U10 ETU has eight channels of built-in Voice Mail.
Basic Port Package
Only one VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU or one VMS-U30 ETU can be
installed in each system in slots S1~S8.
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system.
Expanded Port Package
Only one VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU or one VMS-U30 ETU can be
installed in each system in slots S1~S8.
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system.
Each system can support only one CMS, CTI/VP, CTP, FMS, VMS,
or VMP ETU.
When installing this ETU, make all ETU DIP switch setting
changes before inserting it in the KSU. Ensure that the
KSU is off.
7.6.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-47 VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Settings.
(Revision Q30931 v 6.65 or lower). For Revision Q30931 v 6.68 or
higher, refer to Table 6-48 VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch
Functions.
Table 6-47 VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Settings
Switch
Description
1
Normally Off.
(On to enable COM1.)
2
Normally Off.
When 1 and 2 are both On, COM1 is enabled for HOSTKEY
and the VM application is stopped for Maintenance.
3
On to enable COM2 for remote RS-232/RJ-11.
Off to allow COM1 local connection.
4
Not Used.
Used for Revision Q30931 v 6.65 or lower.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 138
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-48 VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU DIP Switch Functions
DIP
1
DIP
2
DIP
3
DIP
4
ON
ON
To enable HostKey and run Manufacturing
Test (NEC Production only).
ON
To enable HostKey with floppy disk redirection
and run Manufacturing Test (NEC Production
only).
ON
ON
ON
Description
To connect to CoSession using modem
instead of direct cable connection.
ON
To start BRU Host with direct cable
connection.
ON
To start BRU Host with modem connection.
ON
To connect to CoSession using direct cable
connection but not start voice mail software
(Troubleshooting or Maintenance Mode).
Used for Revision Q00631 v 6.68 or higher.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 139
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.6.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-49 VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-49 VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
LIVE
ETU status
Receiving
power
Not Used
No Power
CH1
Port status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not used
CH2
Port status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not used
CH3
Port status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not used
CH4
Port status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not used
CH5
Port status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not used
CH6
Port status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not used
CH7
Port status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not used
CH8
Port status
Busy
Not Used
Idle/Not used
MB
MB Switch
status
ON
Not Used
OFF
BIOS
BIOS Error
Status
BIOS Error
Not Used
No error
BCLR
Application
status
Red:
DOS started
(VM not
ready)
Green:
VM running
Orange:
Error
Not Used
Idle
When BCLR LED is orange, check error type on console
screen. After error is corrected, LED automatically changes to
green. Do Not connect link between console and ETU until
BCLR turns green during booting.
HDD
Hard Disk
status
Not Used
Hard Disk
active
Hard Disk
inactive
Do not reset the ETU while the HDD LED is flashing.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 140
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Refer to Table 6-50 VMS-U30 ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-50 VMS-U30 ETU LED Indications
LED
Name
Description
LED 1
APP1
Indicates status of voice mail application software:
Green Application is running without errors.
Amber Application is running with errors.
Red
Application is not running.
LED 2
APP 2
Not Used
LED 3
Drive
HDD active light is red when the hard drive is accessed.
Do not reset the ETU while this switch is On.
LED 4
CF Power
On when SHUTDOWN switch is in RUN to indicate power on
the ETU.
LED 5
ICGA
Live LED flashes every 125 ms during normal operation.
LED 6
SHUTDOWN
Switch
Indicates that the switch has no software control.
On red only when SHUTDOWN switch is in RUN.
LED 7
Shutdown
On red when Switch S3 is in SHUTDOWN to indicate that
voice mail can be safely removed form the KSU.
LED 8
Power
On red when ETU is receiving power from the KSU.
LED 9
FED DSP
Used only for development purposes.
LED 10
CH 1
On red when voice channel 1 is Off-Hook.
LED 11
CH 2
On red when voice channel 2 is Off-Hook.
LED 12
CH 3
On red when voice channel 3 is Off-Hook.
LED 13
CH 4
On red when voice channel 4 is Off-Hook.
LED 14
CH 5
On red when voice channel 5 is Off-Hook.
LED 15
CH 6
On red when voice channel 6 is Off-Hook.
LED 16
CH 7
On red when voice channel 7 is Off-Hook.
LED 17
CH 8
On red when voice channel 8 is Off-Hook.
The first four channel LEDs are also used during startup to show that the
BICOM driver is loaded (LED 1), Scan disk successfully completed (LED 2),
CoSession Host successfully Loaded (LED 3), and voice mail started
successfully (LED 4). After the system is up and running and all channels are
ready to receive calls, these LEDs are Off. When voice mail does not start
successfully, all eight channel LEDs and LED 1 are on.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 141
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.6.5
VMS(2)/(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
J
9-pin RS-232 (COM2)
Not used (MDM-F-20 Unit)
J
RJ-11 modem port (COM2)
Remote connector on serial interface (MDM-F-20 Unit)
J
9-pin RS-23 (COM1)
Local Serial connector on main ETU for direct connection
7.6.6
VMS-U30 ETU Jumper Settings
J7
7.6.7
Used only on VMS
Pin 1 to Pin 2
Compact flash is master drive.
Pin 2 to Pin 3
Hard Drive is master drive (default).
VMS-U30 ETU Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J
J
J2
Connects to the backplane.
J6
Used for Compact flash drive on FMS.
J9
RJ-45 LAN connector for network connection
J11
COM port for console programming connection
J12
Port expansion connector for DSP-U30
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 142
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 8
OPTIONAL ETUS
This section describes optional Electronic Telephone Units that provide additional
functions for an Electra Elite IPK II system.
8.1
BSU(4M)-U20 ETU
8.1.1
Description
The BSU(4M)-U20 ETU is the Master Base Station Interface Unit
ETU that provides connection for four Base Stations and up to 16
simultaneous calls on the Electra Elite IPK II Wireless – DECT
feature.
Only one BSU(4M)-U20 ETU can be installed in the Basic or
Expanded Electra Elite IPK II system.
Figure 6-79 BSU(4M)-U20 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 143
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.1.2
Installation
As a single unit, the BSU(4M)-U20 ETU (Master) can be installed in
slots S1~S8 in any KSU. Two Slave ETUs [BSU(2S) or BSU(6S)]
can be cascaded on four corner posts to the left of the BSU(4M) in
accordance with the tables below. The complete assembly requires
three adjacent slots and limits installation of the BSU(4M) to slots
S3~S8.
Only one BSU(4M)-U20 ETU can be installed in any interface slot in
the Basic or Expanded Port Package of the Electra Elite IPK II.
No.
Slot N-2
Slot N-1
Slot N
No. of Base
Stations
1
None
None
BSU(4M) ETU
4
2
None
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
6
3
None
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
10
4
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
8
5
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
12
6
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
12
7
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
16
Base Station number assignments are shown in the table below:
Slot
N
N-1
ETU
Channel
BS No.
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
5
9
6
10
Note
BSU(4M) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
When BSU(2S) ETU is
installed, these numbers are
not assigned.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 144
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Slot
N-2
8.1.3
ETU
BS No.
1
11
2
12
3
13
4
14
5
15
6
16
BSU(6S) ETU
Note
When BSU(2S) ETU is
installed, these numbers are
not assigned.
LED Indications
LIVE LED (Red)
8.1.4
Channel
On indicates communication between this ETU
and the Main CPU.
Connectors
J
J
J
CN 1
Connects to the backboard.
CN 4
Connects to RJ-45 connector at mid-top of the
BSU(2S) or BSU(6S) ETU.
CN 5
Connects to RJ-45 connector at mid-bottom of
the BSU(2S) or BSU(6S) ETU.
The BSU(4M) has two serial interfaces: The upper port is for KGAP
Applications, Cable Delay Measurement, and Electra Elite IPK II to
Wireless – DECT administration. The lower port is for Applications,
telephone registration, and system information. The Administration
Program is used to communicate with ether port, depending on
operation required. The specifications for the Serial Ports are as
follows:
Specification
RS-232C
Connector
DB-9 Female
DCE/DTE
DCE (connected by straight cable to PC)
Speed
19200 bps
Data Length
8 bits
Parity
None
Stop Bit
None
Flow Control
Hardware Handshake
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 145
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.2
BSU(2S)-U20 ETU
8.2.1
Description
The BSU(2S)-U20 ETU is the Base Station Interface Unit Slave ETU
that provides connection for two additional Base Stations when
connected to the BSU(4M)-U20 (Master) ETU.
A maximum of two BSU(2S)-U20 ETUs can be installed in the Basic
or Expanded Electra Elite IPK II system.
Figure 6-80 BSU(2S)-U20 ETU
8.2.2
Installation
The BSU(2S)-U20 ETU (Slave) is installed on four corner posts on
the front of a BSU(4M)-U20 ETU or on the front of a BSU(6S)-U20 or
on front of another BSU(2S). Slave ETUs are cascaded on posts to
the left of the BSU(4M)-U20 in accordance with the tables below.
Only two BSU(2S)-U20 ETUs can be installed in the Basic or
Expanded Port Package of the Electra Elite IPK II.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 146
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
No.
Slot N-2
Slot N-1
Slot N
No. of Base
Stations
1
None
None
BSU(4M) ETU
4
2
None
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
6
3
None
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
10
4
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
8
5
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
12
6
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
12
7
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
16
Base Station number assignments are shown in the table below:
Slot
N
N-1
N-2
ETU
Channel
Base
Station
No.
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
5
9
6
10
1
11
2
12
3
13
4
14
5
15
6
16
Note
BSU(4M) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
When BSU(2S) ETU is
installed, these numbers are
not assigned.
When BSU(2S) ETU is
installed, these numbers are
not assigned.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 147
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.2.3
LED Indications
LIVE LED (Red)
8.2.4
On indicates communication between this ETU
and the Main CPU.
Connectors
J
J
J
CN 1
Connects to the backboard
CN 4
Connects to RJ-45 connector at mid-top of
another BSU(2S), BSU(6S), or BSU(4M) ETU.
CN 5
Connects to RJ-45 connector at mid-bottom of
another BSU(2S), BSU(6S), or BSU(4M) ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 148
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.3
BSU(6S)-U20 ETU
8.3.1
Description
The BSU(6S)-U20 ETU is the Base Station Interface Unit slave ETU
that provides connection for an additional six Base Stations when
used with the BSU(4M)-U20 (Master) ETU.
A maximum of two BSU(6S)-U20 ETUs can be installed in the Basic
or Expanded Electra Elite IPK II system.
Figure 6-81 BSU(6S)-U20 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 149
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.3.2
Installation
The BSU(6S)-U20 ETU (Slave) is installed on four corner posts on
the front of a BSU(4M)-U20 ETU or on the front of a BSU(2S)-U20 or
on front of another BSU(6S). Slave ETUs are cascaded on posts to
the left of the BSU(4M)-U20 in accordance with the tables below.
Only two BSU(6S)-U20 ETUs can be installed in the Basic or
Expanded Port Package of the Electra Elite IPK II.
No.
Slot N-2
Slot N-1
Slot N
No. of Base
Stations
1
None
None
BSU(4M) ETU
4
2
None
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
6
3
None
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
10
4
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
8
5
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
12
6
BSU(2S) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
12
7
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
BSU(4M) ETU
16
Base Station number assignments are shown in the table below:
Slot
N
N-1
ETU
Channel
BS No.
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
5
9
6
10
Note
BSU(4M) ETU
BSU(6S) ETU
When BSU(2S) ETU is
installed, these numbers are
not assigned.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 150
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Slot
ETU
N-2
8.3.3
BS No.
1
11
2
12
3
13
4
14
5
15
6
16
BSU(6S) ETU
Note
When BSU(2S) ETU is
installed, these numbers are
not assigned.
LED Indications
LIVE LED (Red)
8.3.4
Channel
On indicates communication between this ETU
and the Main CPU.
Connectors
J
J
J
CN 1
Connects to the backboard.
CN 4
Connects to RJ-45 connector at mid-top of the
BSU(2S), another BSU(6S), or BSU(4M) ETU.
CN 5
Connects to RJ-45 connector at mid-bottom of
the BSU(2S), another BSU(6S), or BSU(4M)
ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 151
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.4
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU
8.4.1
Description
The Common Channel Handler is an optional Interface ETU that
provides a common channel signal through the DTI-U30/U40 ETU to
a K-CCIS network and controls the signaling between the KTS and
the CPU. Each CCH ETU supports four K-CCIS links.
CCH(4)-U( ) ETU firmware V5.1 or higher is required for Electra Elite
IPK II compatibility.
Figure 6-82 CCH(4)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 152
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.4.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
Only one CCH(4)-U( ) ETU can be installed in any interface slot.
Expanded Port Package
Only one CCH(4)-U( ) ETU can be installed in any interface slot.
8.4.3
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-51 CCH(4)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings.
Table 6-51 CCH(4)-U( ) ETU Default Switch Settings
Switch
8.4.4
Setting/Description
SW1
Momentary Switch
Resets the CCH ETU. When this switch is pressed, all
K-CCIS users connected to the CCH ETU are interrupted.
Use this switch only after all other options have failed.
SW2–1
Off:
On:
Normal Operation (Default)
Test Mode
SW2–2
Off:
On:
Boot from Flash Memory (Default)
Boot from E-PROM (IC30)
SW2–3
Off:
On:
Normal Operation (Default)
Test Mode
SW2–4
Off:
On:
Watch Dog Timer On (Default)
Watch Dog Timer Off
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-52 CCH(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-52 CCH(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
1
Link Status for
CCH1
Layer 2: Up
Not Used
Layer 2: Down
2
Link Status for
CCH2
Layer 2: Up
Not Used
Layer 2: Down
3
Link Status for
CCH3
Layer 2: Up
Not Used
Layer 2: Down
4
Link Status for
CCH4
Layer 2: Up
Not Used
Layer 2: Down
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 153
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-52 CCH(4)-U( ) ETU LED Indications (Continued)
8.4.5
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
5
Link Status for
CCH1
Data Sent/
Received
Not Used
Idle
6
Link Status for
CCH2
Data Sent/
Received
Not Used
Idle
7
Link Status for
CCH3
Data Sent/
Received
Not Used
Idle
8
Link status for
CCH4
Data Sent/
Received
Not Used
Idle
9
CCH status
Alarm
Normal
Operation
Not Operating
10
LIVE
Operation
Stopped
(Power Still
On)
Normal
Operation
No Power
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
8.4.6
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN2
Performs maintenance functions.
Connections
There are no physical connections to the MDF for the CCH(4)-U( )
ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 154
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.5
CNF(8)-U( ) ETU
8.5.1
Description
The Multiline Conference Bridge allows any intercom user or outside
party calling to a port of the CNF(8)-U( ) ETU to join or make a
multiparty conference call.
Each CNF(8)-U( ) ETU supports one 8-party conference or two
4-party conferences regulated by a switch setting.
The system recognizes this ETU as SLI(8)-U( ) ETU. This ETU
shares the total number of station ports in the system.
Figure 6-83 CNF(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 155
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.5.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
A maximum of two CNF(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8.
The maximum number of CNF(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by 64
trunk and station ports combined. This ETU shares the total number
of station ports in the system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of two CNF(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8.
The maximum number of CNF(8)-U( ) ETUs that can be installed
depends on other station cards installed. The system is limited by
256 stations. This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the
system.
Calculating maximum capacity is based on the system having a
minimum of eight Electronic Station Interface (ESI) ports, four trunk
ports and a PKUII-U Unit installed.
8.5.3
Switch Settings
The CNF(8)-U( ) ETU has the following switches.
J
Reset Switch
Refer to Table 6-53 CNF(8)-U( ) ETU Reset Switch.
J
Conference Time Switch
Refer to Table 6-54 CNF(8)-U( ) ETU Maximum Conference
Time Switch.
J
Party Size Switch
Table 6-53 CNF(8)-U( ) ETU Reset Switch
Switch
Setting
Description
SW2
Press to Reset
Host Reset Switch
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 156
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-54 CNF(8)-U( ) ETU Maximum Conference Time Switch
Setting
Switch
Max Conference Time
SW3-2
SW3-3
ON
ON
1 Hour
ON
OFF
2 Hour
OFF
ON
3 Hour
OFF
OFF
No Limit
CTS
Table 6-55 CNF(8)-U( ) ETU Party Size Switch
8.5.4
Switch
Setting
Description
SW3-1
ON
One 8-Party Conference
SW3-1
OFF
Two 4-Party Conferences
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-56 CNF(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-56 CNF(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Flashing
Off
Status
ETU Status
Operation
stopped
(Power On)
Normal
Operation
No
Power
CH 0
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
CH 1
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
CH 2
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
CH 3
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
CH 4
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
CH 5
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
CH 6
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
CH 7
Status
Busy
Not Used
Idle
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 157
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.5.5
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J1
Connects to the backplane.
J2
Not currently used
J3
Nine-pin RS-232C connector for maintenance
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 158
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.6
CNF(16)-U20 ETU
8.6.1
Description
The CNF(16)-U20 ETU is a Conference Bridge that is used with the
Electra Elite IPK II system. Refer to Figure 6-84 CNF(16)-U20 ETU.
Each CNF(16)-U20 supports the following conferences and
conditions:
J
J
Simple Mode (8 Ports)
H
H
Two 4-party conferences
Simple Mode (16 Ports)
H
H
H
H
H
H
J
One 8-party conference
One16-party conference
Two 8-party conferences
One 6-party and two 5-party conferences
Four 4-party conferences
Password Protection for each conference
Applicable voice messages and announcements (e.g.,
Entry, password request, or exit).
Advanced Mode Conditions
H
H
H
H
H
Password protection option for each conference
Applicable voice messages and announcements (e.g.,
Entry, password request, or exit)
E-mail notification, when enabled, requires the organizer
to enter the E-mail address of each participant requiring
notification of a pending conference. This option is used
for setting up a new conference.
Host Required, when enabled, requires the host/
organizer to be logged into the conference before any
other participant can enter. This option is used for setting
up a new conference.
Admission Control, when enabled, requires the organizer
to dial a digit allowing each participant to enter the
conference. This FUTURE option is to be used for setting
up a new conference.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 159
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
H
Using a predefined password, the technician can record a
personalized Welcome Greeting for each Multimedia
Conference Bridge.
Figure 6-84 CNF(16)-U20 ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 160
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.6.2
Installation
The CNF(16)-U20 ETU is a hot-swappable ETU that can fit in any
interface slot in a KTS chassis and is recognized by the CPU as a
CNF( )-U20 ETU.
Only one CNF(16)-U20 ETU can be installed in any interface slot in
the Basic Port or Expanded Port Package of the Electra Elite IPK II.
The Ethernet connector can use a Category 5 (CAT5) unshielded
twisted pair (UTP) cable to connect to an Ethernet hub or switch on
the customer premises.
To install the CNF(16)-U20 ETU:
1.
Select the number of ports the ETU supports using SW1 DIP
switch 3 or 4.
2.
Place SW1 DIP switch 2 ON to configure for simple conference
mode.
3.
Place the ETU into the desired slot in the KSU chassis.
4.
After LEDs1~3 (DS11~13) are On, the ETU is operational.
5.
8.6.3
These LEDs are located on the lower back side of the ETU.
Connect the Ethernet cable coming from a hub or switch from
the customer premises to the J1 connector on the CNF ETU.
Verify that the link lamp is on green.
Configuring
When installed for the first time the CNF(16)-U20 ETU comes up
with factory default settings shown in Table 6-57 Default Network
Settings for TCP/IP Addressing.
Table 6-57 Default Network Settings for TCP/IP Addressing
IP Address
192.168.1.100
Subnet Mask
255.255.255.0
Default Gateway
0.0.0.0
These parameters must be redefined before the ETU can work in
your environment. Refer to the Elite Multimedia Conference Bridge
Installation Manual for more information.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 161
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Switch Settings
The CNF(16)-U20 ETU has the following switches.
J
DIP switch SW1
Refer to Table 6-58 CNF(16)-U20 ETU Dip Switch SW1. This
switch has four selector switches:
H
H
H
H
SW1-1
Restores ETU Port and /Modes settings to
Factory Default.
SW1-2
Defines either Simple or Advanced Mode.
SW1-3
Defines the 16 Port configuration.
SW1-4
Defines the 8 Port configuration.
Table 6-58 CNF(16)-U20 ETU Dip Switch SW1
Multimedia ETU Port and Mode
SW1-1
SW1-2
SW1-3
SW1-4
8-Port Simple Mode
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
16-Port Simple Mode
OFF
ON
ON
OFF
8-Port Advanced Mode
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
16-Port Advanced Mode
OFF
OFF
ON
OFF
J
RESET Switch SW2
This switch allows the technician to reset the CNF(16)-U20
ETU without having to remove and insert it again in the KTS.
J
Rotary Switch SW3
This switch is a 16-position (0~9,A~F) rotary switch to select
display options. Refer to Table 6-59 CNF(16)-U20 ETU Rotary
Switch SW3.
Table 6-59 CNF(16)-U20 ETU Rotary Switch SW3
Channel
Status
Channel
Status
0
CH8 (DS1)
ON
CH16 (DS1)
OFF
0
CH7 (DS2)
ON
CH15 (DS2)
OFF
0
CH6 (DS3)
ON
CH14 (DS3)
OFF
Position
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 162
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-59 CNF(16)-U20 ETU Rotary Switch SW3 (Continued)
Channel
Status
Channel
Status
0
CH5 (DS4)
ON
CH13 (DS4)
OFF
0
CH4 (DS5)
ON
CH12 (DS5)
OFF
0
CH3 (DS6)
ON
CH11 (DS6)
OFF
0
CH2 (DS7)
ON
CH10 (DS7)
OFF
0
CH1 (DS8)
ON
CH9 (DS8)
OFF
1
CH8 (DS1)
OFF
CH16 (DS1)
ON
1
CH7 (DS2)
OFF
CH15 (DS2)
ON
1
CH6 (DS3)
OFF
CH14 (DS3)
ON
1
CH5 (DS4)
OFF
CH13 (DS4)
ON
1
CH4 (DS5)
OFF
CH12 (DS5)
ON
1
CH3 (DS6)
OFF
CH11 (DS6)
ON
1
CH2 (DS7)
OFF
CH10 (DS7)
ON
1
CH1 (DS8)
OFF
CH9 (DS8)
ON
Position
8.6.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-60 CNF(16)-U20 ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-60 CNF(16)-U20 ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Off
DS1
Channel Status
CH8/CH16 On
CH8/CH16 Off
DS2
Channel Status
CH7/CH15 On
CH7/CH15 Off
DS3
Channel Status
CH6/CH14 On
CH6/CH14 Off
DS4
Channel Status
CH5/CH13 On
CH5/CH13 Off
DS5
Channel Status
CH4/CH12 On
CH4/CH12 Off
DS6
Channel Status
CH3/CH11 On
CH3/CH11 Off
DS7
Channel Status
CH2/CH10 On
CH2/CH10 Off
DS8
Channel Status
CH1/CH9 On
CH1/CH9 Off
DS9
LIVE
ETU Active
ETU Inactive
DS10
CF BUSY
Flash Access
No Flash Access
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 163
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-60 CNF(16)-U20 ETU LED Indications
LED
Description
On
Off
LED 3 (DS13)
Conference Status
(Back of ETU)
Conference Initialized
Conference not
Initialized
LED 2 (DS12)
Insertion Status
(Back of ETU)
Insertion Complete
Insertion not
Complete
LED 1 (DS11)
Boot Status
(Back of ETU)
Boot Complete
Boot Incomplete
8.6.5
Connectors
The following connectors are used:
J
J1 Ethernet Connector
This connector is a single 10/100 MPS Ethernet Connector.
This port has Auto-Medium Dependent Interface Crossover
(MDIX) to allow using either a straight-through Ethernet cable
for connection to a PC or a crossover Ethernet cable.
The Ethernet Interface setting allows manual configuration of
the Ethernet port from the Web Interface, and can be set to
operate in the following port speed and duplex mode
combinations: 10MB/Full Duplex, 10MB/HalfDuplex,100MB/
Half Duplex, or 100MB/Full Duplex, Auto-Negotiate.
J
J2 Serial Connector
This 10-pin serial terminal is used for debugging operations
only.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 164
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.7
HUB(8)-U( ) ETU
8.7.1
Description
The HUB(8)-U( ) ETU is an optional Ethernet interface for the Electra
Elite IPK II KSU that supports eight Ethernet ports. Each port has
two LEDs that indicate status and activity.
A HUB is a switching point for data that comes together from
individual ports. A switch determines the port where the data should
be forwarded and regulates transmission. The HUB(8)-U( ) ETU
provides an efficient platform when multiple ETUs that require
Ethernet connection are installed in the Electra Elite IPK II KSU.
One port can be a source port, and another port can be set as a
target port to mirror the source and monitor data traffic.
Figure 6-85 HUB(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 165
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.7.2
Installation
The HUB(8)-U( ) ETU cannot be installed in a KSU that contains an
EliteMail VP or CTI system.
This ETU has an attached green cable that must be connected to
frame ground.
Basic Port Package
Only one HUB(8)-U( ) ETU can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The system is limited by 64 trunk and station ports combined. This
ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system.
Expanded Port Package
Only one HUB(8)-U( ) ETU can be installed in slots S1~S8.
The system is limited by 256 stations. This ETU shares the total
number of station ports in the system.
8.7.3
Switch Settings
Press switch SW1 to Reset the HUB(8)-U( ) ETU.
8.7.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-61 HUB(8)-U( ) LEDS.
Table 6-61 HUB(8)-U( ) LEDS
LED
ON
LED1
8.7.5
OFF
Blinking
No Power to ETU
Normal Operation
RJ45C Yellow
100 Mbps
10 Mbps
N/A
RJ45C Green
LINK
No Link
Data Tx/Rx
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J
CN1
Connects to the backplane.
CN3
Three pin Jumper. Pins 2 and 3 are shorted for
Normal operation.
CN5
Channel 1~4 RJ45C Connectors
CN6
Channel 5~8 RJ45C Connectors
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 166
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.8
IAD(8)-U( )
8.8.1
Description
The IAD(8)-U( ) ETU is an optional interface integration device ETU
for the Electra Elite IPK II KSU. The IAD(8)-U( ) ETU supports
various IP applications such as the CCISoIP application and the
MEGACO Station Application. Currently used configurations are
indicated in Figure 6-86 IAD(8)-U( ) ETU.
Figure 6-86 IAD(8)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 167
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-62 IAD(8)-U( ) Configurations
Port
s
Installation slot
Electra Elite IPK
II
CCISoIP
8
S1~S8
CCISoIP ETU
ESI(8)-U( )
8
S1~S8
Megaco Station ETU
Configuration
8.8.2
Application
Boot Up Sequence Status Identification
Status of the IAD(8)-U( ) ETU during boot up is shown in Table 6-63
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU LED Boot Sequence Indications.
Table 6-63 IAD(8)-U( ) ETU LED Boot Sequence Indications
State
D8
CH
1
D6
CH
2
D4
CH
3
D2
CH
4
D7
CH
5
D5
CH
6
D3
CH
7
D1
CH
8
*D12
LIVE
Approximate
Time
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Flash
1 second
(from Cold Boot)
2
ON
ON
ON
ON
Off
Off
Off
Off
Flash
5 seconds
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Flash
3 seconds
4
Off
Off
Off
Off
ON
ON
Off
Off
Flash
5 seconds
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
ON
ON
Flash
5 seconds
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Flash
5 seconds
* LIVE LED D12 also flashes when ETU is receiving power from the KSU.
8.8.3
Installation
This ETU can be installed in any KSU slot that supports the
applicable ETU simulated.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of three IAD(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots
S1~S8 when used as an ESI.
A maximum of six IAD(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8
when used as a CCISoIP ETU.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 14 IAD(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8
when used as an ESI.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 168
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
A maximum of 22 IAD(8)-U( ) ETUs can be installed in slots S1~S8
when used as a CCISoIP ETU.
8.8.4
Switch Settings
Refer to Table 6-64 IAD(8)-U( ) ETU Switches.
Table 6-64 IAD(8)-U( ) ETU Switches
Switch
Setting
Description
S1
Press to Reset
Host Reset Switch
S2
Shown below
Eight-position DIP Switch
S2-1~4
Always Off
Reserved
S2-5
Always On to enable
eight ports
(Off enables four ports)
Number of Voice Ports Selection
S2-6~-8
8.8.5
S2-8 On for CCISoIP
mode.
S2-6 On for ESI Mode
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU Mode
Selection to show simulated ETU
Unlike the IPK system, DIP switch S2-4 should not be ON. It is not
required for card recognition and may interfere with normal operation.
Ethernet Status
Two Built-in LEDs (One green and one yellow) on the front of each
RJ-45 Connector indicate Ethernet connection status. The yellow
LED is On when the link is up; the green LED is On to indicate
activity.
8.8.6
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J
P1
Connects to the backplane.
J1, J10, J11
Reserved for future use.
J5
RJ-45 Ethernet connector for future use
J6
Default RJ-45 Ethernet connector
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 169
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.9
IVR Application
8.9.1
Description
The EliteApps – Interactive Voice Response application is a
man-machine interface that uses scripting language to play prompts
that guide a caller to select different available options using a
touchtone telephone key pad (DTMF tones).
This application is implemented using a VMP(4)-U( ) ETU and an
IVR Compact Flash (CF) to support four ports for IVR applications.
When the DSP-U( ) module is attached eight ports are available.
Figure 6-87 VMP(4)-U( ) ETU With IVR Compact Flash
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 170
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.9.2
Installation
Basic Port Package
Only one VMP ETU can be installed in slots S1~S8.
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system. The
system is limited by 256 stations.
Expanded Port Package
Only one VMP ETU can be installed in slots S1~S8.
This ETU shares the total number of station ports in the system. The
system is limited by 256 stations.
When installing this ETU, make all ETU DIP switch setting
changes before inserting it in the KSU. Ensure that KSU
is off.
8.9.3
Switch Settings
The following default switch settings are used for the VMP(4)/(8)-U( )
ETU. Typically these settings should remain at factory default.
Table 6-65 Switch Settings for VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU
Switch
Default
Setting
SW 1
Off
Resets the ETU. Leave at factory default setting.
SW 2-1
Off
Not used for IVR ETU. Leave at factory default setting.
SW 2-2
Off
Restores the ETU to factory default settings if set to On.
Leave at factory default unless factory defaults must be restored, then set
SW2-2 and SW2-3 to On.
SW2-3
Off
Restores the ETU to factory default settings if set to On.
Leave at factory default unless factory defaults must be restored, then set
SW2-2 and SW2-3 to On.
SW3
Off
Toggles to switch the IVR application On or Off.
Description
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 171
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.9.4
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-66 VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications.
Table 6-66 VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications
LED
LED 1, AP1
Description
On
Flashing
Off
Not Used
Not Used
Running without
errors
Running with errors
Not Running
Green
LED 2, AP2
Not Used
Not Used
Not Used
Not Used
LED 3, DRIVE
Hard Drive Access
Red if accessed
Not Used
When not
accessed
LED 4, CF PWR
Power to the ETU
Red if power is on
Not Used
No power to
ETU
LED 5, ICGA
Live LED
Not Used
Red every
125ms during
operation
Operation is
shutdown
LED 6, Switch S3
Indication
Do not remove Voice
Mail from KSU
Red when S3 in
RUN
Not Used
S3 not in RUN
LED 7, Shutdown
Safe to remove Voice
Mail from KSU
Red when S3 in
SHUTDOWN
Not Used
S3 not in
SHUTDOWN
LED 8, Power
Receiving KSU
power
Red if power is on
Not Used
No KSU power
LED 9, FED DSP
For development only
Not Used
Not Used
Not Used
LED 10, CH1
Off/On-Hook status
Red for Off-Hook
Not Used
On-Hook
LED 11, CH2
Off/On-Hook status
Red for Off-Hook
Not Used
On-Hook
LED 12, CH3
Off/On-Hook status
Red for Off-Hook
Not Used
On-Hook
LED 13, CH4
Off/On-Hook status
Red for Off-Hook
Not Used
On-Hook
LED 14, CH5
Off/On-Hook status
Red for Off-Hook
Not Used
On-Hook
LED 15, CH6
Off/On-Hook status
Red for Off-Hook
Not Used
On-Hook
LED 16, CH7
Off/On-Hook status
Red for Off-Hook
Not Used
On-Hook
Application Software
Amber
Red
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 172
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 6-66 VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU LED Indications (Continued)
LED
Description
LED 17, CH8
On
Off/On-Hook status
Red for Off-Hook
Flashing
Off
Not Used
On-Hook
The following LEDS are also used during startup to signify:
LED 1 - BICOM driver loaded
LED 2 - Scandisk completed successfully
LED 4 - Application started successfully
After the system is up and running these LEDs are turned off, and all channels are ready to
receive calls.
When the VMP(4)/(8) fails to start, all eight channel LEDs and the BCLR LED (AP1) are on.
Table 6-67 VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Ready LED Indications shows the
status of the VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU after it has been installed,
initialized, and is ready to process calls.
Table 6-67 VMP(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU Ready LED Indications
LED
LED 1, AP1
Application Software
LED 4, CF PWR
LED 5, ICGA
LED 7, Shutdown
LED 8, Power
8.9.5
Description
Status
Running without
errors
Solid Green
Power to the ETU
Solid Red
Live LED
Blinking Red
Initialized
application
Solid Green
Receiving KSU
power
Solid Red
Jumper Settings
The following jumper settings apply.
J1
Setting
Pin 1 to Pin 2
IVR Integration (default)
Pin 2 to Pin 3
Not Used
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 173
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
J7
8.9.6
Setting
Pin 1 to Pin 2
Not Used
Pin 2 to Pin 3
Hard Drive is master drive (default)
Connectors
The following connectors are included:
J
J
J
J
J
J2
Connects to the backplane.
J8
Connects to Hard Disk memory.
J9
RJ45 LAN connector for network connection
J11
9-pin RS232 local serial connector for direct
connection
J12
Port expansion connector for DSP-U( ) module
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 174
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.10
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU
8.10.1
Description
The Packet Voice Application, PVA(X)-U( ) ETU is an optional
interface that supports IP Application Packages (Media Gateway
MG16, IP CCISoIP, or MG_CCIS (Combo, requiring version 1.00 or
higher and SPO1J), or Conference Package (Multimedia Conference
Bridge, requiring version 1.00 or higher and SPO1J). Refer to Figure
6-88 PVA(X)-U( ) ETU. This ETU can be assigned as an MG16
Package to support Megaco Stations, as a CCISoIP Package to
support the IP CCIS Network Trunks, or as a CNF package to
support the Multimedia Conference Bridge, or an MG_CCIS
(Combo) Package, version 1.00 or higher with SPO1J.
Figure 6-88 PVA(X)-U( ) ETU
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 175
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.10.2
License
Version 1500 or higher – 4-port license registration provides users
with the flexibility of adding CCISoIP ports in increments of four (4, 8,
12, 16, 20 and 24) or (MG16) DSP resources in increments of four
(4, 8, 12 and 16).
Version 1500 or higher - 16-port Conference License registration
provides users with the flexibility of adding 16 Conference ports.
Version 2000 or higher – Using the MG_CCIS Combo Package
4-port license registration provides users with the flexibility of adding
CCISoIP ports in increments of four (4, 8, 12, 16, 20 and 24) or
(MG16) DSP resources in increments of four (4, 8, 12, 16, 20 and
24).
8.10.3
Installation
Basic Port Package
Each PVA(X)-U( ) ETU installed with the MG16 Package
counts for up to 16 TDM Talk Paths [2 PVA(X)-U( ) ETUs
max].
Each PVA(X)-U( ) ETU installed with the CCISoIP Package
counts for up to 24 Trunk Ports of the 64 Total Ports [2
PVA(X)-U( ) ETUs max].
Each PVA(X)-U( ) ETU installed with the CNF Package counts
for up to 16 Extension ports of the 64 Total Ports (1 Conference
ETU max).
Each PVA(X)-U( ) ETU installed with the MG_CCIS Package
counts for up to 24 Trunk Ports of the 64 Total Ports and up to
24 TDM Talk Paths [2 PVA(X)-U( ) ETUs max].
Expanded Port Package
Each PVA(X)-U( ) ETU installed with the MG16 Package
counts for up to 16 TDM Talk Paths [13 PVA(X)-U( ) ETUs
max per system].
Each PVA(X)-U( ) ETU installed with the CCISoIP Package
counts for up to 24 Trunk Ports* of the max 200 Trunk Ports [11
PVA(X)-U( ) ETUs max per system].
Each PVA(X)-U( ) ETU installed with the CNF Package counts
for up to 16 Extension ports of the max 256 Extension Ports (1
Conference ETU max per system).
Each PVA(X)-U( ) ETU installed with the MG_CCIS Package
counts for up to 24 Trunk Ports* of the max 200 Trunk Ports
and up to 24 TDM Talk Paths [23 PVA(X)-U( ) ETUs max per
system].
*
The system has a maximum of four 24-port ETUs (T-1, PRI,
PVA with CCISoIP, PVA with MG_CCIS).
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 176
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.10.4
Applications Removal Procedure
Table 6-68 PVA(X)-U( ) ETU Configurations
Configuration
Ports
Electra Elite
IPK II
Installation slot
Application
MG16
4~16
(Increments
of four)
S1~S8
MG16 Package
IP CCISoIP
4~24
(Increments
of four)
S1~S8
CCISoIP Package
MG_CCIS
4~24
(Increments
of four)
S1~S8
Combo ETU MG16
and IP CCISoIP
CNF
8/16
S1~S8
Multimedia
Conference Bridge
The PVA(X)-U( ) ETU is hot swappable and can be removed from
the KTS without powering down the ETU or the Electra Elite IPK II
system.
When the Electra Elite IPK II KSU requires system reset, this ETU
comes back on line.
8.10.5
Configuring
When installed for the first time the PVA(X)-U( ) ETU comes up with
factory default settings shown in Table 6-69 Default Network
Settings for TCP/IP Addressing.
Table 6-69 Default Network Settings for TCP/IP Addressing
IP Address
192.168.1.100
Subnet Mask
255.255.255.0
Default Gateway
0.0.0.0
These parameters must be redefined before the ETU can work in
your environment. Refer to the Applicable IP Application Features
and Specifications and installation instructions.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 177
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
The PVA(X)-U( ) ETU has the following switches.
J
DIP switch SW1
Refer to Table 6-70 PVA(X)-U( ) ETU Rotary Switch SW3. This
switch has four selector switches:
H
H
H
H
H
SW1-1
N/A
SW1-2
N/A
SW1-3
N/A
SW1-4
Placed ON to restore factory default software
package when used with Rotary Switch SW3.
RESET Switch SW2
This switch allows the technician to reset the PVA(X)-U( )
without having to remove and insert it again in the KTS.Rotary
Switch SW3
This 16-position (0~9,A~F) rotary switch selects display
options. Only A is currently used. Refer to Table 6-70
PVA(X)-U( ) ETU Rotary Switch SW3.
Table 6-70 PVA(X)-U( ) ETU Rotary Switch SW3
SW1-4
Setting
SW3
Position
ON
A
Status
Restores Factory Default Package
Notes:
1. When setting factory configuration, the ETU must initially boot up
with configured switch settings.
2. When Rotary Switch SW3 is selected, Switch SW1-4 must be ON.
3. Restoring the factory software package may take up to five
minutes.
4. When the ETU has completed booting, return Switch SW1-4 to
OFF and Rotary Switch SW3 to 0.
8.10.6
LED Indications
Refer to Table 6-71 Default Boot Sequence: In Active PVA(X)-U( )
ETU without IP Application Loaded.
The Boot sequence in this table occurs when the ETU is at factory
default and the IP Application is not loaded.
Refer to Table 6-72 Active PVA(X)-U( ) ETU with IP Application
Loaded.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 178
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
The Boot sequence in this table occurs when the IP Application is
loaded.
The PVA(X)-U( ) should be removed only after the ETU has
completed booting, and LEDs 1~3 on the back of the ETU are ON.
Table 6-71 Default Boot Sequence: In Active PVA(X)-U( ) ETU without IP Application Loaded
State
DS8
CH1
DS7
CH2
DS6
CH3
DS5
CH4
DS4
CH5
DS3
CH6
DS2
CH7
DS1
CH8
DS9
Live
DS10
CF
Busy
LED
3
LED
2
LED
1
Approximate
Time
1
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Flash
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
CH1~CH8
Simultaneous
2
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Flash
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
CH1~CH8
Incremental
3
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Flash
Slow
Blink
OFF
OFF
ON
1~3 Minutes
4
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Flash
Flash
OFF
OFF
ON
1~5 Seconds
5
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Flash
Slow
Blink
OFF
OFF
ON
1~3 Minutes
6
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Flash
Fast
Blink
OFF
OFF
ON
1~3 Minutes
7
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Flash
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
ACTIVE
Table 6-72 Active PVA(X)-U( ) ETU with IP Application Loaded
State
DS8
CH1
DS7
CH2
DS6
CH3
DS5
CH4
DS4
CH5
DS3
CH6
DS2
CH7
DS1
CH8
DS9
Live
DS10
CF
Busy
LED
3
LED
2
LED
1
Approximate
Time
1
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Flash
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
CH1~CH8
Simultaneous
2
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Flash
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
CH1~CH8
Incremental
3
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Flash
Flash
OFF
OFF
ON
1~3 Minutes
4
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Flash
OFF
OFF
OFF
ON
1~5 Seconds
5
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
OFF
Flash
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
CH1~CH7
Incremental
6
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
Flash
OFF
ON
ON
ON
ACTIVE
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
6 - 179
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.10.7
Connectors
The following connectors are used:
J
J1 Ethernet Connector
This connector is a single 10/100 Mbps Ethernet Connector.
This port has Auto-Medium Dependent Interface Crossover
(MDIX) to allow using either a straight-through Ethernet cable
for connection to a PC or a crossover Ethernet cable.
The Ethernet Interface setting allows manual configuration of
the Ethernet port from the Web Interface, and can be set to
operate in the following port speed and duplex mode
combinations: 10MB/Full Duplex, 10MB/HalfDuplex,100MB/
Half Duplex, or 100MB/Full Duplex, Auto-Negotiate.
J
J2 Serial Connector
This 10-pin serial terminal is used for debugging only.
J
J4 Compact Flash
Reserved for future use.
___________________________________________________________________________________
6 - 180
Installing ETUs (Circuit Cards)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 7
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ....................................................................................... 7-1
Section 2
Music on Hold ................................................................................................. 7-1
2.1
Connecting Audio Sources to the KSU ....................................................... 7-1
Section 3
Station Background Music ............................................................................ 7-1
Section 4
Paging Connections ....................................................................................... 7-2
Section 5
Connecting a KSU to a Personal Computer ................................................ 7-2
Section 6
5.1
Connecting the PC to the KSU .................................................................... 7-2
5.2
Connecting the Printer to the KSU .............................................................. 7-3
PGD(2)-U10 ADP ............................................................................................. 7-3
6.1
Using a PGD(2)-U10 ADP ........................................................................... 7-3
6.2
LED Indications .......................................................................................... 7-5
6.3
Setting Up PGD(2)-U10 ADP Connections ................................................. 7-5
6.4
Wall Mounting the PGD(2)-U10 ADP (Optional) ....................................... 7-10
6.5
Installing a Door Box ................................................................................. 7-12
6.6
External Page ............................................................................................ 7-15
6.7
Connecting to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP ......................................................... 7-15
6.8
External Paging And Page Relays ............................................................ 7-16
6.9
Section 7
6.8.1
External Page Relays ...................................................................................... 7-16
6.8.2
Connecting a Dry Contact Relay Device to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP .................. 7-17
External Recording System or External Ringer ......................................... 7-17
PMS-U10 Interface Box ................................................................................ 7-19
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List of Figures and Tables
Chapter 7
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 7-1
Music Source Connections ......................................................................................... 7-1
Figure 7-2
Connecting a PC to the KSU ...................................................................................... 7-3
Figure 7-3
PGD(2)-U10 ADP ....................................................................................................... 7-4
Figure 7-4
Remove Cover from PGD(2)-U10 ADP ...................................................................... 7-5
Figure 7-5
Remove Plastic Cover from Cable Hole ..................................................................... 7-6
Figure 7-6
Jumper Settings ......................................................................................................... 7-7
Figure 7-7
PGD(2)-U10 ADP Connection Diagram ..................................................................... 7-8
Figure 7-8
Connecting Cable to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP ............................................................... 7-9
Figure 7-9
PGD(2)-U10 ADP Connections ................................................................................ 7-10
Figure 7-10
Installing the Screws ................................................................................................ 7-11
Figure 7-11
Wall Mounting the PGD(2)-U10 ADP ....................................................................... 7-11
Figure 7-12
Setting the PGD(2)-U10 ADP for a Door Box ........................................................... 7-13
Figure 7-13
Installing a Door Box ............................................................................................... 7-14
Figure 7-14
PGD(2)-U10 ADP Cable Connection ....................................................................... 7-16
Figure 7-15
PGD(2)-U10 ADP Cable Connection ....................................................................... 7-18
Figure 7-16
PMS-U10 Front Viewq ..............................................................................................7-19
Figure 7-17
PMS-U10 Back View ................................................................................................ 7-19
Table 7-1
PMS-U10 Connectors ..............................................................................................7-20
Table 7-2
PMS-U10 LED Indications ........................................................................................ 7-20
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures and Tables
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU
Common Optional Equipment Chapter
7
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Electra Elite IPK II system supports Music on Hold, Station Background Music
and external paging. This chapter provides information regarding these options.
SECTION 2
MUSIC ON HOLD
The Electra Elite IPK II KSU allows external Music on Hold source to be connected to
the Electra Elite IPK II system. The external Music on Hold source can be connected
using the PGD(2)-U10 ADP or the KSU cabinet. Refer to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP
section for details.
2.1
Connecting Audio Sources to the KSU
Connect the plug end into the audio jack on the side of the base KSU.
Figure 7-1 Music Source Connections
SECTION 3
STATION BACKGROUND MUSIC
Station Background Music can be provided using an internal or an external source.
The same connection method used for Music on Hold is used for Station Background
Music.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 4
PAGING CONNECTIONS
When connecting External Paging, the PGD(2)-U10 ADP is the interface with Paging
In/Out, Background Music (External Speaker) Out and/or External Tone Ringer/Night
Chime Out.
SECTION 5
CONNECTING A KSU TO A PERSONAL COMPUTER
To use the PC Programming, specialized software must be installed in the user PC
and the PC must be connected using a serial port to the KSU.
5.1
Connecting the PC to the KSU
Using a DB9 straight cable, connect the PC to one of the COM ports on the
side of the KSU. Refer to Figure 7-2 Connecting a PC to the KSU.
The functions and the communication port connections are:
Function
Port
PC Programming/Station
Message Detail
Recording (SMDR)
COM 1
Serial-port characteristics include:
Characteristic
Value
Baud Rate
38.4 K (maximum)
Parity
None
Stop Bit
1 stop bit
Data Bit
8 bits
Port Type
DCE
___________________________________________________________________________________
7-2
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 7-2 Connecting a PC to the KSU
5.2
Connecting the Printer to the KSU
When using the charge control, connect the printer to the KSU to allow printing
of the charge data. Connect the printer to the serial port on the side of the
KSU with a DB9 straight cable. Use the COM 1 port to connect the printer.
SECTION 6
PGD(2)-U10 ADP
6.1
Using a PGD(2)-U10 ADP
The PGD(2)-U10 ADP (adapter) provides two circuits that allow connection to
external terminals such as:
J
J
J
J
J
Door Box (eight maximum per system)
External Speaker with Amplifier (eight maximum with PGD(2)-U10 ADP)
External Music Source (external MOH) (96 maximum per system)
External Recording System (96 maximum per system)
External Ringing
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
The Electra Elite IPK II allows a maximum of 56 PGD(2)-U10 ADPs to be
installed [48 for ACI (external MOH or external recording system) ports, four
for Door Boxes, and four for Paging]. The PGD(2)-U10 ADP also provides
multipurpose control relays. These control relays can be used to control the
external amplifier, external music source and door lock control using a Door Box.
The system allows up to eight general purpose relays with the PGD(2)-U10
ADP.
The PGD(2)-U10 ADP connects to any available digital extension port. The
terminal connections made in the PGD(2)-U10 ADP and the jumper settings
determine what features are used for each circuit.
The PDG(2)-U10 ADP can be connected only to an ESIB(8)-U20 ETU. If the
PDG(2)-U10 ADP is connected to an ESIE(8)-U20 ETU, it is not recognized.
When an ESIB(8)-U20 ETU has an ESIE(8)-U20 ETU installed [ESIB/E(16)],
the PGD(2)-U10 ADP has both channels available for Paging, MOH, External
Ringers or Door Box according to the strapping on ports 1~8. The
corresponding port on the ESIE(8)-U20 ETU does not support a station or
other hardware (It is used by the PGD(2)-U10 ADP for channel 2). When an
ESIB(8)-U20 is installed without the ESIE(8)-U20 ETU installed, a
PGD(2)-U10 ADP installed on ports 1~8 is recognized, but only channel 1 on
the PGD(2)-U10 ADP is supported. Channel 2 is unavailable. ESIB(8)-U10
ETUs and ESIE(8)-U10 ETUs do not support the PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
Channel 1
Status LED
Channel 2
Status LED
Figure 7-3 PGD(2)-U10 ADP
___________________________________________________________________________________
7-4
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.2
LED Indications
LED
6.3
Indication
Note
LED 1
Green LED
when CH1 in
use.
Flashing green LED indicates dip switch
setting and programming for CH1 are in
conflict.
LED 2
Green LED
when CH2 in
use.
Flashing green LED indicates dip switch
setting and programming for CH2 are in
conflict.
Setting Up PGD(2)-U10 ADP Connections
When the PGD(2)-U10 ADP is to be wall mounted, all the cable connections
should be made first.
For the module to ID correctly after setting the jumpers, set the circuit to zero
for the module port in Program 10-03-01 prior to connecting the line cord to
the PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
1.
Remove the screw from the front of the PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
Module
Figure 7-4 Remove Cover from PGD(2)-U10 ADP
2.
Using a screwdriver, break out the plastic piece covering the cable hole.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7-5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Breakout plastic
for cable access
Figure 7-5 Remove Plastic Cover from Cable Hole
3.
Set the S3 - S6 jumpers to the proper setting for the function to be used.
Channel
1
Channel
2
S3
S4
Function
Open
Open
Door Box
On when in use.
Open
Short
External Paging Speaker
On when in use.
Short
Open
External Ringer
On when in use.
Short
Short
External Music on Hold/
Recording System
On steady.
S5
S6
Open
Open
Door Box
On when in use.
Open
Short
External Paging Speaker
On when in use.
Short
Open
External Ringer
On when in use.
Short
Short
External Music on Hold/
Recording System
On steady.
Function
LED Indication
LED Indication
___________________________________________________________________________________
7-6
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Short setting
Open setting
S3
S4
S5
S6
Figure 7-6 Jumper Settings
4.
Strip one end of the cable to be connected to the control relay or door
box so that approximately 1/4” (8 mm) of bare wire is exposed.
Cable
8mm
5.
Insert the cable in the proper CN4 or CN5 location while holding down
the lock button with a flat-head screwdriver. After the cable is in place,
release the lock button.
Refer to the specific function being connected for more detail on
PGD(2)-U10 ADP connections.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7-7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 7-7 PGD(2)-U10 ADP Connection Diagram
___________________________________________________________________________________
7-8
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Flat-head screwdriver
Cable
Press down
CN4, CN5
Figure 7-8 Connecting Cable to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP
6.
Repeat Steps 4 and 5 for any additional connections required.
7.
Replace the cover and tighten the screw to hold the cover in place.
8.
When required for the function being used, insert the RCA connectors in
the CN3 (Channel 1) and CN3 (Channel 2) connectors on the back of the
PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7-9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
CN3
Channel 2
CN3
Channel 1
CN1
(to ESIU port)
RCA
Plugs
Figure 7-9 PGD(2)-U10 ADP Connections
9.
Install a modular jack for each PGD(2)-U10 ADP. For each module, run
one-pair 24 AWG station cable from the crossconnect block to a modular
jack. Ground the unused pair.
10. Terminate the extension leads to GRN/RED of the modular jack.
Terminate the unused leads to the jack.
11.
Install bridging clips as required.
For the module to ID correctly, set the circuit type to 0 for the port in
Program 10-03-01 prior to connecting the line cord.
12. Plug a modular line cord from the mod jack to the CN1 connector on the
PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
6.4
Wall Mounting the PGD(2)-U10 ADP (Optional)
1.
To wall mount the PGD(2)-U10 ADP, insert two wood screws 100mm
apart (3 15/16”). Leave 3mm (1/8”) of the screw exposed. The screws
can be installed either vertical or horizontal, depending on which position
fits best for your location.
___________________________________________________________________________________
7 - 10
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4mm
3mm
100mm
100mm
Figure 7-10 Installing the Screws
2.
The back of the PGD(2)-U10 ADP has two key-hole type openings.
Place the PGD(2)-U10 ADP over the two screws and slide it down or
over (depending on the positioning) to lock it in place.
Protruding
Screws
Protruding
Screws
Figure 7-11 Wall Mounting the PGD(2)-U10 ADP
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.5
Installing a Door Box
A PGD(2)-U10 ADP is required for this feature.
The Door Box is a self-contained Intercom unit typically used to monitor an
entrance door. A visitor at the door can press the Door Box call button (like a
door bell). The Door Box then sends chime tones to all extensions
programmed to receive chimes.
Each PGD(2)-U10 ADP audio output can optionally support two analog Door
Boxes. In addition, you can connect each circuit control relay to an electric
door strike. This allows an extension user to remotely activate the door strike
while talking to a visitor at the Door Box. The control relays are normally open.
The NTCPU also provides one relay. This relay is defined as relay 0 in
programming. The relays on the PGD(2)-U10 ADP are numbered 1~8. The
system can have up to eight Door Boxes.
A PGD(2)-U10 ADP circuit used for an analog Door Box cannot be used for
External Paging.
1.
Make sure the jumper in the PGD(2)-U10 ADP for the associated Door
Box is set correctly. (Refer to Figure 7-6 Jumper Settings).
2.
If a line cord was not previously connected to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP,
complete Steps 3~6. Otherwise, skip to Step 7.
3.
Install a modular jack for each PGD(2)-U10 ADP. For each module, run
one-pair 24 AWG station cable from the crossconnect block to a modular
jack. Ground the unused pair.
4.
Terminate the extension leads to GRN/RED of the modular jack.
Terminate the unused leads to the jack.
5.
Install bridging clips as required.
6.
Plug a modular line cord from the mod jack to the CN1 connector on the
PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
7.
When wall mounting the Door Box, remove the screw on the front of the
Door Box.
8.
Remove the back half of the Door Box and attach this mounting bracket
to the wall with the two provided screws.
___________________________________________________________________________________
7 - 12
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
9.
Connect the two-conductor station cable from the CN4 connectors in the
PGD(2)-U10 ADP to the Door Box terminals. These wires must be routed
through the opening in the bottom of the Door Box mounting bracket.
Be sure to maintain the proper polarity.
10. Replace the front half of the Door Box and reattach the screw to secure it
in place.
Door Box CH1
Door Box CH2
To Digital Station Port
RCA Jack for External Page,
External Ringer,
and External Music Source
Relay 5
Relay 6
Door Box Connections
S3-S6
Circuit type selection
Figure 7-12 Setting the PGD(2)-U10 ADP for a Door Box
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
To Door Chime Box 1
Crossconnect
to 66M150 block to
PGDAD
Adaptor
Rear View
To Door
Chime Box Relay
Misc Block
Holes for
mounting screws
Screw
Figure 7-13 Installing a Door Box
___________________________________________________________________________________
7 - 14
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.6
External Page
Two external page zone/door box circuits are provided by each PGD(2)-U10
ADP installed. Each Door Box/external page circuit provides a dry relay
contact. The external page speakers provided by the PGD(2)-U10 ADP are
1~8. The relays on the PGD(2)-U10 ADP are numbered 1~8. Refer to Paging,
External in the Electra Elite IPK II Features and Specifications Manual for
additional details.
6.7
A PGD(2)-U10 ADP circuit used for External Paging cannot be used for an
analog Door Box.
Connecting to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP
1.
Make sure the jumper in the PGD(2)-U10 ADP for the channel is set
correctly. (Refer to Figure 7-6 Jumper Settings).
2.
If a line cord was not previously connected to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP,
complete Steps 3~6. Otherwise, skip to Step 7.
3.
Install a modular jack for each PGD(2)-U10 ADP. Run one-pair 24 AWG
station cable from the crossconnect block to a modular jack. Ground the
unused pair.
4.
Terminate the extension leads to GRN/RED of the modular jack.
Terminate the unused leads to the jack.
5.
Install bridging clips as required.
6.
Plug a modular line cord from the mod jack to the CN1 connector on the
PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
7.
Connect the two-conductor station cable from the CN5 connector in the
PGD(2)-U10 ADP to the external relay/external page.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
External Page
CN2 or CN3
Page Control
External Relay
To 8/16
ESIU PCB
AC 117V
CN1
CN2
CN3
Relay 5
Relay 6
PGDAD Module
Page amplification is not provided by the PGD(2)-U10 ADP and must be
accommodated by using an external page amplifier.
Figure 7-14 PGD(2)-U10 ADP Cable Connection
6.8
External Paging And Page Relays
6.8.1
External Page Relays
Two external dry contact relays are available when a PGD(2)-U10
ADP is installed that can be used to activate ancillary devices (i.e.,
door unlock devices). The relays on the PGD(2)-U10 ADP are
numbered 1~8. Each Door Box/external page circuit provides a dry
relay contact.
___________________________________________________________________________________
7 - 16
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.8.2
Connecting a Dry Contact Relay Device to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP
Make sure the jumper in the PGD(2)-U10 ADP for the channel is set
correctly. (Refer to Figure 7-6 Jumper Settings).
1.
If a line cord was not previously connected to the PGD(2)-U10
ADP, complete Steps 2~5. Otherwise, skip to Step 6.
2.
Install a modular jack for each PGD(2)-U10 ADP. Run one-pair
24 AWG station cable from the crossconnect block to a
modular jack. Ground the unused pair.
3.
Terminate the extension leads to GRN/RED of the modular
jack. Terminate the unused leads to the jack.
4.
Install bridging clips as required.
5.
Plug a modular line cord from the mod jack to the CN1
connector on the PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
6.
Connect the two-conductor station cable from the CN5
connectors in the PGD(2)-U10 ADP to the external relay.
6.9
The relay closes when the Door Box/external page zone is
called. The maximum applied voltage is 24vDC at .5A for each
contact.
External Recording System or External Ringer
The PGD(2)-U10 ADP allows for the connection of an external recording system
or external ringer.
1.
Make sure the jumper in the PGD(2)-U10 ADP for the channel is set
correctly. (Refer to Figure 7-6 Jumper Settings).
2.
If a line cord was not previously connected to the PGD(2)-U10 ADP,
complete Steps 3~6. Otherwise, skip to Step 7.
3.
Install a modular jack for each PGD(2)-U10 ADP. Run one-pair 24 AWG
station cable from the crossconnect block to a modular jack. Ground the
unused pair.
4.
Terminate the extension leads to GRN/RED of the modular jack.
Terminate the unused leads to the jack.
5.
Install bridging clips as required.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.
Plug a modular line cord from the mod jack to the CN1 connector on the
PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
7.
Connect an RCA jack to the audio output(s) on the back of the
PGD(2)-U10 ADP.
8.
The opposite end of this cable is connected to the external recording
system or external ringer either directly or by connecting to the
crossconnect block where the item is connected.
External Ringer
OR
External Recording System
CN2 or CN3
To ESIU PCB
CN1
CN2
CN3
PGDAD Module
Figure 7-15 PGD(2)-U10 ADP Cable Connection
___________________________________________________________________________________
7 - 18
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 7
PMS-U10 INTERFACE BOX
With 2000 series software and a PMS-U10, the Elite IPKII can support third party
PMS applications. The PMS-U10 serves as a gateway between the PMS
applications, the Electra Elite IPKII and EliteMail LX voice mails.
Refer to the Electra Elite IPKII Hotel/Motel Services Manual for programming and
configuration instructions.
Figure 7-16 PMS-U10 Front Viewq
Figure 7-17 PMS-U10 Back View
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
7 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 7-1 PMS-U10 Connectors
Connector
Description
COM 1
Used for serial connection to PMS System.
COM 2
Used for serial connection to voice mail.
ETH 0
Used for IP connection to KTS PMS
Configurator software and PMS System.
ETH 1
Not Used.
Default
This pin hole on front of the PMS-U10 has no
label. To default, press and hold with paper
clip, power on unit, wait three seconds and
release.
USB
Not Used.
8-pin Connector
Not Used.
Table 7-2 PMS-U10 LED Indications
LED
Indication
Power
Green when power is On.
ETH 0
Green when connected.
Flashing during data transmission
ETH 1
Not Used.
___________________________________________________________________________________
7 - 20
Installing Electra Elite IPK II KSU Common Optional Equipment
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 8
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ....................................................................................... 8-1
Section 2
Multiline Terminals ......................................................................................... 8-1
2.1
DTR-2DT-1 TEL .......................................................................................... 8-1
2.2
DTR-4D-1 TEL ............................................................................................ 8-3
2.3
DTH-8-1/2 TEL ............................................................................................ 8-4
2.4
DTH-8D-1/2 TEL ......................................................................................... 8-5
2.5
DTH-16-1/2 TEL .......................................................................................... 8-6
2.6
DTH-16D-1/2 TEL ....................................................................................... 8-7
2.7
DTH-16(BL)-1/2 TEL ................................................................................... 8-8
2.8
DTH-16LD-1/2 TEL ..................................................................................... 8-9
2.9
DTH-32D-1 TEL ........................................................................................ 8-10
2.10
ITR-4D-3 TEL ............................................................................................ 8-11
2.11
ITH-8D-2/3 TEL ......................................................................................... 8-12
2.12
ITH-16D-2/3 TEL ....................................................................................... 8-13
2.13
DCR-60-1 Console .................................................................................... 8-14
Section 3
Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the System ........................................ 8-15
Section 4
Applying Power to IP Terminals ................................................................. 8-16
Section 5
Connecting an IP Multiline Terminal to the Network and PC ................... 8-18
Section 6
Connecting the Attendant Console to a Multiline Terminal ..................... 8-20
Section 7
Adjusting the LCD on a Multiline Terminal ................................................ 8-21
Section 8
Installing Line Cards and Plastic Panels ................................................... 8-22
8.1
Installing the Line Card and Plastic Panel ................................................. 8-22
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.2
Removing the Plastic Panel ..................................................................... 8-23
Section 9
Installing a Directory Card on a Multiline Terminal .................................. 8-23
Section 10
Installing a Button Set on a Multiline Terminal ......................................... 8-25
Section 11
Adjusting the Height on a Multiline Terminal ............................................ 8-26
Section 12
Removing or Installing the Base Plate on a Multiline Terminal ............... 8-27
Section 13
12.1
Removing the Base Plate ......................................................................... 8-27
12.2
Installing the Base Plate ........................................................................... 8-28
Wall Mounting Multiline Terminals ............................................................. 8-29
13.1
Section 14
Section 15
Wall Mounting a Multiline Terminal using the Base Plate ........................ 8-29
13.1.1
Adjusting the Hanger Hook ......................................................................... 8-29
13.1.2
Wall Mounting the Telephone ...................................................................... 8-30
13.1.3
Removing the Wall Mounted Multiline Terminal from the Base Plate .......... 8-33
13.1.4
Wall Mounting the Base Plate on a Switch Box ........................................... 8-33
Installing ITH-4D-3 Dterm IPK Terminals ..................................................... 8-35
14.1
Description ............................................................................................... 8-35
14.2
Power Source ........................................................................................... 8-35
14.2.1
AC-2R/AC-3R .............................................................................................. 8-35
14.2.2
Power Over Ethernet (POE) ........................................................................ 8-35
14.3
Connecting the IP Terminal to the System .............................................. 8-36
14.4
Installing Line Cards and Plastic Panels .................................................. 8-37
14.5
Removing the Base Cover ....................................................................... 8-38
14.6
Wall Mounting ITH-4D-3 Multiline Terminals ............................................ 8-40
14.6.1
Using a Switch Box ..................................................................................... 8-40
14.6.2
Installing Base Cover Directly to the Wall .................................................... 8-41
Wall Mounting a Multiline Terminal
using the Wall Mount Unit (WM-R Unit) ..................................................... 8-43
15.1
Removing the Wall Mounted Multiline Terminal
from the Wall Mount Unit .......................................................................... 8-45
15.2
Mounting the Wall Mount Unit on a Switch Box ....................................... 8-46
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List of Figures
Chapter 8
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 8-1
DTR-2DT-1 TEL ......................................................................................................... 8-2
Figure 8-2
DTR-4D-1 TEL ........................................................................................................... 8-3
Figure 8-3
DTH-8-1 TEL Multiline Terminal ................................................................................. 8-4
Figure 8-4
DTH-8D-1 TEL Multiline Terminal .............................................................................. 8-5
Figure 8-5
DTH-16-1 TEL Multiline Terminal ............................................................................... 8-6
Figure 8-6
DTH-16D-1 TEL Multiline Terminal ............................................................................ 8-7
Figure 8-7
DTH-16(BL)-1 TEL Multiline Terminal ........................................................................ 8-8
Figure 8-8
DTH-16LD-1 TEL Multiline Terminal .......................................................................... 8-9
Figure 8-9
DTH-32D-1 TEL Multiline Terminal .......................................................................... 8-10
Figure 8-10
ITR-4D-3 TEL IP Multiline Terminal ......................................................................... 8-11
Figure 8-11
ITH-8D-2/3 TEL Multiline Terminal ........................................................................... 8-12
Figure 8-12
ITH-16D-2/3 TEL Multiline Terminal ......................................................................... 8-13
Figure 8-13
DCR-60-1 Console ................................................................................................... 8-14
Figure 8-14
Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the System ........................................................ 8-15
Figure 8-15
Leading Line Cords on a Multiline Terminal .............................................................8-15
Figure 8-16
Plug in AC-2R/AC-3R Adapter ................................................................................. 8-16
Figure 8-17
Switch SW2 Position ................................................................................................8-17
Figure 8-18
IP Terminal Rear Connector Locations ....................................................................8-18
Figure 8-19
Typical Network IP Connection ................................................................................ 8-19
Figure 8-20
Connecting the DCR Console to a Multiline Terminal ..............................................8-20
Figure 8-21
Connecting the Line Cord and AC Adapter
when Installing a DCR Attendant Console .............................................................. 8-20
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 8-22
Attendant Console and Multiline Terminal ............................................................... 8-21
Figure 8-23
Adjusting the LCD on a Multiline Terminal ............................................................... 8-21
Figure 8-24
Installing Line Card and Plastic Panel on a Multiline Terminal ................................ 8-22
Figure 8-25
Installing Plastic Panel on a DTH/DTR Multiline Terminal ....................................... 8-22
Figure 8-26
Removing the Plastic Panel from the Multiline Terminal .......................................... 8-23
Figure 8-27
Attaching Directory Card to Directory Card Holder .................................................. 8-23
Figure 8-28
Attaching Directory Card Holder to the Multiline Terminal ....................................... 8-24
Figure 8-29
Removing the Button Set from a Multiline Terminal ................................................. 8-25
Figure 8-30
Inserting a New Button Set into a Multiline Terminal ............................................... 8-25
Figure 8-31
Raising the Height on the DTH/DTR/ITH Multiline Terminal .................................... 8-26
Figure 8-32
Lowering the Base Plate on the Multiline Terminal .................................................. 8-26
Figure 8-33
Removing Base Plate ............................................................................................... 8-27
Figure 8-34
Installing Base Plate ................................................................................................. 8-28
Figure 8-35
Removing the Hanger Hook on a Multiline Terminal ................................................ 8-29
Figure 8-36
Sliding the Hanger Hook into Position ...................................................................... 8-29
Figure 8-37
Removing the Cutout ............................................................................................... 8-30
Figure 8-38
Bundling the Line Cord ............................................................................................. 8-30
Figure 8-39
Wall Mounting the Base Plate .................................................................................. 8-31
Figure 8-40
Installing the Multiline Terminal ................................................................................ 8-31
Figure 8-41
Plugging in Line Cord ............................................................................................... 8-32
Figure 8-42
Hiding Excess Cord .................................................................................................. 8-32
Figure 8-43
Removing the Multiline Terminal .............................................................................. 8-33
Figure 8-44
Wall Mounting Base Plate on Switch Box ................................................................ 8-33
Figure 8-45
Wall Mounted Multiline Terminal .............................................................................. 8-34
Figure 8-46
ITH-4D-3 Terminal ................................................................................................... 8-35
Figure 8-47
ITH-4D-3 Power Sources ......................................................................................... 8-36
Figure 8-48
Connecting the Terminal to the System ................................................................... 8-36
Figure 8-49
Removing Plastic Panel ........................................................................................... 8-37
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 8-50
Installing New Line Card ..........................................................................................8-37
Figure 8-51
Connecting Terminal to the System ......................................................................... 8-38
Figure 8-52
Pressing Knob to Release Base Cover ....................................................................8-38
Figure 8-53
Removing Base Cover ............................................................................................. 8-39
Figure 8-54
Lining up Tabs and Slots ..........................................................................................8-39
Figure 8-55
Installing Base Cover ............................................................................................... 8-40
Figure 8-56
Attaching Base Cover to Switch Box ........................................................................8-40
Figure 8-57
Installing Terminal on Base Cover ........................................................................... 8-41
Figure 8-58
Clipping Off Notches ................................................................................................ 8-41
Figure 8-59
Using Screws to Attach Base Cover To Wall ........................................................... 8-42
Figure 8-60
Connecting Terminal to the Base Cover .................................................................. 8-42
Figure 8-61
Attaching the Wall Mount Unit to the Wall ................................................................8-43
Figure 8-62
Attaching the Multiline Terminal to the Wall Mount Unit ........................................... 8-44
Figure 8-63
Plugging in Line Cord ............................................................................................... 8-44
Figure 8-64
Hiding Excess Cord Behind the Wall Mount Unit .....................................................8-45
Figure 8-65
Removing Multiline Terminal from the Wall Mount Unit ........................................... 8-45
Figure 8-66
Mounting Wall Mount Unit on the Switch Box .......................................................... 8-46
Figure 8-67
Wall Mounted Multiline Terminal .............................................................................. 8-46
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
v
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
vi
List of Figures
Installing Electra Elite IPK
Multiline Terminals
Chapter 8
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Electra Elite IPK II system supports several different Multiline Terminals and an
Attendant Console. This chapter describes each terminal and the console and
provides instructions for attaching the terminals to the system and for wall mounting.
SECTION 2
MULTILINE TERMINALS
2.1
DTR-2DT-1 TEL
This digital nondisplay Multiline Terminal has two programmable line keys
(each with a 2-color LED), nine function keys, a built-in speakerphone, and a
large LED to indicate incoming calls and messages. This terminal is available
in black or white.
This terminal has a built-in data port that is available for analog devices. Each
terminal requires a digital port.
The DTR-2DT-1 TEL does not support adapters.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTR-2DT-1 TELs can be installed in the Basic Port
Package. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 239 DTR-2DT-1 TELs can be installed in the Expanded Port
Package. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
240.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 8-1 DTR-2DT-1 TEL
___________________________________________________________________________________
8-2
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.2
DTR-4D-1 TEL
This digital display Multiline Terminal has four multifunction keys, four
programmable line keys (each with a 2-color LED), nine function keys, two
volume keys, four softkeys, a built-in speakerphone, and a large LED to
indicate incoming calls and messages. This terminal is available in black only.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTR-4D-1 TELs can be installed in the Basic Port Package.
The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTR-4D-1 TELs can be installed in the Expanded Port
Package. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
240.
Figure 8-2 DTR-4D-1 TEL
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.3
DTH-8-1/2 TEL
This digital nondisplay Multiline Terminal has eight programmable line keys
(each with a 2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED
to indicate incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-R,
AP(A)-R, AP(R)-R, CT(A)-R, CT(U)-R, or HF-R, Unit. This terminal is
available in black or white.
The DTR-8-1/2 TEL is similar to the DTH-8-1/2 TEL and can also be used with
the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTH-8-1/2 or DTR-8-1/2 TELs can be installed in the
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTH-8-1/2 or DTR-8-1/2 TELs can be installed in the
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 240.
Figure 8-3 DTH-8-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8-4
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.4
DTH-8D-1/2 TEL
This digital Multiline Terminal has eight programmable line keys (each with the
2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED to indicate
incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-R, AP(A)-R,
AP(R)-R, CT(A)-R, CT(U)-R, HF-R, or IP-R Unit. This terminal is available in
black or white.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
The DTR-8D-1/2 TEL is similar to the DTH-8D-1/2 TEL and can also be used
with the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTH-8D-1/2 or DTR-8D-1/2 TELs can be installed in the
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTH-8D-1/2 or DTR-8D-1/2 TELs can be installed in the
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 240.
Figure 8-4 DTH-8D-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8-5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.5
DTH-16-1/2 TEL
This digital nondisplay Multiline Terminal has 16 programmable line keys
(each with a 2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED
to indicate incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-R,
AP(A)-R, AP(R)-R, CT(A)-R, CT(U)-R, or HF-R, Unit. This terminal is
available in black or white.
The DTR-16-1/2 TEL is similar to the DTH-16-1/2 TEL and can also be used
with the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTH-16-1/2 or DTR-16-1/2 TELs can be installed in the
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTH-16-1/2 or DTR-16-1/2 TELs can be installed in the
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 240.
Figure 8-5 DTH-16-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8-6
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.6
DTH-16D-1/2 TEL
This digital Multiline Terminal has 16 programmable line keys (each with a
2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED to indicate
incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-R, AP(A)-R,
AP(R)-R, CT(A)-R, CT(U)-R, HF-R, or IP-R Unit. This terminal is available in
black or white.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
The DTR-16D-1/2 TEL is similar to the DTH-16D-1/2 TEL and can also be
used with the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTH-16D-1/2 or DTR-16D-1/2 TELs can be installed in an
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTH-16D-1/2 or DTR-16D-1/2 TELs can be installed in an
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 240.
Figure 8-6 DTH-16D-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8-7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.7
DTH-16(BL)-1/2 TEL
This digital Multiline Terminal has 16 programmable line keys (each with a
2-color LED), a built-in half-duplex speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED
to indicate incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-R,
AP(A)-R, AP(R)-R, CT(A)-R, CT(U)-R, HF-R, or IP-R Unit. This terminal is
available in black or white.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Back-Lighted (BL)
Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) and four softkeys.
The DTR-16(BL)-1/2 TEL is similar to the DTH-16(BL)-1/2 TEL and can also
be used with the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTH-16(BL)-1/2 or DTR-16(BL)-1/2 TELs can be installed in
an Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals
that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTH-16(BL)-1/2 or DTR-16(BL)-1/2 TELs can be installed
in an Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals
that can be installed is 240.
Figure 8-7 DTH-16(BL)-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8-8
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.8
DTH-16LD-1/2 TEL
This digital Multiline Terminal has 16 programmable line keys, a built-in
speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED to indicate incoming calls and
messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-R, AP(A)-R, AP(R)-R, CT(A)-R,
CT(U)-R, HF-R or IP-R Unit. This terminal is available in black or white.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
This terminal is equipped with two additional 8-character LCDs. These can be
programmed to identify the line key designations.
The DTR-16LD-1/2 TEL is similar to the DTH-16LD-1/2 TEL and can also be
used with the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTH-16LD-1/2 or DTR-16LD-1/2 TELs can be installed in
an Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals
that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTH-16LD-1/2 or DTR-16LD-1 TELs can be installed in an
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 240.
Figure 8-8 DTH-16LD-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8-9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.9
DTH-32D-1 TEL
This digital Multiline Terminal has 32 programmable line keys (each with a
2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED to indicate
incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-R, AP(A)-R,
AP(R)-R, CT(A)-R, CT(U)-R, HF-R, or IP-R Unit. This terminal is available in
black or white.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
The DTR-32D-1 TEL is similar to the DTH-32D-1 TEL and can also be used
with the Electra Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTH-32D-1/DTR-32D-1 TELs can be installed in an Electra
Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be
installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTH-32D-1/DTR-32D-1 TELs can be installed in an
Electra Elite IPK II system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 240.
Figure 8-9 DTH-32D-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 10
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.10
ITR-4D-3 TEL
This IP Multiline Terminal has four programmable line keys (each with a
2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, and a large LED to indicate incoming
calls and messages. This terminal is available only in black.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 ITR-4D-3 TELs can be installed in an Electra Elite IPK II
system. The combined total of all Electra Elite IPK/IP Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 ITR-4D-3 TELs can be installed in an Electra Elite IPK II
system. The combined total of all Electra Elite IPK/IP Multiline Terminals that
can be installed is 240.
AC Adapter is required.
Some headsets introduce hum or echo on IP terminals.
Figure 8-10 ITR-4D-3 TEL IP Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.11
ITH-8D-2/3 TEL
This IP Multiline Terminal has eight programmable line keys (each with a
2-color LED), a built-in full-duplex speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED to
indicate incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-2R. This
terminal is available in black or white.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 ITH-8D-2/3 TELs can be installed in an Electra Elite IPK II
system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 256 ITH-8D-2/3 TELs can be installed in an Electra Elite IPK II
system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
256.
AC Adapter is required.
Some headsets introduce hum or echo on IP terminals.
Figure 8-11 ITH-8D-2/3 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 12
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.12
ITH-16D-2/3 TEL
This IP Multiline Terminal has 16 programmable line keys (each with a 2-color
LED), a built-in full-duplex speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED to
indicate incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with AD(A)-2R. This
terminal is available in black or white.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 ITH-16D-2/3 TELs can be installed in an Electra Elite IPK II
system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 256 ITH-16D-2/3 TELs can be installed in an Electra Elite IPK II
system. The combined total of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
256.
ACR or in-line power is required.
Some headsets introduce hum or echo on IP terminals.
Figure 8-12 ITH-16D-2/3 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.13
DCR-60-1 Console
The Attendant Console has 60 programmable line keys (each with a 2-color
LED). These 60 line keys can be programmed as 48 Direct Station Selection
keys, 12 function keys, or as outside line keys. An AC adapter is required and
provided with the Attendant Console.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 32 DCR-60-1 Consoles can be installed in any Electra Elite IPK
II system. An Attendant Position can have all 32 associated DCR-60-1
Consoles.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 32 DCR-60-1 Consoles can be installed in any Electra Elite IPK
II system. An Attendant Position can have all 32 associated DCR-60-1
Consoles.
Figure 8-13 DCR-60-1 Console
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 14
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 3
CONNECTING A MULTILINE TERMINAL TO THE SYSTEM
This instruction applies to all DTH/DTR/IP Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals except
DTR-2DT-1 TEL.
1.
Plug the telephone cord into the modular jack on the bottom side of the Multiline
Terminal. The handset is also attached to the bottom side of the Multiline
Terminal.
Figure 8-14 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the System
2.
Lead the telephone and handset cords through the applicable grooves.
Figure 8-15 Leading Line Cords on a Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 4
APPLYING POWER TO IP TERMINALS
The ITH-8D/16D-2 terminals support two different methods to power the terminal:
J
AC-2R/AC-3R
Plug the optional AC-2R/AC-3R AC Adapter input Jack in the terminal base unit,
and plug the 2-prong wall plug of the AC Adapter in a standard 120 Vac wall
outlet.
Figure 8-16 Plug in AC-2R/AC-3R Adapter
J
In-Line Power/POE (Power Over Ethernet)
In-Line Power (sometimes called Power Over Ethernet) is a LAN technology
that allows standard 10/100 Base-T data cables to pass electrical current from a
power source to a requesting end device.
Refer to Table 8-1 Power Configuration Switch Settings (ITH-3) and Figure 8-17
Switch SW2 Position to allow different power sources for the ITH-8D/16D-3
terminals.
J
Power Configuration Switch Settings
Table 8-1 Power Configuration Switch Settings (ITH-3)
Power Method
NEC AC Adapter
IEEE 802.3af
Cisco Equipment
(CDP)
Equipment Used
AC-2R, AC-3R
Switch SW2
Position
1
any IEEE 802.3af compliant equipment
Cisco In-Line Power Switches
2
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 16
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 8-17 Switch SW2 Position
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 5
CONNECTING AN IP MULTILINE TERMINAL TO THE NETWORK AND PC
These instructions for connecting an IP Multiline Terminal to the Network and PC
apply to ITH-8D/16D-2/3 Multiline Terminals. Refer to Figure 8-18 IP Terminal Rear
Connector Locations.
1.
Connect the LAN Network 10/100 Base-T cable to the LAN (=) connector.
2.
The IP terminal has a switching HUB to connect a PC to the LAN Network.
Connect the 10/100 Base-T/TX straight cable used for this connection to the
PC(x) connector and to the PC.
Refer to Figure 8-19 Typical Network IP Connection.
REAR VIEW
to LAN
to PC
Note: The PC connector on the IP terminal is exclusively for a PC connection, not a second IP
terminal.
Figure 8-18 IP Terminal Rear Connector Locations
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 18
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
IP
Subscriber
Circuit
LAN
PC
Main Unit
AC-2R/AC-3R Unit
AC Adapter input jack
Not Required when POE or
In-Line Power is available.
Figure 8-19 Typical Network IP Connection
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 6
CONNECTING THE ATTENDANT CONSOLE TO A MULTILINE TERMINAL
An Attendant DCR-60-1 Console can be attached to a Multiline Terminal using the
following procedure.
1.
Place the Multiline Terminal and the Attendant Console face down.
2.
Using the joining plate provided with the Attendant Console, attach the plate to
the Multiline Terminal and the Attendant Console.
Figure 8-20 Connecting the DCR Console to a Multiline Terminal
3.
Connect the line cord and the AC adapter to the indicated locations on the
bottom of the Attendant Console.
Line Cord Jack
AC Adapter Plug
Figure 8-21 Connecting the Line Cord and AC Adapter
when Installing a DCR Attendant Console
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 20
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
When the Attendant Console and the Multiline Terminal are properly connected,
they sit side-by-side as shown in Figure 8-22 Attendant Console and Multiline
Terminal.
Use only the AC adapter, provided with the Attendant Console. Using a different
AC adapter may cause problems. Check that the supplied voltage matches that
specified for the adapter and plug it in an outlet.
Figure 8-22 Attendant Console and Multiline Terminal
SECTION 7
ADJUSTING THE LCD ON A MULTILINE TERMINAL
Electra Elite IPK II display Multiline Terminals have an adjustable Liquid Crystal
Display (LCD). The LCD can be adjusted by pulling up or pushing down as desired.
Figure 8-23 Adjusting the LCD on a Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 21
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 8
INSTALLING LINE CARDS AND PLASTIC PANELS
8.1
Installing the Line Card and Plastic Panel
Line key designations are entered on the line card that is then placed on the
telephone to provide a quick reference of key designations. The line cards
can be changed as necessary. The plastic panel is placed on top of the line
card to hold it in place.
1.
Place the line card over the keys on the Multiline Terminal.
When replacing an existing plastic panel or line card refer to paragraph
8.2 Removing the Plastic Panel.
Line Card
Multiline Terminal
Figure 8-24 Installing Line Card and Plastic Panel on a Multiline Terminal
2.
Place the plastic panel over the line card and push the corners of the
plastic panel until they click into place.
Plastic Panel
Multiline Terminal
Figure 8-25 Installing Plastic Panel on a DTH/DTR Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 22
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.2
Removing the Plastic Panel
Lift up on the plastic panel as illustrated in Figure 8-26 Removing the Plastic
Panel from the Multiline Terminal and remove it from the telephone.
Figure 8-26 Removing the Plastic Panel from the Multiline Terminal
SECTION 9
INSTALLING A DIRECTORY CARD ON A MULTILINE TERMINAL
A directory card can be attached to DTH/DTR/ITH Multiline Terminals. The directory
card can be used to record often dialed numbers or other important information.
1.
After recording the information on the lined insert, reinsert it between the plastic
panels of the directory card. Attach the directory card to the directory card
holder as illustrated in Figure 8-27 Attaching Directory Card to Directory Card
Holder. Note that the open end slides into the directory card holder.
Directory Card
Directory Card
Holder
Figure 8-27 Attaching Directory Card to Directory Card Holder
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 23
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Locate the two grooves on the top of the telephone as illustrated in Figure 8-28
Attaching Directory Card Holder to the Multiline Terminal. Push the directory
card holder into the grooves on the Multiline Terminal until they snap into place.
To remove the directory card, press the two sides of the directory card holder
inward until the tabs release and pull the holder out of the grooves.
Multiline Terminal
Grooves
Directory Card
Holder
Figure 8-28 Attaching Directory Card Holder to the Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 24
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 10
INSTALLING A BUTTON SET ON A MULTILINE TERMINAL
The BS( )-R Unit button set can be installed on a Multiline Terminal to accommodate
French and Spanish languages. The keypad provides the appropriate language
designations.
1.
Remove the plastic cover. (Refer to paragraph 8.2 Removing the Plastic Panel
on page 8-23.)
2.
Pull up on the tab and lift the button pad away from the telephone to remove the
existing button.
Figure 8-29 Removing the Button Set from a Multiline Terminal
3.
Slide the new button set into the grooves located on the inside of the telephone,
then press down on the button set to snap it into place.
Figure 8-30 Inserting a New Button Set into a Multiline Terminal
4.
Insert the line card and plastic panel on the Multiline Terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 25
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 11
ADJUSTING THE HEIGHT ON A MULTILINE TERMINAL
The base plate on the Multiline Terminal is hinged to allow the height of the terminal
to be raised or lowered.
1.
Grasp in the middle of the hollow spaces at the top and pull up until the retaining
tabs click to raise the base plate. Refer to Figure 8-31 Raising the Height on the
DTH/DTR/ITH Multiline Terminal.
Figure 8-31 Raising the Height on the DTH/DTR/ITH Multiline Terminal
2.
After the height is adjusted, pull the line cord though the groove in the bottom of
the Multiline Terminal and adjust it.
3.
Push on the adjustment tabs on the side of the stand and push down to lower
the base plate. Refer to Figure 8-32 Lowering the Base Plate on the Multiline
Terminal.
Figure 8-32 Lowering the Base Plate on the Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 26
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 12
REMOVING OR INSTALLING THE BASE PLATE ON A MULTILINE TERMINAL
DTH/DTR/ITH Multiline Terminals come equipped with a base cover.
12.1
Removing the Base Plate
1.
Extend the base plate to maximum height.
2.
Press the tabs as illustrated in Figure 8-33 Removing Base Plate, and
slide the base cover in the direction of the arrows until it clicks.
Figure 8-33 Removing Base Plate
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 27
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
12.2
Installing the Base Plate
1.
Line up the four tabs on the extended base cover with corresponding
slots on the Multiline Terminal as illustrated in Figure 8-34 Installing
Base Plate.
2.
Slide the cover in the direction of the arrows until it clicks in place.
Figure 8-34 Installing Base Plate
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 28
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 13
WALL MOUNTING MULTILINE TERMINALS
You can wall mount a DTH/DTR/IP connection Multiline Terminal (except for
DTR-2D-1 TEL) using the base cover or an optional wall mount unit. A wall mount
unit must be used if adapters are installed on the Multiline Terminal.
13.1
Wall Mounting a Multiline Terminal using the Base Plate
13.1.1
Adjusting the Hanger Hook
1.
Remove the hook from the unit.
Hanger Hook
Figure 8-35 Removing the Hanger Hook on a Multiline Terminal
2.
Turn the hook with the tab toward the top.
3.
Slide the hook until it glides into position forming the hanger
hook for the handset.
Figure 8-36 Sliding the Hanger Hook into Position
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 29
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
13.1.2
Wall Mounting the Telephone
1.
Extend and remove the base cover from the telephone. Refer
to Section 12 Removing or Installing the Base Plate on a
Multiline Terminal.
2.
Remove cutout shown in Figure 8-37 Removing the Cutout.
Figure 8-37 Removing the Cutout
3.
Plug line cord in the wall receptacle. Leave about eight inches
of cord and bundle the rest as shown in Figure 8-38 Bundling
the Line Cord.
Figure 8-38 Bundling the Line Cord
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 30
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Turn the base cover upside down, feed the line cord through
the cutout and attach the cover to the wall using six screws as
shown in Figure 8-39 Wall Mounting the Base Plate.
Figure 8-39 Wall Mounting the Base Plate
5.
Install the Multiline Terminal over the four tabs on the base
cover, and push down until it clicks in place.
Figure 8-40 Installing the Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 31
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.
Plug the line cord into the Multiline Terminal as illustrated in
Figure 8-41 Plugging in Line Cord.
Figure 8-41 Plugging in Line Cord
7.
Push spare line cord behind the Multiline Terminal as shown in
Figure 8-42 Hiding Excess Cord.
Line Cord
Figure 8-42 Hiding Excess Cord
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 32
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
13.1.3
Removing the Wall Mounted Multiline Terminal from the Base Plate
To remove the Multiline Terminal, press the tabs at the bottom as
shown in Figure 8-43 Removing the Multiline Terminal, and push up
on the Telephone until it comes loose.
Figure 8-43 Removing the Multiline Terminal
13.1.4
Wall Mounting the Base Plate on a Switch Box
1.
Locate the screw holes on the base cover and hang the cover
over the screws on the switch box as illustrated in Figure 8-44
Wall Mounting Base Plate on Switch Box.
Figure 8-44 Wall Mounting Base Plate on Switch Box
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 33
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Hang the Multiline Terminal on the base cover.
Figure 8-45 Wall Mounted Multiline Terminal
Because of strength variation in switch boxes, this method is
not recommended.
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 34
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 14
INSTALLING ITH-4D-3 Dterm IPK TERMINALS
14.1
Description
This Terminal has four programmable line keys (each with a 2-color LED), a
built-in speakerphone, a large LED to indicate incoming calls and messages, a
3-line, 24-character LCD display, and four softkeys. Refer to Figure 8-46
ITH-4D-3 Terminal.
Figure 8-46 ITH-4D-3 Terminal
14.2
Power Source
Two power sources are possible. Refer to Figure 8-47 ITH-4D-3 Power
Sources.
14.2.1
AC-2R/AC-3R
The AC Adapter is not included.
14.2.2
Power Over Ethernet (POE)
Use IEEE802.3af compatible power over Ethernet.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 35
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
AC Adapter
Ethernet
Figure 8-47 ITH-4D-3 Power Sources
14.3
Connecting the IP Terminal to the System
Refer to Figure 8-48 Connecting the Terminal to the System, and connect a
10/100 Base-T/TX cable to each IP terminal and to the networking equipment.
Figure 8-48 Connecting the Terminal to the System
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 36
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
14.4
Installing Line Cards and Plastic Panels
Line key designations are entered on a line card that is placed on the terminal
to provide quick line-key reference. The line card can be changed when
necessary. The plastic panel is placed on top of the line card to hold it in
place. To change line card:
1.
Refer to Figure 8-49 Removing Plastic Panel, and lift up on the plastic
panel to remove it.
Figure 8-49 Removing Plastic Panel
2.
Refer to Figure 8-50 Installing New Line Card, and place new line card
over the keys on the Terminal.
Figure 8-50 Installing New Line Card
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 37
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Refer to Figure 8-51 Connecting Terminal to the System, place the
plastic panel over the Line Card, and push down the corners until they
click into place.
Figure 8-51 Connecting Terminal to the System
14.5
Removing the Base Cover
The height of the Multiline Terminal can be lowered by removing the Base
Cover.
1.
Turn the Multiline Terminal upside down, refer to Figure 8-52 Pressing
Knob to Release Base Cover, and press on the knob to release the Base
Cover.
Figure 8-52 Pressing Knob to Release Base Cover
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 38
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Refer to Figure 8-53 Removing Base Cover, and pull up on the Base
Cover to remove it.
Figure 8-53 Removing Base Cover
3.
To replace the Base Cover, refer to Figure 8-54 Lining up Tabs and
Slots, and line up the tabs and slots.
Figure 8-54 Lining up Tabs and Slots
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 39
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Refer to Figure 8-55 Installing Base Cover, Press down on the base
cover and move it toward the knob until it clicks in place.
Figure 8-55 Installing Base Cover
14.6
Wall Mounting ITH-4D-3 Multiline Terminals
The ITH-4D-3 terminal can be installed on the wall either by using a switch box
or by direct connection.
14.6.1
Using a Switch Box
1.
Remove the Base Cover, and hook it on a switch box as shown
in Figure 8-56 Attaching Base Cover to Switch Box.
Figure 8-56 Attaching Base Cover to Switch Box
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 40
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Attach the terminal to the Base Cover as shown in Figure 8-57
Installing Terminal on Base Cover.
Figure 8-57 Installing Terminal on Base Cover
14.6.2
Installing Base Cover Directly to the Wall
1.
Remove Base Cover and clip off the notches as shown on
Figure 8-58 Clipping Off Notches.
Figure 8-58 Clipping Off Notches
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 41
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Connect the Base Cover to the wall as shown on Figure 8-59
Using Screws to Attach Base Cover To Wall.
Figure 8-59 Using Screws to Attach Base Cover To Wall
3.
Install the terminal on the Base Cover as shown on Figure 8-60
Connecting Terminal to the Base Cover. To remove the
Terminal from the wall, press the knob used to unlatch the base
cover and push the terminal up until it disconnects.
Figure 8-60 Connecting Terminal to the Base Cover
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 42
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 15
WALL MOUNTING A MULTILINE TERMINAL USING THE WALL MOUNT UNIT
(WM-R UNIT)
The Wall Mount Unit is used to attach any DTH/DTR/IP connection Multiline Terminal
(except the DTR-2DT-1 TEL and the ITR-4D-3 TEL) to the wall. This unit connects to
the back side of the telephone.
When adapters are used, the Multiline Terminal must be installed on the wall using
the WM-R Unit.
1.
Plug line cord in the wall receptacle. Leave about eight inches of cord and
bundle the rest.
2.
Feed the line cord through the opening in the wall mount unit as illustrated in
Figure 8-61 Attaching the Wall Mount Unit to the Wall.
3.
Attach the WM-R Unit using six screws.
Figure 8-61 Attaching the Wall Mount Unit to the Wall
4.
Install the Multiline Terminal over the four tabs on the base cover, and push
down until it clicks in place as illustrated in Figure 8-62 Attaching the Multiline
Terminal to the Wall Mount Unit.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 43
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 8-62 Attaching the Multiline Terminal to the Wall Mount Unit
5.
Plug the line cord into the Multiline Terminal as illustrated in Figure 8-63
Plugging in Line Cord.
Figure 8-63 Plugging in Line Cord
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 44
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.
Push spare line cord behind the Multiline Terminal as shown in Figure 8-64
Hiding Excess Cord Behind the Wall Mount Unit.
Figure 8-64 Hiding Excess Cord Behind the Wall Mount Unit
15.1
Removing the Wall Mounted Multiline Terminal from the Wall
Mount Unit
To remove the Multiline Terminal, press the tabs at the bottom as shown in
Figure 8-65 Removing Multiline Terminal from the Wall Mount Unit, and push
up on the Multiline Terminal until it comes loose.
Figure 8-65 Removing Multiline Terminal from the Wall Mount Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
8 - 45
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
15.2
Mounting the Wall Mount Unit on a Switch Box
1.
Locate the screw holes on the wall mount unit and hang the cover over
the screws on the switch box as illustrated in Figure 8-66 Mounting Wall
Mount Unit on the Switch Box.
This method is not recommended because of varied strength of switch
boxes.
Figure 8-66 Mounting Wall Mount Unit on the Switch Box
2.
Hang the Multiline Terminal on the base cover.
Figure 8-67 Wall Mounted Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
8 - 46
Installing Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminals
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 9
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ...................................................................................... 9-1
Section 2
Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation............................... 9-1
Section 3
Installing Adapters ....................................................................................... 9-4
3.1
AC-2R/AC-3R Unit (AC Adapter) ...............................................................9-4
3.1.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
Connecting the AC-2R/AC-3R Unit ..................................................... 9-4
AD(A)-R/AD(A)-2R Unit (Ancillary Device Adapter) ...................................9-6
3.2.1
Connecting Cables to the AD(A)-R Unit ............................................. 9-7
3.2.2
Switch Settings ................................................................................. 9-11
3.2.3
Installing the AD(A)-R Unit on a Multiline Terminal .......................... 9-12
AP(A)-R Unit/AP(R)-R Unit (Port Adapter)...............................................9-14
3.3.1
Switch Settings ................................................................................. 9-15
3.3.2
Installing AP(A)-R or AP(R)-R Unit on a Multiline Terminal .............. 9-16
CT(A)-R Unit (Computer Telephony Adapter)..........................................9-19
3.4.1
Installing the CT(A)-R Unit ................................................................ 9-20
3.4.2
Connecting the CT(A)-R Unit to the PC ............................................ 9-22
3.4.3
Installing the Optional Headset ......................................................... 9-22
3.4.4
Installing the Driver on the PC ..........................................................9-23
CT(U)-R Unit (Computer Telephony Adapter)..........................................9-23
3.5.1
Installing the CT(U)-R Unit ................................................................ 9-24
3.5.2
Connecting the CT(U)-R Unit to the PC ............................................ 9-26
3.5.3
Installing the Optional Headset ......................................................... 9-26
3.5.4
Installing the Driver on the PC ..........................................................9-26
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.6
3.7
3.8
3.9
HF-R Unit (Handsfree Unit) ......................................................................9-27
3.6.1
Installing an HF-R Unit on any DTR/DTH Multiline Terminal
(except DTR-2DT-1 and ITH-8D/16D-2 ............................................ 9-27
3.6.2
Installing the External Microphone ................................................... 9-28
IP-R Unit...................................................................................................9-29
3.7.1
IP-R Unit Specifications .................................................................... 9-29
3.7.2
Applying Power to the IP-R Unit ....................................................... 9-30
3.7.3
Installing the IP-R Unit on the Multiline Terminal .............................. 9-31
3.7.4
Connection Example ........................................................................ 9-35
3.7.5
Quick Setup and Configuration Procedures ..................................... 9-35
PS(A)-R Unit.............................................................................................9-38
3.8.1
Description ........................................................................................ 9-38
3.8.2
Switch Settings ................................................................................. 9-39
3.8.3
LAN/PSTN Selection Switch Operation ............................................ 9-39
3.8.4
Switch Mode Operation .................................................................... 9-40
3.8.5
LCD Display ...................................................................................... 9-41
3.8.6
Installing the PS(A)-R Unit ................................................................ 9-42
Dterm Voice Security Recorder .................................................................9-46
3.9.1
Description ........................................................................................ 9-46
3.9.2
Connection Configuration ................................................................. 9-46
3.9.3
Connectors ....................................................................................... 9-47
3.9.4
Requirements for Installation ............................................................ 9-47
3.9.5
Installation Procedures for Windows 98 or ME ................................. 9-48
3.9.6
Installation Procedures for Windows 2000 or XP ............................. 9-48
3.9.7
VSR Application Software ................................................................ 9-50
3.9.8
VSR User Interface Tab Options ...................................................... 9-51
3.9.9
VSR Playback Tab ........................................................................... 9-51
3.9.10 VSR Record Tab .............................................................................. 9-54
3.9.11 About Tab ......................................................................................... 9-55
3.9.12 Options Tab ...................................................................................... 9-56
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.13 File Management Tab ....................................................................... 9-58
3.9.14 Custom Program Settings .................................................................9-58
3.10
Installing Add on Module (ADM) ..............................................................9-61
3.10.1 Connecting the Interface Unit: ..........................................................9-61
3.10.2 Wall Mounting ADM and Multiline Terminal ...................................... 9-63
3.11
NEC Conference Max™...........................................................................9-65
3.11.1 Description ........................................................................................ 9-65
3.11.2 Installation ......................................................................................... 9-66
3.11.3 Keypad Functions ............................................................................9-66
3.11.4 Programming Options ....................................................................... 9-67
3.11.5 Compliance .......................................................................................9-68
3.12
NEC Push-to-Mute (PTM) or Push-to-Talk (PTT) Handset......................9-69
3.12.1 Description ........................................................................................ 9-69
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
Table of Contents
List of Figures and Tables
Chapter 9
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-1
Raising the Base Plate ............................................................................................... 9-1
Figure 9-2
Removing the Multiline Terminal Base Plate .............................................................. 9-2
Figure 9-3
Modifying Base Plate for Adapter Installation ............................................................. 9-3
Figure 9-4
AC-2R/AC-3R Unit (AC Adapter) ............................................................................... 9-4
Figure 9-5
Connecting the AC Adapter to an Installed Adapter ................................................... 9-5
Figure 9-6
AD(A)-R/AD(A)-2R Unit .............................................................................................. 9-6
Figure 9-7
Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a Recording Device
using an AD(A)-R Unit (Example) .............................................................................. 9-6
Figure 9-8
AD(A)-R Unit Connection without Pause Control .......................................................9-7
Figure 9-9
AD(A)-R Unit Connection with Pause Control ............................................................ 9-7
Figure 9-10
Removing AD(A)-R Unit Cover ................................................................................... 9-8
Figure 9-11
Attaching Cables to the AD(A)-R Unit ........................................................................ 9-8
Table 9-1
AD(A)-R Unit Cable Connections ............................................................................... 9-9
Figure 9-12
AD(A)-R Unit Cable Access Port ..............................................................................9-11
Figure 9-13
AD(A)-R Switch Default Settings ..............................................................................9-11
Table 9-2
AD(A)-R Unit Switch Settings ...................................................................................9-12
Figure 9-14
Attaching the AD(A)-R Unit to the Multiline Terminal ...............................................9-13
Figure 9-15
Connecting a Multiline Terminal to an Analog Telephone
using an AP(A)-R Unit/AP(R)-R Unit (Example) .......................................................9-14
Figure 9-16
AP(A)-R Unit/AP(R)-R Unit Switches .......................................................................9-15
Table 9-3
AP(A)-R/AP(R)-R Unit Switch Settings ....................................................................9-15
Figure 9-17
Attaching the AP(A)-R/AP(R)-R Unit to the Multiline Terminal .................................9-17
Figure 9-18
Installing the Ferrite Core on the AP(A)-R/AP(R)-R Unit ..........................................9-18
Figure 9-19
CT(A)-R Unit .............................................................................................................9-19
Figure 9-20
Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a PC using a CT(A)-R Unit (Example) ..............9-19
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
v
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-21
Attaching the CT(A)-R Unit to the Terminal ............................................................. 9-21
Figure 9-22
Connecting the RS-232C Cable to the CT(A)-R Unit ............................................... 9-22
Figure 9-23
Attaching the Headset to the Multiline Terminal ....................................................... 9-22
Figure 9-24
CT(U)-R Unit ............................................................................................................ 9-24
Figure 9-25
Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a PC using a CT(U)-R Unit (Example) .............. 9-24
Figure 9-26
Attaching the CT(U)-R Unit to the Multiline Terminal ............................................... 9-25
Figure 9-27
Connecting the USB Cable to the CT(U)-R Unit ...................................................... 9-26
Figure 9-28
Attaching the HF-R Unit to the Multiline Terminal .................................................... 9-27
Figure 9-29
Microphone with Mute .............................................................................................. 9-28
Table 9-4
IP-R Unit Specifications ........................................................................................... 9-29
Figure 9-30
IP Terminal Rear Connector Locations .................................................................... 9-30
Figure 9-31
IP-R Unit SW1 Setting for Power Source ................................................................. 9-30
Table 9-5
Switch SW1 Setting for Power Configuration ........................................................... 9-31
Figure 9-32
Raising the Base Plate ............................................................................................. 9-32
Figure 9-33
Removing the Base Plate ......................................................................................... 9-32
Figure 9-34
Removing Cutouts .................................................................................................... 9-33
Figure 9-35
Plugging in the IP-R Unit .......................................................................................... 9-34
Figure 9-36
Attaching the Base Plate .......................................................................................... 9-34
Figure 9-37
Connection Example ................................................................................................ 9-35
Figure 9-38
PS(A)-R Unit ............................................................................................................ 9-38
Table 9-6
PS(A)-R Unit Switch Settings ................................................................................... 9-39
Table 9-7
Selection Switch in LAN ........................................................................................... 9-39
Table 9-8
Selection Switch in PSTN ........................................................................................ 9-40
Table 9-9
IP Telephone Operation when LAN/PSTN Switch is Changed ................................ 9-40
Figure 9-39
LCD Display of Making a Call Through PSTN ......................................................... 9-41
Table 9-10
LCD Display for Each State ..................................................................................... 9-41
Table 9-11
Volume/Contrast Display Using PSTN Line ............................................................. 9-42
Figure 9-40
Raise the Base Stand .............................................................................................. 9-42
___________________________________________________________________________________
vi
List of Figures and Tables
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-41
Remove Base Stand ................................................................................................9-43
Figure 9-42
Remove Covers ........................................................................................................9-43
Figure 9-43
Install PS(A)-R Unit ..................................................................................................9-44
Figure 9-44
Replace Base Stand .................................................................................................9-44
Figure 9-45
Connect Handset and PSTN Line Cords ..................................................................9-45
Figure 9-46
Dterm Voice Security Recorder .................................................................................9-46
Figure 9-47
VSR Connection Configuration ................................................................................9-47
Figure 9-48
Wizard Welcome Screen ..........................................................................................9-48
Figure 9-49
Search and Installation Options ...............................................................................9-49
Figure 9-50
Software Not Compatible Warning ...........................................................................9-49
Figure 9-51
Hardware Update Completed ...................................................................................9-50
Figure 9-52
VSR User Interface Tab Options ..............................................................................9-51
Figure 9-53
VSR Playback Tab ...................................................................................................9-52
Figure 9-54
Caller ID or Comment Editor ....................................................................................9-53
Figure 9-55
View Levels and Control Recording .........................................................................9-54
Figure 9-56
VSR About Tab ........................................................................................................9-55
Figure 9-57
Select VSR Setup Options .......................................................................................9-56
Figure 9-58
Manage Calls at Completion ....................................................................................9-57
Figure 9-59
File Management Tab ..............................................................................................9-58
Figure 9-60
Comvurgent Options for Additional Adjustments ......................................................9-59
Figure 9-61
Customizing Application to Meet Requirements .......................................................9-60
Figure 9-62
ADM Interface Unit ...................................................................................................9-61
Table 9-12
DSW1 Switch Positions ............................................................................................9-62
Figure 9-63
ADM and Multiline Terminal with Base Covers Removed ........................................9-62
Figure 9-64
Installing the Connector Plate ..................................................................................9-63
Figure 9-65
Installing Base Units on the Wall ..............................................................................9-64
Figure 9-66
NEC Conference Max™ ...........................................................................................9-65
Table 9-13
Keypad Functions .....................................................................................................9-66
Table 9-14
Programming Options ..............................................................................................9-67
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
vii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-67
NEC PTM or PTT Handset ....................................................................................... 9-69
___________________________________________________________________________________
viii
List of Figures and Tables
Installing Electra Elite IPK II
Optional Terminal Equipment
Chapter 9
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Electra Elite IPK II system provides several adapters that allow peripheral
equipment to be attached to the Multiline Terminals. This optional equipment
enhances the Electra Elite IPK II system and can be purchased separately as a
customer business grows. Each Multiline Terminal (except DTR-2DT-1) can have up
to two adapters installed at the same time. Only one IP-R Unit or IPW-2U Unit is
allowed per terminal. This chapter describes each adapter and provides applicable
installation instructions.
SECTION 2
PREPARING MULTILINE TERMINAL FOR ADAPTER INSTALLATION
To prepare the Multiline Terminal for adapter installation:
1.
Unplug the telephone line from the terminal.
2.
Grasp in the middle of the hollow spaces at the top and pull up until the retaining
tabs click to raise the base plate. Refer to Figure 9-1 Raising the Base Plate.
Figure 9-1 Raising the Base Plate
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Press down on the tabs indicated in Figure 9-2 Removing the Multiline Terminal
Base Plate, and push forward on the base plate to remove it.
Figure 9-2 Removing the Multiline Terminal Base Plate
4.
When an adapter is installed for the first time, the base cover on the Multiline
Terminal must be modified. Two adapters can be installed in the Multiline
Terminal, and two separate cutouts are provided. Remove the applicable cutout/
cutouts on the bottom of the base plate. When only one adapter is being
installed and it needs an AC-2R/AC-3R Unit for power, remove only the right
cutout as shown in Figure 9-3 Modifying Base Plate for Adapter Installation.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9-2
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Remove for Cable
Connector
Remove for AC
Adapter Plug
Remove for Adapter
Figure 9-3 Modifying Base Plate for Adapter Installation
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 3
INSTALLING ADAPTERS
3.1
AC-2R/AC-3R Unit (AC Adapter)
This unit shown in Figure 9-4 AC-2R/AC-3R Unit (AC Adapter) provides power
to ancillary devices or to an Attendant Console. The AC-2R/AC-3R Unit must
be connected to some adapters that are installed on a Multiline Terminal.
When more than one adapter is installed on a Multiline Terminal, only one
AC-2R/AC-3R Unit is necessary.
Figure 9-4 AC-2R/AC-3R Unit (AC Adapter)
The power requirements for the AC-2R/AC-3R Unit are:
J
J
J
3.1.1
Input: 110~240 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 45 VA
Output: 27 Vdc, 750 mA
Polarity:
⊕
Connecting the AC-2R/AC-3R Unit
1.
Unplug the AC-2R/AC-3R Unit from the AC outlet.
Failing to do this can damage the unit and/or the
Multiline Terminal.
2.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation
on page 9-1.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9-4
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
The Plug Puller shown in Figure 9-4 AC-2R/AC-3R Unit (AC
Adapter) is a hollow cylindrical sleeve with a post and a circular
rim on the base. The plug of the adapter is inserted in this hole,
and the sleeve is pulled over the back of the plug to seat the
post that can then be used to unplug the adapter.
4.
Locate the plug on the ancillary device that is connected to the
bottom of the Multiline Terminal and plug in the AC Adapter.
Figure 9-5 Connecting the AC Adapter to an Installed Adapter
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9-5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.2
AD(A)-R/AD(A)-2R Unit (Ancillary Device Adapter)
This Ancillary Device Adapter, shown on Figure 9-6 AD(A)-R/AD(A)-2R Unit,
allows connection of a tape recorder to all Multiline Terminals except the
DTR-2DT-1. The AD(A)-2R is used with ITH-8D/16D-2 Multiline Terminals.
Figure 9-6 AD(A)-R/AD(A)-2R Unit
Figure 9-7 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a Recording Device using an
AD(A)-R Unit (Example) illustrates how the AD(A)-R Unit is connected to the
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU and to the recording device.
Multiline Terminal + AD(A)-R Unit
ESI
ETU
Line Cord
(2-line)
Figure 9-7
Mini-Plug
Mini-Plug
Connection Cord
Recording
Device
Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a Recording Device using
an AD(A)-R Unit (Example)
When installing the AD(A)-R Unit, connect the cables to the AD(A)-R Unit, set
the dip switches, and then install the AD(A)-R Unit on the Multiline Terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9-6
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.2.1
Connecting Cables to the AD(A)-R Unit
The first step in installing the AD(A)-R Unit is to connect the cables
between the recording device and the AD(A)-R Unit.
Cable terminal connectors are located on the side of the AD(A)-R
Unit. Cables should be connected on this unit before installing the
unit on the Multiline Terminal.
Cables can be connected to determine whether or not pause control
is provided for the recording.
AD(A)-R Unit
Recording
Device
Mini-Plug
Mini-Plug
Connection Cord
Earphone
CN2
Figure 9-8 AD(A)-R Unit Connection without Pause Control
Remote
Mini-Plug
Mini-Plug
Connection Cord
T6 (Shielded Wire)
AD(A)-R Unit
T7 (Wire)
Recording
Device
Mini-Plug
Mini-Plug
Connection Cord
Line In
CN2
Figure 9-9 AD(A)-R Unit Connection with Pause Control
To connect the cables:
1.
Cut off the plug on one end of the cable.
2.
Remove the screw as illustrated in Figure 9-10 Removing
AD(A)-R Unit Cover and open the unit cover.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9-7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Remove Screw
Figure 9-10 Removing AD(A)-R Unit Cover
3.
Locate the adapter terminals on the unit.
4.
Remove the cap on the adapter terminal to expose the metal
receptacle. Push the cable in the applicable receptacle, and
replace the cap. Line up the slot on the cap with the slot on the
metal receptacle to ensure proper contact. Refer to Figure 9-11
Attaching Cables to the AD(A)-R Unit.
Attach the cables to the AD(A)-R Unit according to Table 9-1
AD(A)-R Unit Cable Connections.
Figure 9-11 Attaching Cables to the AD(A)-R Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
9-8
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 9-1 AD(A)-R Unit Cable Connections
Terminal
Number
Cables to Connect
Terminal Specifications
When warning tone is not being
sent from the recorder, connect wire
pair input from tone generator to
T1:T2. The warning tones from the
generator are sent to T1:T2 on a
dedicated wire pair while the
speech path is sent from the
AD(A)-R on T3:T4 over a separate
wire pair to the recorder.
Input Terminal: T1 and T2 are enabled
for tone generating device when
switches SW1-3 and SW1-4 are OFF.
When switches SW1- 3 and SW1-4 are
ON, a humming sound may be recorded
due to impedance mismatch.
Input Impedance on T1 and T2: 100K Ω
Input Level on T1 and T2: –15 dB ~ 40
dB
T3:T4
Connect recorder device wire pair
speech input to T3:T4.
When the recorder used supplies a
warning tone, this tone may also be
sent over the T3:T4 wire pair back
to the terminal.
Input/Output Terminal:
Refer to dip switch settings in Table 9-2
AD(A)-R Unit Switch Settings.
T5
Connect the bare end of the control
cable.
When a Multiline Terminal is idle, this
contact is closed. When the Multiline
Terminal goes off-hook (using the
handset, headset, or speakerphone),
this contact is open.
When recording device owner’s manual
specifies start on open circuit, connect
T5 and T6.
T6
Connect the shielded end of the
control cable.
Provides common connection for
control cable.
T7
Connect the bare end of the control
cable.
When the Multiline Terminal is idle, this
contact is open. When the Multiline
Terminal is busy (using the handset,
headset, or speakerphone), this contact
is closed.
When recording device owner’s manual
specifies start on closed circuit, connect
T6 and T7.
T1
T2
T8
T9
Unused
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9-9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 9-1 AD(A)-R Unit Cable Connections (Continued)
Terminal
Number
Cables to Connect
Terminal Specifications
Notes:
When recording in handsfree (half-duplex) mode using the built-in speakerphone,
the record warning tone may not be audible to the far-end party.
The transmit recording level is lower than the receiving voice level for intercom
calls; the transmit recording level for CO calls is normal.
Depending on the recording device(s), separate cables may be required for the
warning tone and speech path. Then connect the warning tone cables to input
terminals T1 and T2 on the AD(A)-R Unit (T3 and T4 are used as the recording
device input).
When remote control of the recorder is necessary, the record start/stop control is
provided by connecting to T5 (or T7) and T6 on the AD(A)-R Unit. (Connecting to
T5 or T7 is determined by the specifications of the recording device.)
When a warning tone is provided from the recording equipment, it should be input
via T3 and T4 on AD(A)-R Unit. Do not use T1 and T2 to input beep tone.
Conversations cannot be recorded from terminals connected to an AP(R)/
AP(A)-R Unit.
Speakerphone calls through the HF-R Unit cannot be recorded.
5.
Insulate the end of the cable that needs to be shielded with
insulating tape.
6.
Feed the installed cable through the cable access port, located
on the back of the unit, as illustrated in Figure 9-12 AD(A)-R
Unit Cable Access Port.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 10
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Cable Access Port
Cable
Figure 9-12 AD(A)-R Unit Cable Access Port
3.2.2
Switch Settings
The AD(A)-R Unit has two switch locations; SW1/SW2 and the DSW
switches. The location of the switches on the AD(A)-R Unit is
illustrated in Figure 9-13 AD(A)-R Switch Default Settings. The dip
switches (DSW) allow a technician to configure the unit for specific
settings.
Figure 9-13 AD(A)-R Switch Default Settings
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
To provide control to the recorder or to enable/disable the record
start warning tones, refer to Table 9-2 AD(A)-R Unit Switch Settings.
Table 9-2 AD(A)-R Unit Switch Settings
Switch
SW1-1
Connects to Multiline Terminal
Connect = Default
SW1-2
Not Used
SW2-1
Sets External Equipment Impedance to 600 Ω
SW2-2
Used for Complex Impedance Devices
(< 30 Ω Input Impedance)
SW1
SW2
Dip
Switche
s
(DSW)
3.2.3
Description/Settings
DSW 1
Output Hook Signal to External Device
On = Output
Off = No Output (Default)
DSW 2
Record Confirmation Tone
On = Tone On
Off = Tone Off (Default)
DSW 3
and
DSW 4
Use T1/T2
On = Disable (Default)
Off = Enable
DSW 5
Reset Signal Upgrade
On = Normal (Default)
Off = Debugging
DSW
6~8
Firmware Upgrade
On = Firmware Upgrade
Off = Disable (Default)
Do not connect T1 and T2 when DSW switches 3 and 4 are On.
Installing the AD(A)-R Unit on a Multiline Terminal
The AD(A)-R Unit should be installed after the cables are connected
and the switches are set.
1.
If wall mounting the Multiline Terminal, a WM-R Unit must be used.
Refer to Section 13 Wall Mounting Multiline Terminals on page 8-29.
Unplug the telephone cord (and the AC-2R/AC-3R Unit cord if
installed) from the Multiline Terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 12
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Plug the tabs marked A and B into adapter slots, then snap the
tab on the other end of the adapter into the receptacle marked
C. Refer to Figure 9-14 Attaching the AD(A)-R Unit to the
Multiline Terminal.
Figure 9-14 Attaching the AD(A)-R Unit to the Multiline Terminal
3.
Replace the base plate (or wall mount unit) and attach the line
cord. Refer to Section 3 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the
System on page 8-15.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.3
AP(A)-R Unit/AP(R)-R Unit (Port Adapter)
The AP(A)-R Unit Analog Port Adapter without Ringer or the AP(R)-R Unit
Analog Port Adapter with Ringer is used to install a Single Line Terminal,
Modem, Credit Card Reader, Wireless Headset, or other compatible analog
device.
The AP(R)-R Unit generates ringing signals and requires an AC-2R/AC-3R
Unit.
The AP(A)-R Unit or the AP(R)-R Unit can be installed on all Multiline
Terminals except the DTR-2DT-1 and ITH-8D/16D-2.
Figure 9-15 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to an Analog Telephone using an
AP(A)-R Unit/AP(R)-R Unit (Example) illustrates how the AP(A)-R Unit/
AP(R)-R Unit is connected to the ESI(8)-U( ) ETU and to an analog
telephone.
Multiline Terminal + AP(A)-R Unit or AP(R)-R Unit
ESI
ETU
Line Cord (2-line)
Core
Line Cord (2-line)
Analog
Telephone
AC Adapter
(use only with AP(R)-R Unit)
Figure 9-15 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to an Analog Telephone using an
AP(A)-R Unit/AP(R)-R Unit (Example)
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 14
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.3.1
Switch Settings
The AP(A)-R Unit and AP(R)-R Unit have three switch locations.
Refer to Table 9-3 AP(A)-R/AP(R)-R Unit Switch Settings for a
description of each switch and an explanation of the settings.
Figure 9-16 AP(A)-R Unit/AP(R)-R Unit Switches
Table 9-3 AP(A)-R/AP(R)-R Unit Switch Settings
Switch
Description/Settings
SW1-1
Connects to Multiline Terminal (Default).
SW1-2
Not Used
SW3-1
Sets impedance to 600 Ω for devices such as
modems or facsimile machines.
SW3-2
Used for complex impedance devices such as
Single Line Telephones.
SW1
SW3
Dip
Switch
es
(DSW)
DSW
1~8
Leave switches at default.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.3.2
Installing AP(A)-R or AP(R)-R Unit on a Multiline Terminal
The AP(A)-R or AP(R)-R Unit should be installed after the switches
are set.
When wall mounting the Multiline Terminal, a WM-R Unit must be
used. Refer to Section 13 Wall Mounting Multiline Terminals on page
8-29.
1.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation
on page 9-1.
2.
Plug the tabs marked A and B into adapter slots, then snap the
tab on the other end of the adapter into the receptacle marked
C. Refer to Figure 9-17 Attaching the AP(A)-R/AP(R)-R Unit to
the Multiline Terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 16
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-17 Attaching the AP(A)-R/AP(R)-R Unit to the
Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Install the ferrite core (provided with the unit) about two inches
from the line cord plug.
2”
AP(A)-R Unit
or
AP(R)-R Unit
Figure 9-18 Installing the Ferrite Core on the AP(A)-R/
AP(R)-R Unit
4.
Connect the line cord to the unit, limiting the cable length from
the AP(A)/AP(R)-R Unit to the Single Line Telephone to a
maximum of 50 feet.
5.
When only installing the AP(R)-R Unit, plug the AC Adapter
(AC-2R/AC-3R Unit) power cord into the indicated AP(R)-R
Unit receptacle and connect it to a power source. Refer to
Figure 9-5 Connecting the AC Adapter to an Installed Adapter
on page 9-5.
Replace the base plate (or wall mount unit) and attach the line
cord. Refer to Section 3 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the
System on page 8-15.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 18
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.4
CT(A)-R Unit (Computer Telephony Adapter)
The Computer Telephony Adapter, CT(A)-R Unit allows a Multiline Terminal to
be connected to a PC. The PC can perform all Multiline Terminal functions
using a TAPI-compatible application software (Microsoft Telephony
Application Programming Interface).
The Multiline Terminal must be located within five feet (1.5 m) of the PC. An
AC-2R/AC-3R Unit is necessary.
This adapter can be installed on any Multiline Terminal except the DTR-2DT-1
TEL and ITH-8D/16D-2.
Figure 9-19 CT(A)-R Unit
Figure 9-20 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a PC using a CT(A)-R Unit
(Example) shows how the CT(A)-R Unit is connected to the ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
and to the PC. The required AC-2R/AC-3R Unit adapter is not shown.
PC
Multiline Terminal + CT(A)-R Unit
ESI
ETU
Line Cord (2-line)
CT(A)-R Unit
RS-232C Cable (Straight)
[CT(A)-R Unit: D-sub9 Male Pin]
Optional Headset
Figure 9-20 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a PC using a CT(A)-R Unit (Example)
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.4.1
Installing the CT(A)-R Unit
The CT(A)-R Unit should be installed before connecting the PC and
before connecting the ESI port to the Multiline Terminal.
When wall mounting the Multiline Terminal, a WM-R Unit must be
used. Refer to Section 13 Wall Mounting Multiline Terminals on page
8-29.
1.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation
on page 9-1.
2.
Plug the tabs marked A and B into adapter slots, then snap the
tab on the other end of the adapter into the receptacle marked
C. Refer to Figure 9-21 Attaching the CT(A)-R Unit to the
Terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 20
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-21 Attaching the CT(A)-R Unit to the Terminal
3.
Replace the base plate (or wall mount unit) and attach the line
cord. Refer to Section 3 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the
System on page 8-15.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 21
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.4.2
Connecting the CT(A)-R Unit to the PC
Connect RS-232C cable from the PC to the CT(A)-R Unit as shown
in Figure 9-22 Connecting the RS-232C Cable to the CT(A)-R Unit.
Figure 9-22 Connecting the RS-232C Cable to the CT(A)-R Unit
3.4.3
Installing the Optional Headset
Install the headset and anchor it in the cord slot on the Multiline
Terminal as shown in Figure 9-23 Attaching the Headset to the
Multiline Terminal.
Figure 9-23 Attaching the Headset to the Multiline Terminal
Headsets that have open style receivers (i.e., Mirage, Duoset and
Duopro) can cause echo problems on ITH-8D/16D-2 telephones.
The echo suppression and receiver gain of the telephone determines
the severity of the echo when using any headset.
Due to the environment where the telephones or headsets are
located, ambient noise may affect performance. Please contact NEC
for the recommended headset to use with VoIP applications.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 22
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.4.4
Installing the Driver on the PC
Using the download from Web provided with the CT(A)-R Unit install
the driver onto your PC. Refer to the CT(A)-R Unit installation
instructions for installing the driver.
3.5
CT(U)-R Unit (Computer Telephony Adapter)
The CT(U)-R Unit Computer Telephony Adapter allows a Multiline Terminal to
be connected to a PC using the PC USB port.
Connecting using the USB port provides telephony and sound device control.
The general functions of the CT(U)-R Unit include:
J
Telephony Control
The application is based on the Microsoft Telephony Application
Programming Interface (TAPI) and provides call handling on the PC
(e.g., call, answer, hold, transfer, conference, or caller ID).
J
User Interface to Support Dterm Emulation
This interface provides the functions of the Dterm such as normal
telephone indications, LCD, line keys or hookswitch.
J
Sound Support
Allows voice recording or recording playing on an audio device assigned
to a PC. Voice Mail and Live Record are supported on the PC.
J
Plug and Play
An AC-2R/AC-3R Unit is necessary when using this unit.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 23
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
This adapter can be installed on any Multiline Terminal except the DTR-2DT-1
TEL and ITH-8D/16D-2.
Figure 9-24 CT(U)-R Unit
Figure 9-25 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a PC using a CT(U)-R Unit
(Example) shows how the CT(U)-R Unit is connected to the ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
and to the PC. The required AC-2R/AC-3R Unit is not shown.
PC
Multiline Terminal + CT(U)-R Unit
ESI
ETU
Line Cord (2-line)
USB Cable
CT(U)-R Unit
Optional Headset
Figure 9-25 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to a PC using a CT(U)-R Unit (Example)
3.5.1
Installing the CT(U)-R Unit
The CT(U)-R Unit should be installed after the switches are set.
When wall mounting the Multiline Terminal, a WM-R Unit must be
used. Refer to Section 13 Wall Mounting Multiline Terminals on page
8-29.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 24
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
1.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation
on page 9-1.
2.
Plug the tabs marked A and B into adapter slots, then snap the
tab on the other end of the adapter into the receptacle marked
C. Refer to Figure 9-26 Attaching the CT(U)-R Unit to the
Multiline Terminal.
Figure 9-26 Attaching the CT(U)-R Unit to the
Multiline Terminal
3.
Replace the base plate (or wall mount unit) and attach the line
cord. Refer to Section 3 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the
System on page 8-15.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 25
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
3.5.2
Attach the AC-2R/AC-3R to the CT(U)-R Unit. Refer to Figure
9-5 Connecting the AC Adapter to an Installed Adapter on page
9-5.
Connecting the CT(U)-R Unit to the PC
Connect USB cable from the PC to the CT(U)-R Unit as shown in
Figure 9-27 Connecting the USB Cable to the CT(U)-R Unit.
Figure 9-27 Connecting the USB Cable to the CT(U)-R Unit
3.5.3
Installing the Optional Headset
Install the headset and anchor it in the cord slot on the Multiline
Terminal as shown in Figure 9-23 Attaching the Headset to the
Multiline Terminal on page 9-22.
3.5.4
Installing the Driver on the PC
Using the download from Web with the CT(U)-R Unit install the driver
on your PC. Refer to the CT(U)-R Unit installation instructions for
installing the driver.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 26
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.6
HF-R Unit (Handsfree Unit)
The Handsfree Unit provides full-duplex handsfree communication for a
desktop user. Large or enclosed areas may cause poor full-duplex operation.
This unit comes with the handsfree adapter and an external microphone unit.
This adapter can be installed on any DTR/DTH Multiline Terminal except
DTR-2DT-1 and ITH-8D/16D-2.
3.6.1
Installing an HF-R Unit on any DTR/DTH Multiline Terminal (except
DTR-2DT-1 and ITH-8D/16D-2
1.
With terminal upside down, facing from the bottom of the open
cover, install this unit in terminal adapter Slot 1.
Figure 9-28 Attaching the HF-R Unit to the Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 27
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.6.2
2.
Plug the tabs marked A and B into adapter slots, then snap the
tab on the other end of the adapter into the receptacle marked
C. Refer to Figure 9-28 Attaching the HF-R Unit to the Multiline
Terminal.
3.
Replace the base plate (or wall mount unit) and attach the line
cord. Refer to Section 3 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the
System on page 8-15.
Installing the External Microphone
An external microphone can be installed on the HFU-U Unit. These
instructions apply to the external microphone obtained from NEC.
The microphone is equipped with a locking mute button and a red
LED indicator that is off when the microphone is in mute.
Figure 9-29 Microphone with Mute
1.
Plug the microphone cord into the jack on the HF-R Unit.
The microphone should be one~three feet away from the
Multiline Terminal with the Mic grate facing the user.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 28
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.7
IP-R Unit
The Elite IP-R Unit allows connection to an IAD(8)-U( ) ETU with a MEGACO
Station Package in the Electra Elite IPK II.
Installing the IP-R Unit in the plug-in socket located at the bottom of the
Terminal transforms a DTH Multiline Terminal into an IP station. The user can
also connect a PC to the LAN through an RJ-45 Ethernet jack on the IP-R Unit
that acts as a switching hub.
Any Terminal (8D/16D/32D-1) with an IP-R Unit installed, in conjunction with
the IAD(8)-U() ETU (MEGACO Station Package), enables IP Telephony
stations for the Electra Elite IPK II System. The IP stations can provide
connectivity with the Corporate Elite over the local LAN (Ethernet).
3.7.1
IP-R Unit Specifications
Refer to Table 9-4 IP-R Unit Specifications.
Table 9-4 IP-R Unit Specifications
Feature
Specification
Interface
10/100 Base-T (IEEE 802.3), RJ-45
Protocol
Voice (UDP, RTP, and RTCP)
Signal (TCP, H.225 and H.245)
Jitter Buffer
Max 90 ms
Quality of Station (QOS)
Network Managed switches supporting Type
of Service (TOS) field and VLAN support
Local Power
27 V 750 mA via AC Adapter Base
Applications
TFTP (Client), DHCP Client, Megaco (H.248)
Standards
UL1459, FCC Part 68
Voice Specifications
G.711 (PCM Mu-law/A-law) G.729
Mountable Dterm
Dterm 8D, 16D, 32D-type telephone
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 29
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.7.2
Applying Power to the IP-R Unit
Power is provided to the IP-R Unit using an AC-2R/AC-3R Unit or
Power Over the Ethernet.
Figure 9-30 IP Terminal Rear Connector Locations
J
AC-2R/AC-3R Unit (AC Adapter)
Plug the optional AC-2R/AC-3R Unit input jack in the AC
Adapter connection shown in Figure 9-30 IP Terminal Rear
Connector Locations.
J
Power over the Ethernet (POE)
POE sometimes called In-Line Power, is a LAN technology that
allows standard 10/100 Base-T data cables to pass current
from a power source to a requesting-end device. Refer to
Figure 9-31 IP-R Unit SW1 Setting for Power Source.
Figure 9-31 IP-R Unit SW1 Setting for Power Source
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 30
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
The IP-R Unit switch SW1 indicates to the system how the
adapter is powered.
To set Switch SW1 for the applicable power source, refer to
Table 9-5 Switch SW1 Setting for Power Configuration.
Table 9-5 Switch SW1 Setting for Power Configuration
Switch
(SW1)
Setting
s
Power Method
AC Adapter
NEC POE Equipment
3.7.3
NEC AC-2R/AC-3R AC
Adapter (27V, 750 mA)
H
1
2
(Default)
Equipment Used
CICSO Equipment
(CDP)
H
H
H
NEC Power Patch Panel
SN1604 PRWMS (Stock
No. 59022)
NEC BF200/24 POE
Switching Hub
Cisco Catalyst PRW
Series
Cisco Powered Patch
Panel
Installing the IP-R Unit on the Multiline Terminal
The IP-R Unit can be installed on any DTH-8D/16D/32D-1/2 Multiline
Terminal as shown below.
1.
Unplug the telephone line from the terminal. Turn the terminal
upside down, press the areas indicated on the diagram and
raise the base plate until the retaining tabs click.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 31
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-32 Raising the Base Plate
2.
Press down on the tabs as shown in Figure 9-33 Removing the
Base Plate and push the base plate forward to remove it.
Figure 9-33 Removing the Base Plate
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 32
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
When an IP-R Unit is installed for the first time in a terminal, the
base cover on the Multiline Terminal must be modified as
shown in Figure 9-34 Removing Cutouts. Remove all cutouts
on the bottom and back of the terminal base plate before
installing the IP-R Unit.
Figure 9-34 Removing Cutouts
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 33
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Plug the IP-R Unit in Connector 1 on the Multiline Terminal
(DTH-8D/16D/32D-1/2) as shown in Figure 9-35 Plugging in
the IP-R Unit.
IP-R Unit
Optional
Connector
Connector 1
Figure 9-35 Plugging in the IP-R Unit
5.
Attach the base plate by lining up the four tabs on the base
cover with corresponding slots on the terminal as shown in
Figure 9-36 Attaching the Base Plate, and slide the cover in the
direction of the arrows until it clicks in place.
Figure 9-36 Attaching the Base Plate
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 34
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.7.4
Connection Example
Refer to Figure 9-37 Connection Example.
Personal Computer
Note 1
Electra Elite IPK II
LAN/WAN
IAD(8)-U( ) ETU
Megaco Station
LAN Connection
(Straight) Note 2
Connector for PC Connection
AC Adapter Connection
AC Adapter
Note 1:
The IP-R Unit is equipped with a switching Hub function, enabling connection to personal
computers.
Note 2:
When using 10 Base-T, a straight cable category 3 or higher is required (maximum length 100
meters). When using 100 Base-TX, a straight cable category 5 or higher is required (maximum
length 100 meters).
Figure 9-37 Connection Example
3.7.5
Quick Setup and Configuration Procedures
This section provides step-by-step procedures for setting up and
configuring the IP-R Unit.
1.
Connect the LAN port of the IP-R Unit to the network and the
PC port to an optional PC at your workstation. Plug in the
AC-R Unit.
2.
The IP-R Unit automatically attempts to locate the DHCP
server when powered up. Wait until the server lookup times
out, and DHCP Server is Not Found is displayed on the
terminal, and then begin programming.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 35
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Press Hold, Transfer,,, and # to enter the basic programming
mode.
4.
The Programming Menu is displayed. Press 1 to display the
Network Settings options. This enables you to configure IP
settings for IP Terminals.
5.
Press 1 (DHCP mode is displayed). Press the corresponding
digit (1 or 2) to enable or disable DHCP mode; then press the
softkey that corresponds to Set on the LCD.
6.
When DHCP is not used (Static IP assignment), select 1
(Disable), then select Set, and proceed to step 7. When DHCP
is used, select 2 (Enable - factory default) and proceed to step
10.
7.
From the Network Settings option, press 2 and enter the IP
Address (XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX); then press the softkey
that corresponds to Set on the LCD.
8.
From the Network Settings option, press 3 and enter the
Subnet Mask (XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX); then press the softkey that
corresponds to Set on the LCD.
9.
From the Network Settings option, press 4 and enter the Router
IP Address (XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX); then press the softkey that
corresponds with Set on the LCD. To return to Programming
Menu, press the softkey that corresponds to Prev on the LCD.
10.
Press 2 from the Programming Menu to access the MGC
(Media Gateway Controller) IP Address and enter the IP
Address for IAD(8)-U( ) or PVA ETU Megaco Station
(XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX); then press the softkey that corresponds
to Set on the LCD.
11.
Press 3 from the Programming Menu to access the Extension
Number option. Enter the extension number and press the
softkey that corresponds to Set on the LCD.
12.
The extension number is used to register the IP terminal with
the IAD(8)-U( ) Megaco Station Card or PVA ETU. These
settings must match the Electra Elite IPK II Programming
Station Number Assignment in PRG 11-02. This entry is
required if DHCP mode is enabled.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 36
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
13.
Press 9 from the Programming Menu to access Advanced
Settings option.
14.
Select 3, DRS Settings.
15.
Select 1, DRS Mode, and Disable this function.
This function must be Disabled prior to saving the
configuration.
16.
Select Save; the system stores the new configuration and
performs a software reset.
17.
After the unit performs the software reset, the IP-R Unit
searches for the MGC. After the unit locates the MGC, the
terminal LCD restores the system time and the softkeys for
System, Station, Up, and Down are restored.
18.
The ITH 8D/16D-2 Telephone or the IP-R Unit installed is now
ready for operation.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 37
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.8
PS(A)-R Unit
3.8.1
Description
The PS(A)-R Unit, an optional adapter for the ITH/ITR-3 Terminals,
is used with IP telephones to make or receive a call using the Public
Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) when a call cannot be made or
received using the Local Area Network (LAN). When a power failure
occurs, the IP telephone is automatically switched to the PSTN.
When power is restored, the IP telephone restarts and connects to
the network unless a conversation is in progress on PSTN. The
PSTN call must be completed by going On-hook before the
connection to the LAN is restored. Refer to Figure 9-38 PS(A)-R
Unit.
Handset Connection
LAN/PSTN Switch
PSTN Line Connection
Receive Volume Control
Figure 9-38 PS(A)-R Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 38
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.8.2
Switch Settings
Refer to the following table.
Table 9-6 PS(A)-R Unit Switch Settings
Switch
Position 1
Position 2
LAN/PSTN Selection Switch
Out – LAN
In – PSTN
SW3: Mode
Dial Pulse
DTMF
SW1: Pulse Rate
20 pps
10 pps
SW2: Make Rate
33%
40%
Three position volume control
Receive Volume Control
3.8.3
Use maximum
position for hearing
impaired only.
Otherwise hearing
damage may
occur.
LAN/PSTN Selection Switch Operation
When power is active, the user can manually select either a Local
Area Network (LAN) or Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN)
communication path using this switch. When power failure occurs, a
LAN path is automatically changed to PSTN. Refer to Table 9-7
Selection Switch in LAN.
Table 9-7 Selection Switch in LAN
Power
Active
Power
Failure
Power
Restored
IP
PSTN
IP
Network Failure
IP*
PSTN
IP*
Network Power
Restored
IP
PSTN
IP
Normal
IP-Network State
* IP can communicate when changed to PSTN.
When selection switch is in PSTN, the communication path is always
connected to PSTN. Refer to Table 9-8 Selection Switch in PSTN.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 39
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 9-8 Selection Switch in PSTN
IP-Network State
3.8.4
Power
Active
Power
Failure
Power
Restored
Normal
PSTN
PSTN
PSTN
Network Failure
PSTN
PSTN
PSTN
Network Power
Restored
PSTN
PSTN
PSTN
Switch Mode Operation
Refer to Table 9-9 IP Telephone Operation when LAN/PSTN Switch
is Changed.
Table 9-9 IP Telephone Operation when LAN/PSTN Switch is Changed
Mode
Changed from LAN to PSTN
Changed from PSTN to LAN
Idle
Sending/receiving IP packets
stops. PSTN usage is displayed on
the LCD.
Resets.
Communication
Sending/receiving IP packets
stops. PSTN usage is displayed on
the LCD. Communication Stops
and DT is sent from PSTN.
Resets when communication ends.
Ring
Sending/receiving IP packets
stops. PSTN usage is displayed on
the LCD. Ringing stops.
Stops ringing and resets.
Configuration
Continue normal operation. Does
not change to PSTN.
Cannot change until PSTN
conversation ends.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 40
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.8.5
LCD Display
When power is on, the IP telephone displays the characters shown
on Figure 9-39 LCD Display of Making a Call Through PSTN. Refer
to Table 9-10 LCD Display for Each State.
012345678901234567890123
****************************
* LINE → PSTN
*
*****************************
¢
¢
¢
¢
Figure 9-39 LCD Display of Making
a Call Through PSTN
Table 9-10 LCD Display for Each State
Power State
Switch in PSTN
Switch in IP
Active
LINE → PSTN
Normal Display
Failure
–
Restored
LINE → PSTN
–
Normal Display
The IP telephone displays volume/contrast for HANDSET,
SPEAKER, RING, OFF-HOOK RING, LCD, or BGM when operating
in D80/85 mode. However, when using a PSTN line only LCD
contrast is displayed. Refer to Table 9-11 Volume/Contrast Display
Using PSTN Line.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 41
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 9-11 Volume/Contrast Display Using PSTN Line
Volume/
Contrast
Display
HANDSET
None [Volume is controlled by PS(A)-R.]
SPEAKER
None (Cannot be used for PSTN line.)
RING
None [Volume controlled by PS(A)-R switch.]
OFF-HOOK
RING
None (Cannot be used for PSTN line.)
LCD
LCD contrast
BGM
None (Not Used)
3.8.6
Installing the PS(A)-R Unit
1.
Turn over the ITR terminal, remove the LAN and headset
cables, and disconnect the AC adapter when it is being used.
2.
Raise the Base stand in the direction of the arrow until it locks
in the fully expanded position.
Figure 9-40 Raise the Base Stand
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 42
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Press down the tabs, and slide the base stand in the direction
of the arrows to remove it.
Figure 9-41 Remove Base Stand
4.
Cut off the notches on the base stand with wire clippers, and
remove the covers on the rear and bottom side of the unit.
Remove for
Handset Plug
Remove for Cable
Connector
Remove for
Adapter
Figure 9-42 Remove Covers
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 43
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.
Hook tabs A and B of the PS(A)-R Unit in the grooves and
press down until it seats.
Figure 9-43 Install PS(A)-R Unit
6.
Line up the four tabs of the base stand with the corresponding
slots on the terminal, and slide the stand in the direction of the
arrows until it clicks in place.
Figure 9-44 Replace Base Stand
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 44
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.
Insert the handset cord and the PSTN line cord in the
connector slots.
Figure 9-45 Connect Handset and PSTN Line Cords
8.
Connect the LAN cable to the IP terminal. When the AC
adapter is required, plug it in the outlet after connecting the
LAN cable.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 45
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9
Dterm Voice Security Recorder
3.9.1
Description
The VSR Extension Recorder is a Universal Serial Bus (USB) device
that taps across the digital extension pair of a Dterm Digital extension
port and includes software that enables the user to manage stored
calls. VSR hardware connects in-line at the user desktop. Power is
not required because the connection is a metallic wiring of the in and
out connections. The recorder does nothing to affect operation of the
Digital Telephone.
This device meets all applicable FCC and UL requirements for this
type of communication device.
Figure 9-46
3.9.2
Dterm Voice Security Recorder
Connection Configuration
The configuration connection is shown in Figure 9-47 VSR
Connection Configuration.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 46
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.3
Connectors
J
J
One PC USB connector that provides power and streams all
speech and control channel information to the host PC and
desktop software.
Two digital telephone line connections that passively tap
across the Dterm digital connection and listen in high
impedance mode to the signaling on the line.
Dterm Telephone
IPK II KSU
VSR
USB
Computer
Figure 9-47 VSR Connection Configuration
3.9.4
Requirements for Installation
The VSR is packaged with everything necessary for installation
including:
J
J
J
J
Software CD
USB Cable
Telephone connection lead
Quick-start installation manual
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 47
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.5
3.9.6
Installation Procedures for Windows 98 or ME
1.
Run the Setup.exe program file from the NEC installation CD
before connecting the telephone interface unit to your PC.
2.
Connect the VSR USB interface connector to your PC using
the provided USB cable.
3.
Connect your telephone to either VSR port.
4.
Connect the other VSR port to the telephone system, and
recording is enabled.
Installation Procedures for Windows 2000 or XP
1.
Using the provided USB cable, connect the VSR USB interface
to your PC.
2.
Windows automatically detects the new hardware and displays
a Wizard dialog box.
3.
Select Install from a list or specific location (Advanced), and
select next.
Figure 9-48 Wizard Welcome Screen
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 48
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
The next screen is displayed.
Figure 9-49 Search and Installation Options
5.
If files were downloaded from the Internet, uncheck Search
Removable Media, and check Include this location in the
search, and enter the location where the downloaded files are
to be stored (e.g., C:\My Documents).
6.
Select next and the next screen is displayed.
Figure 9-50 Software Not Compatible Warning
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 49
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.
The software is fully tested, but has not been sent to Microsoft
for approval. Select Continue anyway and the next screen is
displayed.
Figure 9-51 Hardware Update Completed
3.9.7
8.
The necessary device drivers are installed.
9.
Select Finish to close the dialogue.
10.
Now run Setup.exe on your NEC installation CD to install
necessary application software on your PC.
11.
Connect your telephone to the VSR ports, and you are ready to
record.
VSR Application Software
The VSR software is delivered on a Compact Disk using a
self-starting install shield. The CD contains all applicable files and
installation procedures to operate to this specification, including USB
device drivers, software application, and Help files.
A quick-start instruction sheet and a pre-recorded user guide that
steps the user through the various options are provided.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 50
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
The VSR application supports Microsoft Operating Systems that
support USB devices. The following systems meet this requirement:
J
J
J
J
3.9.8
WIN 98SE
WIN Millennium Edition (ME)
WIN 2000
WIN XP (all variants)
VSR does not support WIN 95 and below, or WIN NT.
VSR User Interface Tab Options
VSR has the following tabs to allow the user to select features and
options:
J
J
J
J
J
Playback allows various playback features of recorded
conversations.
Record allows control of recording.
About provides software version information.
Options to set-up controls such as recording format.
File Management allows the user to manage disk space used
by the VSR.
Figure 9-52 VSR User Interface Tab Options
3.9.9
VSR Playback Tab
This tab allows the user to list and play recorded conversations. A
graphical presentation of the volume level of the call with a cursor to
indicate the current playback position is displayed. The cursor can
be dragged forward or backward to allow rapid selection of the
applicable section.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 51
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-53 VSR Playback Tab
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 52
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-54 Caller ID or Comment Editor
The user can edit the Caller ID or the Comments field when viewing
an existing recording.
Caller ID and number dialed are not available on the first release.
Check with NEC for release date.
The user can list recordings in order of importance (using
exclamation mark) with Caller ID, Time + Date, or duration.
The Caller ID and Comment buttons allow the user to filter out all
recordings with the required Caller ID or text in the Comments field.
Playback, pause and stop buttons allow the user to control the
Playback.
The Red exclamation mark allows recording to be identified as
important for future listing or ensures that the recording cannot be
overwritten.
The Red X allows recordings to be manually deleted.
The envelope button generates an e-mail with the recording inserted
for mailing to a colleague.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 53
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.10
VSR Record Tab
This tab allows the user to view recording levels and control the
recording.
Figure 9-55 View Levels and Control Recording
The Oscilloscope shows the local and remote levels on the line
separately (Microphone is the user level, and speaker is the distant
party level).
The Caller ID field is for future versions, but information can be
entered or overwritten by the user.
Manual Start, Stop, and Pause buttons control the recording status.
The user can add notes and mark important recordings with an
exclamation point to avoid deleting the conversation.
The camera button allows a user to snapshot record conversation to
the current point while continuing to record the entire conversation.
This feature is important for emergency centers to allow an operator
to quickly reply to an important part while continuing to record.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 54
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.11
About Tab
This tab provides version and manufacturer information.
Figure 9-56 VSR About Tab
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 55
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.12
Options Tab
This tab allows the user to select various setup options of the VSR.
Figure 9-57 Select VSR Setup Options
J
Automatically start recording every call
Starts the recording when a call, including an internal extension
call, is made.
J
Recorded format
Perfect Digital Recording stores the recording in PCM format
taken directly from the digital line. But the highest quality
requires significant space (35 hours per Gbyte) on the PC disk.
GSM 06.10 uses a compression technique to store 168 Hours
per Gbyte. The quality difference is negligible so this becomes
the default selection.
J
Show dialog when recorder starts
Selecting this default option brings the Record tab to the front
of the user screen when record is activated.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 56
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
Call Selection
Saves all calls or only those that exceed an established limit.
J
Show splash screen at startup
When selected, the VSR logo is shown for five seconds when
the application is started.
J
Email format
Allows the user to select the type of file inserted in an e-mail
when the user selects the e-mail button on the Playback Tab to
send the VSR format to other users that have this application or
to convert it to a .wav format for replay by any PC.
Dterm VSR selection automatically adds the Caller ID, time,
date and comments fields to any e-mail.
J
Prompt for call information at the start of each call
When selected, the Record screen is displayed when a call is
made to allow the user to enter information.
J
Prompt for call information at the end of each call
When selected, the screen shown below is displayed to allow
the user to manage calls at the point of completion. The user
can save or erase the call, add notes, or mark important calls
using the red key shown below.
Figure 9-58 Manage Calls at Completion
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 57
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.13
File Management Tab
File management is necessary when the user makes many
telephone calls and stores each conversation. The selections are
self-explanatory.
Figure 9-59 File Management Tab
3.9.14
Custom Program Settings
Comvurgent provides the dealer or user the option of making
additional adjustments.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 58
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-60 Comvurgent Options for Additional Adjustments
This special configuration program can only be accessed by
browsing to the installation location (default C:\Program
Files\Comvurgent\XtRecorder), and then click on the NEC Dterm
Config.exe.
The customer takes all responsibility to ensure they meet legal
requirements. Comvurgent provides the user option settings to meet
customer demands and cannot be responsible for misapplication of
the product.
Several settings can be customized to meet requirements of the
application as shown in Figure 9-61 Customizing Application to Meet
Requirements.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 59
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-61 Customizing Application to Meet Requirements
J
Display splash screen at the start of every call
Reminds user that recording is taking place by splashing a
screen with every call.
J
Show Dterm Recorder dialog at the start of every call
Displays application record screen anytime a call is being
recorded.
J
Prevent users of this station from deleting calls
Disables the delete key.
J
Prevent users of this station from pausing or halting recording
Disables pause and stop controls.
J
Hide the system tray icon for invisible recording
Hides the small icon that appears in the system tray and
flashes red when recording.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 60
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
Password
Locks access to these settings and those at the user level.
3.10
When making changes, the application must be closed and
started again to become effective.
Installing Add on Module (ADM)
The D16(LD)-R ADM creates a 16 button Phonebook directory. The interface
for this unit shown in Figure 9-62 ADM Interface Unit is connected in the right
adapter connector for the applicable multiline terminal. When another adapter
needs to be added, this interface must be moved to the left adapter connector
to preserve the cable integrity.
DSW1
ON
O N
DSW1
Position
3
1
1 2
3 4
5 6
7
8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Figure 9-62 ADM Interface Unit
3.10.1
Connecting the Interface Unit
1.
Set DSW1 to the pattern for the applicable multiline terminal as
shown in Table 9-12 DSW1 Switch Positions on the next page.
2.
Place the ADM and multiline terminal upside down and remove
the Base Units.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 61
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 9-12 DSW1 Switch Positions
Series
Keyset Name
DSW1 Switch Positions
DSW1
ON
Dterm Series i
DTR/H-(8)/(16)D-2( ) TEL
DTR/H -16LD-2( ) TEL
DTR/H-16D(BL)-2( ) TEL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3.
Plug the interface unit into the right adapter connection as
shown on Figure 9-63 ADM and Multiline Terminal with Base
Covers Removed on the next page.
Figure 9-63 ADM and Multiline Terminal with Base Covers Removed
4.
Place the interface unit cable in the cable channels on the ADM
and multiline terminal.
5.
Install the connector plate provided with the ADM as shown in
Figure 9-64 Installing the Connector Plate on the next page.
The connector plate cannot be used with Inaset terminals.
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 62
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-64 Installing the Connector Plate
6.
3.10.2
Replace the base units as shown in Figure 9-63 ADM and
Multiline Terminal with Base Covers Removed.
Wall Mounting ADM and Multiline Terminal
1.
Remove both Base Units.
2.
Remove the Multiline Terminal Base Unit cutout shown in
Figure 9-65 Installing Base Units on the Wall.
3.
Install the base units on the wall using the eight screws.
4.
Install the ADM and Multiline Terminal as shown on Figure 9-63
ADM and Multiline Terminal with Base Covers Removed.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 63
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 9-65 Installing Base Units on the Wall
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 64
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.11
NEC Conference Max™
3.11.1
Description
This expandable conferencing telephone provides premium,
full-duplex audio to small conference rooms as a single unit or to
larger rooms when expanded by up to three units that also expand
microphone access and loudspeaker coverage with even distribution
of sound.
Figure 9-66 NEC Conference Max™
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 65
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.11.2
3.11.3
Installation
1.
Connect the provided 25’ Cat. 5 cable between the LINK OUT
jack of the base unit and the LINK IN jack of the conferencing
pod.
2.
Connect the provided RJ-11 cable between the base unit and
the telephone jack.
3.
Connect the power cord to the base unit and plug it in an
electrical outlet.
4.
To connect additional units, connect a 12’ Cat. 5 cable between
the LINK OUT jack of the unit connected to the base unit and
the LINK IN jack of the second unit and repeat the connection
of another 12’ Cat. 5 cable between the LINK OUT jack of each
unit to the LINK IN of the next unit in sequence.
Keypad Functions
Refer to Table 9-13 Keypad Functions.
Table 9-13 Keypad Functions
Key
Function
ON/OFF key
(telephone icon)
Press to activate the telephone and access dial tone.
Press again to hang up and return to standby mode.
PHONEBOOK (book
icon)
Press to dial stored numbers. Press and hold two
seconds to enter Phonebook Edit mode.
REDIAL (circular arrow
icon)
Press once to dial the last number called. Press and
hold two seconds to enter Program mode.
CONFERENCE (three
person icon)
Press to dial the conferencing service provider. This
feature must be programmed.
FLASH (lightning flash
icon)
Press to enable call forwarding, call waiting, or
three-way calling when supported by telephone
service.
CLEAR ( vertical line
and left arrow icon)
Press to clear the last digit entered or press and hold to
clear all numbers.
Press to exit programming mode.
VOLUME (loud and
dim speaker icons)
Press during call to adjust call volume or press while
telephone is ringing or in standby mode to adjust ringer
volume.
MUTE (mike with
diagonal line icon)
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 66
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.11.4
Programming Options
To enter Programming mode, press and hold REDIAL until a
diamond arrow is displayed on the LCD. Then press the applicable
key and follow the instruction in Table 9-14 Programming Options.
Table 9-14 Programming Options
Menu Option
Key
Programming
Ringer Melody
1
Press REDIAL. The current melody selection
flashes. Press 1~5 to change melody. Press
REDIAL to save the selection.
Dialing Mode
2
Press REDIAL. The current dialing selection
flashes. Press 1 for tone or 2 for pulse. Press
REDIAL to save the selection.
Flash Duration
3
Press REDIAL. The current duration flashes.
Press 1~5 to select duration as follows:
1 = 600 ms
2 = 300 ms
3 = 150 ms
4 = 100 ms
5 = 80 ms
Press REDIAL to save the selection.
Local Number ,
4
Press REDIAL. Enter the telephone number that
you want displayed on the LCD in standby mode.
Press REDIAL to save the number.
Conference ,
5
Press REDIAL. Enter the telephone number you
want the conference key to dial. Press REDIAL to
save the number.
Service ,
6
Press REDIAL. Enter the telephone number you
want the O key to dial. Press REDIAL to save the
number.
7
Press REDIAL. Press number key for country as
follows:
1
US/Canada/China/Japan/Mexico/Singapore
2
Europe CTR 21
3
Australia
4
S. Africa
5
Brazil
6
New Zealand
7
South Korea
Press REDIAL to save the country setting.
Country
,
Press CLEAR to return the previous menu. Press and hold to
exit programming without saving changes.
Press and hold 1 to enter hyphen or , to enter a space in the number.
Press CLEAR before entering a new number.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 67
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.11.5
Compliance
This product is in compliance with the following regulations and
requirements:
J
FCC Part 15/ICES-003
This product has been tested and complies with the limits for a
Class A digital device.
J
FCC Part 68
US:FBIMT01B910158015 Ringer Equivalence Number
(REN):0.1B(ac)
J
Industry of Canada (IC)
IC: 1970A-158015: REN:0.1B(ac)
J
European
Council Directive 1999/5/EC
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 68
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.12
NEC Push-to-Mute (PTM) or Push-to-Talk (PTT) Handset
3.12.1
Description
The PTM (780503) or PTT (780504) handset has a single-pole,
single throw switch that must be continuously held down to provide
the feature.
Figure 9-67 NEC PTM or PTT Handset
These replacement handsets for DTH/ITH terminals help to ensure a
secure telephony environment by keeping unwanted audio from
being transmitted over the corporate telephone network.
Using the PTM or PTT handset on an NEC digital or IP terminal
prevents eavesdropping and eliminates the worry that privileged
information could be transmitted without user authority. These
handsets are also an ideal solution to filter unwanted audio
transmissions from environments with ambient background noise.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
9 - 69
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
9 - 70
Installing Electra Elite IPK II Optional Terminal Equipment
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 10
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ..................................................................................... 10-1
Section 2
Multiline Terminals ....................................................................................... 10-1
2.1
DTP-2DT-1 TEL ........................................................................................ 10-1
2.2
DTU-8-1 TEL ............................................................................................. 10-3
2.3
DTU-8D-2 TEL .......................................................................................... 10-4
2.4
DTU-16-1 TEL ........................................................................................... 10-5
2.5
DTU-16D-2 TEL ........................................................................................ 10-6
2.6
DTU-32-1 TEL ........................................................................................... 10-7
2.7
DTU-32D-2 TEL ........................................................................................ 10-8
2.8
DCU-60-1 CONSOLE ............................................................................... 10-9
Section 3
Connecting a DTU/DTP Terminal to the System ..................................... 10-10
Section 4
Connecting Attendant Console to a Multiline Terminal .......................... 10-11
Section 5
Adjusting the DTU/DTP LCD ..................................................................... 10-12
Section 6
Installing DTU/DTP Line Cards and Plastic Panels ................................. 10-13
6.1
Line Card and Plastic Panel Installation .................................................. 10-13
6.2
Plastic Panel Removal ............................................................................ 10-14
Section 7
Removing DTU/DTP Softkeys ................................................................... 10-15
Section 8
Adjusting DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal Height ........................................ 10-15
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List of Figures
Chapter 10
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 10-1
DTP-2DT-1 TEL .......................................................................................................10-2
Figure 10-2
DTU-8-1 TEL Multiline Terminal ...............................................................................10-3
Figure 10-3
DTU-8D-2 TEL Multiline Terminal ............................................................................10-4
Figure 10-4
DTU-16-1 TEL Multiline Terminal .............................................................................10-5
Figure 10-5
DTU-16D-2 TEL Multiline Terminal ..........................................................................10-6
Figure 10-6
DTU-32-1 TEL Multiline Terminal .............................................................................10-7
Figure 10-7
DTU-32D-2 TEL Multiline Terminal ..........................................................................10-8
Figure 10-8
DCU-60-1 CONSOLE ...............................................................................................10-9
Figure 10-9
Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the System ...................................................... 10-10
Figure 10-10
Leading Line Cords on a Multiline Terminal ...........................................................10-10
Figure 10-11
Connecting the Line Cord and AC Adapter when Installing a DCU
Attendant Console .................................................................................................. 10-11
Figure 10-12
DCU Attendant Console and Multiline Terminal ..................................................... 10-12
Figure 10-13
Adjusting the DTU/DTP LCD .................................................................................. 10-12
Figure 10-14
Installing Line Card and Plastic Panel on a DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal .............. 10-13
Figure 10-15
Installing Plastic Panel on a DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal ...................................... 10-14
Figure 10-16
Removing the Plastic Panel from the DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal ....................... 10-14
Figure 10-17
Removing DTU/DTP Softkeys ................................................................................ 10-15
Figure 10-18
Locating the Adjustment Tabs on the DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal ....................... 10-15
Figure 10-19
Raising the Base Plate on the DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal .................................. 10-16
Figure 10-20
Adjusting the Line Cord Length .............................................................................. 10-16
Figure 10-21
Lowering the Base Plate on the Multiline Terminal ................................................10-17
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures
Installing Electra Elite
Multiline Terminals
Chapter 10
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Electra Elite IPK II system provides several Electra Elite Multiline Terminals, an
Attendant Console, and several adapters that attach peripheral equipment to the
Multiline Terminals. The adapters can be used with Dterm Series E Multiline Terminals
also. This chapter describes each terminal, console, and adapter and provides
applicable installation instructions.
SECTION 2
MULTILINE TERMINALS
2.1
DTP-2DT-1 TEL
This digital nondisplay Multiline Terminal has two programmable line keys
(each with a 2-color LED), eight function keys, a built-in speakerphone,
headset connection, and a large LED to indicate incoming calls and
messages.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTP-2DT-1 TELs can be installed. The combined total of all
Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTP-2DT-1 TELs can be installed. The combined total of
all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 240.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 10-1 DTP-2DT-1 TEL
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 2
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.2
DTU-8-1 TEL
This digital nondisplay Multiline Terminal has eight programmable line keys
(each with a 2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED
to indicate incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with ADA-U,
APA-U, APR-U, CTA-U, CTU(S), or HFU-U.
The DTP-8-1 TEL is comparable and can also be used with the Electra Elite
IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTU-8-1/DTP-8-1 TELs can be installed. The combined
total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTU-8-1/DTP-8-1 TELs can be installed. The combined
total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 240.
Figure 10-2 DTU-8-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.3
DTU-8D-2 TEL
This digital Multiline Terminal has eight programmable line keys (each with the
2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a Large LED to indicate
incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with ADA-U, APA-U, APR-U,
CTA-U, CTU(S), or HFU-U.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
The DTP-8D-1 TEL is comparable and can also be used with the Electra Elite
IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTU-8D-2/DTP-8D-1 TELs can be installed. The combined
total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTU-8D-2/DTP-8D-1 TELs can be installed. The combined
total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 240.
Figure 10-3 DTU-8D-2 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 4
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.4
DTU-16-1 TEL
This digital nondisplay Multiline Terminal has 16 programmable line keys
(each with a 2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED
to indicate incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with ADA-U,
APA-U, APR-U, CTA-U, CTU(S) or HFU-U Unit.
The DTP-16-1 TEL is comparable and can also be used with the Electra Elite
IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTU-16-1/DTP-16-1 TELs can be installed. The combined
total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTU-16-1/DTP-16-1 TELs can be installed. The combined
total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 240.
Figure 10-4 DTU-16-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.5
DTU-16D-2 TEL
This digital Multiline Terminal has 16 programmable line keys (each with a
2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED to indicate
incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with ADA-U, APA-U, APR-U,
CTA-U, CTU(S), or HFU-U.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
The DTP-16D-1 TEL is comparable and can also be used with the Electra
Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTU-16D-2/DTP-16D-1 TELs can be installed. The
combined total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTU-16D-2/DTP-16D-1 TELs can be installed. The
combined total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
240.
Figure 10-5 DTU-16D-2 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 6
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.6
DTU-32-1 TEL
This digital nondisplay Multiline Terminal has 32 programmable line keys
(each with a 2-color LED), 16 one-touch keys, a built-in speakerphone,
headset jack, a large LED to indicate incoming calls and messages, and
compatibility with ADA-U, APA-U, APR-U, CTA-U, CTU(S), or HFU-U.
The DTP-32-1 TEL is comparable and can also be used with the Electra Elite
IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTU-32-1/DTP-32-1 TELs can be installed. The combined
total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTU-32-1/DTP-32-1 TELs can be installed. The combined
total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 240.
Figure 10-6 DTU-32-1 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.7
DTU-32D-2 TEL
This digital Multiline Terminal has 32 programmable line keys (each with a
2-color LED), a built-in speakerphone, headset jack, a large LED to indicate
incoming calls and messages, and compatibility with ADA-U, APA-U, APR-U,
CTA-U, CTU(S), or HFU-U.
This terminal also has a 3-line, 24-character, adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) and four softkeys.
The DTP-32D-1 TEL is comparable and can also be used with the Electra
Elite IPK II system.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTU-32D-2/DTP-32D-1 TELs can be installed. The
combined total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 240 DTU-32D-2/DTP-32D-1 TELs can be installed. The
combined total of all Electra Elite Multiline Terminals that can be installed is
240.
Figure 10-7 DTU-32D-2 TEL Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 8
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.8
DCU-60-1 CONSOLE
The Attendant Console has 60 programmable line keys (each with a 2-color
LED). These 60 line keys can be programmed as Direct Station Selection
keys, function keys, or as outside line keys. An external power supply (AC
adapter) is provided with the Attendant Console.
Basic Port Package and Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 32 DCU-60-1 CONSOLEs can be installed in an Electra Elite
IPK II system. An Attendant Position can have all 32 associated DCU-60-1
CONSOLEs.
Figure 10-8 DCU-60-1 CONSOLE
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 3
CONNECTING A DTU/DTP TERMINAL TO THE SYSTEM
The instructions for connecting a Multiline Terminal to the system applies to all
Multiline Terminals.
1.
Plug the telephone cord into the modular jack on the bottom side of the Multiline
Terminal. The handset is also attached to the bottom side of the Multiline
Terminal.
Figure 10-9 Connecting a Multiline Terminal to the System
2.
Lead the telephone and handset cords through the appropriate grooves.
Figure 10-10 Leading Line Cords on a Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 10
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 4
CONNECTING ATTENDANT CONSOLE TO A MULTILINE TERMINAL
An Attendant Console can be attached to a Multiline Terminal using the following
procedures.
1.
Turn the Multiline Terminal and the Attendant Console face down.
2.
Using the joining plate provided with the Attendant Console, attach the plate to
the Multiline Terminal and the Attendant Console.
3.
Connect the line cord and the AC adapter to the indicated locations on the
bottom of the Attendant Console.
Line Cord Jack
AC Adapter Plug
Figure 10-11 Connecting the Line Cord and AC Adapter
when Installing a DCU Attendant Console
4.
When the Attendant Console and the Multiline Terminal are properly connected,
they sit side-by-side as shown in Figure 10-12 DCU Attendant Console and
Multiline Terminal.
5.
Make sure that the AC adapter, supplied with the Attendant Console, is used.
Using a different AC adapter may cause problems. Check that the supplied
voltage matches that specified for the adapter and plug it in an outlet.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 10-12 DCU Attendant Console and Multiline Terminal
SECTION 5
ADJUSTING THE DTU/DTP LCD
Electra Elite display Multiline Terminals have an adjustable Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD). The LCD can be adjusted by pushing down or pulling up as desired.
Figure 10-13 Adjusting the DTU/DTP LCD
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 12
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 6
INSTALLING DTU/DTP LINE CARDS AND PLASTIC PANELS
6.1
Line Card and Plastic Panel Installation
Line key designations are entered on the Line Card that is then placed on the
Multiline Terminal to provide a quick reference of key designations. The Line
Cards can be changed as necessary. The Plastic Panel is placed on top of
the Line Card to hold it in place.
1.
Place the Line Card over the keys on the Multiline Terminal.
2.
Place the tabs on the bottom of the plastic panel in the grooves at the
terminal bottom, and press top right and left ends to secure plastic panel
to the Multiline Terminal. Refer to Figure 10-15 Installing Plastic Panel
on a DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal.
Figure 10-14 Installing Line Card and Plastic Panel
on a DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 10-15 Installing Plastic Panel on a DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal
6.2
Plastic Panel Removal
Lift the right corner, raise the panel, and slide the bottom away from the
Multiline Terminal.
Never pull on the bottom of the plastic panel to remove it;
the plastic panel could be damaged.
Figure 10-16 Removing the Plastic Panel from the DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 14
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 7
REMOVING DTU/DTP SOFTKEYS
When the softkeys on the Multiline Terminal are not used, they can be removed using
the following procedure:
1.
Remove the softkeys by pulling the softkey plate upward as shown in
Figure 10-17 Removing DTU/DTP Softkeys.
Figure 10-17 Removing DTU/DTP Softkeys
SECTION 8
ADJUSTING DTU/DTP MULTILINE TERMINAL HEIGHT
The base plate on the Electra Elite Multiline Terminal is hinged to allow adjustment to
raise or lower the terminal.
1.
Turn the Multiline Terminal upside down and locate the tabs as shown in Figure
10-18 Locating the Adjustment Tabs on the DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal.
Figure 10-18 Locating the Adjustment Tabs on the DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Push the adjustment tabs and raise the base plate until it locks.
Figure 10-19 Raising the Base Plate on the DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal
3.
The length of the cord can be adjusted by pulling the line cord though the groove
in the bottom of the Multiline Terminal.
Figure 10-20 Adjusting the Line Cord Length
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 16
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
To lower the base plate on the Multiline Terminal, push on the adjustment tabs
and push the base plate downward.
Tab
Figure 10-21 Lowering the Base Plate on the Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
10 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
10 - 18
Installing Electra Elite Multiline Terminals
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 11
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ..................................................................................... 11-1
Section 2
Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation ............................... 11-1
Section 3
Installation Procedures ................................................................................ 11-6
3.1
ACA-U Unit (AC Adapter) .......................................................................... 11-6
3.1.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
Connecting the ACA-U Unit ...................................................................... 11-6
ADA-U Unit (Ancillary Device Adapter) ..................................................... 11-7
3.2.1
Installing an ADA-U Unit on a Multiline Terminal ...................................... 11-7
3.2.2
Connecting Cables to the ADA-U Unit ...................................................... 11-9
3.2.3
Switch Settings ....................................................................................... 11-12
APA-U Unit (Analog Port Adapter) .......................................................... 11-14
3.3.1
Installing APA-U Unit on any DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal except
DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1 ................................................................ 11-14
3.3.2
Switch Settings ....................................................................................... 11-15
3.3.3
Connecting Cables on the APA-U Unit ................................................... 11-16
APR-U Unit (Analog Port Ringer) ............................................................ 11-17
3.4.1
Installing an APR-U Unit on any DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal except
DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1 ................................................................ 11-17
3.4.2
Switch Settings ....................................................................................... 11-19
3.4.3
Connecting Cables on the APR-U Unit ................................................... 11-20
CTA-U Unit (Computer Telephony Application) ...................................... 11-21
3.5.1
Installing the CTA-U Unit ........................................................................ 11-22
3.5.2
Connecting the Cables on the CTA-U Unit ............................................. 11-23
3.5.3
Installing the Driver on the PC ................................................................ 11-23
Computer Telephony Adapter, CTU(8)-U Unit, with USB Interface ........ 11-23
3.6.1
CTU(S) Unit Connections ....................................................................... 11-24
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.7
3.8
3.9
3.10
HFU-U Unit (Handsfree Unit) ................................................................. 11-25
3.7.1
Installing an HFU-U Unit on any DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal
(except DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1) .................................................. 11-25
3.7.2
Installing the External Microphone ......................................................... 11-26
3.7.3
Switch Settings ...................................................................................... 11-27
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP (Single Line Telephone) ........................................... 11-27
3.8.1
Connecting the SLTII(1)-U10 ADP to the System ................................. 11-27
3.8.2
Wall Mounting the SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP .................................................... 11-29
Wall Mounting ......................................................................................... 11-31
3.9.1
Removing and Remounting the Handset Hanger .................................. 11-31
3.9.2
Wall Mounting using the Base Unit ........................................................ 11-31
3.9.3
Installing the Wall Mount Unit and Mounting the Multiline Terminal
using the WMU-U Unit ........................................................................... 11-35
3.9.4
Removing the Multiline Terminal from the Base Plate ........................... 11-39
3.9.5
Removing the Multiline Terminal from the WMU-U Unit ........................ 11-39
ETU Compatibility ................................................................................... 11-40
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List of Figures
Chapter 11
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 11-1
Raising the Base Plate ............................................................................................. 11-2
Figure 11-2
Unlocking Tab ..........................................................................................................11-2
Figure 11-3
Releasing Right Tab .................................................................................................11-3
Figure 11-4
Removing Bottom Cover ..........................................................................................11-3
Figure 11-5
Removing Base Plate Dummy End ..........................................................................11-4
Figure 11-6
Cutting Dummy End in Half ......................................................................................11-4
Figure 11-7
Installing Adapter in Connector 1 .............................................................................11-5
Figure 11-8
Installing Dummy End B ...........................................................................................11-5
Figure 11-9
ACA-U Unit Connection ............................................................................................11-7
Figure 11-10
Attaching the ADA-U Unit to the Multiline Terminal ..................................................11-8
Figure 11-11
Leading the Audio Cable out from the ADA-U Unit ..................................................11-8
Figure 11-12
ADA-U Unit ...............................................................................................................11-9
Figure 11-13
Attaching Cables to the ADA-U Unit .........................................................................11-9
Figure 11-14
ADA-U Unit Switch Settings ................................................................................... 11-12
Figure 11-15
APA-U Unit ............................................................................................................. 11-14
Figure 11-16
Attaching the Unit to the Multiline Terminal ............................................................ 11-15
Figure 11-17
APA-U Unit Switches .............................................................................................. 11-15
Figure 11-18
Connecting Cables on the APA-U Unit ................................................................... 11-16
Figure 11-19
APR-U Unit ............................................................................................................. 11-17
Figure 11-20
Attaching the Unit to the Multiline Terminal ............................................................ 11-18
Figure 11-21
Leading the Telephone Cord out from the Unit ...................................................... 11-18
Figure 11-22
Closing the Base Plate Cover ................................................................................ 11-19
Figure 11-23
APR-U Unit Switches ............................................................................................. 11-19
Figure 11-24
Connecting Cables on the APR-U Unit ..................................................................11-20
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 11-25
Attaching an Electra Elite Multiline Terminal to a PC ............................................. 11-21
Figure 11-26
CTA-U Unit ............................................................................................................. 11-22
Figure 11-27
Attaching the Unit to the Multiline Terminal ............................................................ 11-22
Figure 11-28
Connecting the RS-232C Cable to the CTA-U Unit
on the Multiline Terminal ........................................................................................ 11-23
Figure 11-29
CTU (S)-U Unit ....................................................................................................... 11-24
Figure 11-30
HFU-U Unit ............................................................................................................. 11-25
Figure 11-31
Microphone with Mute ............................................................................................ 11-26
Figure 11-32
Attaching a Microphone to a Multiline Terminal ..................................................... 11-26
Figure 11-33
HFU-U(BK)/(WH) Unit Switches ............................................................................. 11-27
Figure 11-34
Connecting a Single Line Telephone to the System
using an SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP ..................................................................................... 11-28
Figure 11-35
Connecting the SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP ......................................................................... 11-29
Figure 11-36
Removing the Screws from the SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP ................................................ 11-29
Figure 11-37
Attaching the SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP to the Wall ........................................................... 11-30
Figure 11-38
Positioning the Handset Hanger ............................................................................ 11-31
Figure 11-39
Removing the Knockout ......................................................................................... 11-32
Figure 11-40
Attaching the Base Plate to the Wall ...................................................................... 11-32
Figure 11-41
Plugging in the Line Cord using a Wall Jack .......................................................... 11-33
Figure 11-42
Plugging in the Line Cord Using a Modular Jack ................................................... 11-33
Figure 11-43
Attaching the Bottom Tabs of the Multiline Terminal to the Base Plate ................. 11-34
Figure 11-44
Attaching the Top Tabs of the Multiline Terminal to the Base Plate ...................... 11-34
Figure 11-45
Installed Wall Mount Unit ....................................................................................... 11-35
Figure 11-46
Removing the Tabs from the Adapter .................................................................... 11-36
Figure 11-47
Removing the Tabs from the WMU-U Unit ............................................................. 11-36
Figure 11-48
Leading the Line Cord out of the WMU-U Unit ....................................................... 11-37
Figure 11-49
Attaching the Wall Mount Unit to the Wall .............................................................. 11-37
Figure 11-50
Attaching the Multiline Terminal to the WMU-U Unit .............................................. 11-38
Figure 11-51
Removing the Multiline Terminal from the Base Plate ........................................... 11-39
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures
List Of tables
Chapter 11
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 11-1
ADA-U Cable Connections ..................................................................................... 11-10
Table 11-2
ADA-U Unit Switch Settings ................................................................................... 11-12
Table 11-3
APA-U Unit Switch Settings for SW3 ..................................................................... 11-16
Table 11-4
APR-U Unit Switch Settings for SW1 and SW3 ..................................................... 11-20
Table 11-5
HFU-U Unit Switch Settings ................................................................................... 11-27
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
v
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
vi
List of Tables
Installing Electra Elite
Optional Terminal Equipment
Chapter 11
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Electra Elite optional equipment can be purchased separately from the system
and added as the customer business grows. Except as noted, these adapters can be
installed on Electra Elite Multiline Terminals. The adapters can also be used with
Dterm Series E (DTP) Multiline Terminals.
A Multiline Terminal can have up to three adapters installed at the same time. When
attaching an APR-U, CTA-U, CTU(S)-U, or HFU-U Unit an external power supply is
required. Only one power supply is needed even when more than one adapter is
installed.
When an adapter is installed in a terminal for the first time, the base cover on the
Multiline Terminal may have to be modified. The base cover has two access panels
that are removed before the cover can be closed over the adapters to complete the
installation.
SECTION 2
PREPARING MULTILINE TERMINAL FOR ADAPTER INSTALLATION
To prepare the Multiline Terminal for adapter installation:
1.
Unplug the telephone cord from the terminal.
2.
Turn the terminal upside down. Push the tabs indicated in Figure 11-1 Raising
the Base Plate, and raise the inner area of the base plate.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 11-1 Raising the Base Plate
3.
Insert a flat head screwdriver into A in Figure 11-2 Unlocking Tab and press
straight down until tab unlocks.
Figure 11-2 Unlocking Tab
4.
Lightly press the right side of leg shown as B in Figure 11-3 Releasing Right
Tab, insert a flat head screwdriver at C. Press straight down until other tab
unlocks.
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 2
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 11-3 Releasing Right Tab
5.
Open and remove the bottom cover by rotating counterclockwise as shown in
Figure 11-4 Removing Bottom Cover.
Figure 11-4 Removing Bottom Cover
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
6.
When an adapter is being installed, press tabs A and B to remove the dummy
end from the base plate as shown in Figure 11-5 Removing Base Plate Dummy
End.
Figure 11-5 Removing Base Plate Dummy End
7.
Cut the dummy end in half as shown in Figure 11-6 Cutting Dummy End in Half.
Figure 11-6 Cutting Dummy End in Half
8.
When the adapter is installed in connector 1 as shown in Figure 11-7 Installing
Adapter in Connector 1, Install the dummy end B as shown in Figure 11-8
Installing Dummy End B.
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 4
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 11-7 Installing Adapter in Connector 1
Figure 11-8 Installing Dummy End B
9.
When the Adapter is installed in Connector 2, install dummy end A in the other
slot.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 3
INSTALLATION PROCEDURES
3.1
ACA-U Unit (AC Adapter)
This unit provides power to ancillary devices, Attendant Consoles, or the
DTP-16HC-1 TEL. Except for the DTP-16HC-1 TEL, the ACA-U Unit connects
to one of the following adapters installed on a Multiline Terminal: APR-U Unit,
CTA-U Unit, CTU(S)-U Unit or HFU-U Unit. When more than one adapter is
installed on a Multiline Terminal, only one ACA-U Unit is necessary.
The power requirements for the ACA-U Unit are:
J
J
J
3.1.1
Input: 120 Vac, 60 Hz, 30W
Output: 24 Vdc, 750 mA
⊕
Polarity:
Connecting the ACA-U Unit
1.
Unplug the line cord from the Multiline Terminal and unplug the
ACA-U Unit from the AC outlet.
Failing to do this can damage the unit and/or the
Multiline Terminal.
2.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation.
3.
Locate the AC Adapter plug on the ancillary device that is
connected to the bottom of the Multiline Terminal and plug in
the AC Adapter.
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 6
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
AC Adapter Plug
Figure 11-9 ACA-U Unit Connection
3.2
ADA-U Unit (Ancillary Device Adapter)
Ancillary Device Adapters allow connection of a tape recorder to all DTU/DTP
Multiline Terminals except DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1.
When installing an ADA-U Unit, first connect the cables to the ADA-U Unit, set
the dip switches, and then install the ADA-U Unit on the Multiline Terminal.
3.2.1
Installing an ADA-U Unit on a Multiline Terminal
1.
Unplug the telephone cord from the Multiline Terminal.
2.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation.
3.
Plug the ADA-U Unit connector into the receptacle connector
on the back of the Multiline Terminal. Snap the ADA-U Unit into
the hooks on the Multiline Terminal to secure it.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 11-10 Attaching the ADA-U Unit to the Multiline Terminal
4.
Replace base plate.
5.
Lead the audio cable out through the groove on the base cover.
Connect the telephone cord.
6.
Connect the telephone cord.
Figure 11-11 Leading the Audio Cable out from the ADA-U Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 8
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.2.2
Connecting Cables to the ADA-U Unit
Cable terminal connectors are located on the right side of the ADA-U
Unit. Cables should be connected on this unit before installing the
unit on the Multiline Terminal.
Terminals
Figure 11-12 ADA-U Unit
1.
Cut off the plug on one end of the cable.
2.
Locate the adapter terminals on the right side of the unit as
illustrated in Figure 11-12 ADA-U Unit.
3.
Remove the cap on the adapter terminal to expose the metal
receptacle. Push the cable in the applicable receptacle, and
replace the cap. Line up the slot on the cap with the slot on the
metal receptacle to ensure proper contact. Refer to
Figure 11-13 Attaching Cables to the ADA-U Unit.
Figure 11-13 Attaching Cables to the ADA-U Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Insulate the end of the cable that needs to be shielded with
insulating tape.
Table 11-1 ADA-U Cable Connections provides a list of cable
connections to ADA-U ADP terminals and describes the
specifications for the terminals.
Table 11-1 ADA-U Cable Connections
Terminal
Number
T1
T2
Cables to Connect
Terminal Specifications
When warning tone is not being
sent from the recorder, connect
wire pair input from tone
generator to T1:T2. The
warning tones from the
generator are sent to T1:T2 on a
dedicated wire pair while the
speech path is sent from the
ADA-U on T3:T4 over a
separate wire pair to the
recorder.
Input Terminal:T1 and T2
are enabled for tone
generating device when
switches SW1-3 and SW1-4
are OFF.
(When switches SW1- 3 and
SW1-4 are ON, a humming
sound may be recorded due
to impedance mismatch.)
Input Impedance on T1 and
T2: 100K Ω
Input Level on T1 and T2:
15 dB ~ 40 dB
T3:T4
Connect recorder device wire
pair speech input to T3:T4.
When the recorder used
supplies a warning tone, this
tone may also be sent over the
T3:T4 wire pair back to the
terminal.
Input/Output Terminal:
Refer to dip switch settings
in Table 11-2 ADA-U Unit
Switch Settings.
T5
Connect the bare end of the
control cable.
When a Multiline Terminal is
idle, this contact is closed.
When the Multiline Terminal
goes off-hook (using the
handset, headset, or
speakerphone), this contact
is open.
When recorder owner
manual specifies start on
open circuit, connect T5 and
T6.
T6
Connect the shielded end of the
control cable.
Provides common
connection for control cable.
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 10
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 11-1 ADA-U Cable Connections (Continued)
T7
Connect the bare end of the
control cable.
When the Multiline Terminal
is idle, this contact is open.
When the Multiline Terminal
is busy (using the handset,
headset, or speakerphone),
this contact is closed.
When recorder owner
manual specifies start on
closed circuit, connect T6
and T7.
T8
Unused
T9
Notes:
When recording in handsfree (half-duplex) mode using the built-in
speakerphone, the record warning tone may not be audible to the
far-end party.
The transmit recording level is lower than the receiving voice level
for intercom calls; the transmit recording level for CO calls is
normal.
Depending on the recording device(s), separate cables may be
required for the warning tone and speech path. In this case,
connect the warning tone cables to input terminals T1 and T2 on
the ADA-U Unit. (T3 and T4 are used as the tape recorder input.)
When remote control of the recorder is necessary, the record
start/stop control is provided by connecting to T5 (or T7) and T6
on the ADA-U Unit. (Connecting to T5 or T7 is determined by the
specifications of the recorder.)
When a warning Tone is provided from the recording equipment, it
should be input via T3 and T4 on ADA-U Unit. Do not use T1 and
T2 to input Beep Tone.
Conversations cannot be recorded from terminals connected to
an APR/APA-U Unit. Speakerphone calls through the HFU-U Unit
cannot be recorded.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.2.3
Switch Settings
The DIP Switch is located at the bottom center of the ADA-U Unit.
The DIP Switch allows a technician to configure the board to specific
settings. Figure 11-14 ADA-U Unit Switch Settings shows the default
settings.
Terminals
Dip Switch
Default Settings
Figure 11-14 ADA-U Unit Switch Settings
The following switch settings should be made on the ADA-U Unit to
enable or disable the record start warning tone. Switch settings
should be made before installing the ADA-U Unit in the Multiline
Terminal. Refer to Table 11-2 ADA-U Unit Switch Settings.
Table 11-2 ADA-U Unit Switch Settings
Switch
Setting
Description
SW1–1
On
When the ADA-U provides control to the
recorder, SW1-1 should be set to On,
otherwise set it to Off.
SW1–2
Off
Leave Off
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 12
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 11-2 ADA-U Unit Switch Settings (Continued)
Switch
SW1–3
and
SW1-4
SW1–5
and
SW1–6
Setting
Description
SW1–3
SW1–4
Warning Tone from recording device over
same wire pair as speech path.
ON
ON
SW1–3
SW1–4
OFF
OFF
Warning Tone from recorder or generator
equipment on dedicated wire pair to
recorder MIC input
SW1–5
SW1–6
Input impedance is 600 Ω.
OFF
ON
SW1–5
SW1–6
ON
OFF
Input impedance is less than 30Ω.
SW1–7
ON
When warning tone from any device is
sent to telephone
SW1–8
Off
Leave Off
Do not connect T1 and T2 when switches SW1-3 and SW1-4
are ON.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.3
APA-U Unit (Analog Port Adapter)
The Analog Port Adapter without Ringer is the interface for installing Single
Line Telephones, Modems, Credit Card Readers, Wireless Headsets, NEC
VoicePoint/VoicePoint Plus Conferencing unit, and other compatible analog
devices. The APA-U Unit does not generate a ringing signal. One
user-adjustable switch with two settings is provided on the adapter. Setting 1
allows impedance to be set to 600Ω for devices such as modems. Setting 2 is
used for complex impedance devices such as a Single Line Telephone.
This adapter can be installed on any DTP or DTU Multiline Terminal except
DTP-2DT-1 TEL, DTP-16HC-1 TEL, or cordless terminals.
Figure 11-15 APA-U Unit
3.3.1
Installing APA-U Unit on any DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal except
DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1
1.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation.
2.
Plug the unit into the receptacle connector inside the base
plate. Refer to Figure 11-16 Attaching the Unit to the Multiline
Terminal.
The APA-U Unit does not require an ACA-U Unit to supply
external power.
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 14
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Close the base plate, and snap the cover in place.
Figure 11-16 Attaching the Unit to the Multiline Terminal
3.3.2
4.
Install a ferrite core (provided with the APA-U Unit) by looping
line cord through the core between the terminal (one inch from
the terminal) and ESI(8)-U10 ETU. This core is only used with
the APA-U Unit.
5.
Plug the telephone cord in the jack.
Switch Settings
The APA-U Unit has one switch.
Figure 11-17 APA-U Unit Switches
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Refer to Table 11-3 APA-U Unit Switch Settings for SW3.
Table 11-3 APA-U Unit Switch Settings for SW3
Switch
3.3.3
Description
SW3–1
Sets impedance to 600Ω for devices such as
modems or facsimile machines.
SW3–2
Used for complex impedance devices such as
Single Line Telephones.
Connecting Cables on the APA-U Unit
Plug the telephone cord from the Single Line Telephone into the
modular jack on the APA-U Unit. Refer to Figure 11-18 Connecting
Cables on the APA-U Unit.
Limit the cable length from the APA-U Unit to the Single Line
Telephone to a maximum of 50 feet.
Figure 11-18 Connecting Cables on the APA-U Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 16
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.4
APR-U Unit (Analog Port Ringer)
The Analog Port Adapter with Ringing is the interface for installing Single Line
Telephones, modems, NEC VoicePoint/VoicePoint Plus Conferencing unit,
and other compatible analog devices. The APR-U Unit also generates ringing
signals. By providing ring generation, the user can install a personal fax
machine or an answering machine for convenience.
Two user-adjustable switches are provided on the adapter; one allows for 600
Ω or a complex impedance interface to devices such as a modem or Single
Line Telephone, the second switch (SW1) is set to position 2. When this
Analog Port Ringer adapter is used, an additional Single Line Telephone or a
modem can be connected to a Multiline Terminal.
If a CTA-U, CTU(S)-U, or HFU-U and an APR-U Unit are both installed, only
one AC Adapter is required.
This adapter can be installed on any DTP or DTU Multiline Terminal except
DTP-2DT-1 TEL, DTP-16HC-1 TEL, or cordless terminals.
ACA-U Unit
(AC Adapter)
Figure 11-19 APR-U Unit
3.4.1
Installing an APR-U Unit on any DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal except
DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1
1.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation.
2.
Plug the unit into the receptacle connector inside the base
plate. Refer to Figure 11-20 Attaching the Unit to the Multiline
Terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 11-20 Attaching the Unit to the Multiline Terminal
3.
Plug the cord of the ACA-U Unit (AC adapter) into the jack on
the APR-U Unit. Lead the telephone cord out through the
groove in the base as shown in Figure 11-21 Leading the
Telephone Cord out from the Unit.
Figure 11-21 Leading the Telephone Cord out from the Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 18
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Close the base plate, lead the AC adapter cord out through the
hole, and snap the cover in place.
Figure 11-22 Closing the Base Plate Cover
3.4.2
5.
Install a ferrite core (provided with the APR-U Unit) by looping
line cord through the core between the terminal (one inch from
the terminal) and ESI(8)-U10 ETU. This core is only used with
the APR-U Unit.
6.
Plug in the power cord on the AC adapter and the telephone
cord in the jack.
Switch Settings
The APR-U Unit has two switches.
Figure 11-23 APR-U Unit Switches
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Refer to Table 11-4 APR-U Unit Switch Settings for SW1 and SW3.
Table 11-4 APR-U Unit Switch Settings for SW1 and SW3
Switch
Description
SW1–1
Do not use
SW1–2
A Single Line Telephone and Multiline Terminal are used
alternately.
(The Multiline Terminal and the APR-U Unit share the same
B1 channel.)
3.4.3
SW3–1
Sets impedance to 600Ω for devices such as modems or
facsimile machines.
SW3–2
Used for complex impedance devices such as Single Line
Telephones.
Connecting Cables on the APR-U Unit
Plug the telephone cord from the Single Line Telephone in the
modular jack on the APR-U Unit.
Limit the cable length from the APR-U Unit to the Single Line
Telephone to a maximum of 50 feet.
Figure 11-24 Connecting Cables on the APR-U Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 20
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.5
CTA-U Unit (Computer Telephony Application)
Computer Telephony Application allows a DTU or DTP Multiline Terminal to
be connected to a PC using the TAPI (Microsoft Telephony Application
Programming Interface) adapter. The PC can perform all Multiline Terminal
functions using a TAPI-compatible application software.
This adapter can be installed on any DTU or DTP Multiline Terminal except
DTP-2DT-1 TEL, DTP-16HC-1 TEL, or Cordless Terminals.
Figure 11-25 Attaching an Electra Elite Multiline Terminal to a PC
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 21
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
The CTA-U Unit is attached to the bottom of any DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal
except DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1.
ACA-U Unit
(AC Adapter)
Figure 11-26 CTA-U Unit
3.5.1
Installing the CTA-U Unit
1.
Prepare Multiline Terminal for adapter installation. Refer to
Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter Installation.
2.
Plug the unit into the receptacle connector inside the base plate
on the Multiline Terminal. Refer to Figure 11-27 Attaching the
Unit to the Multiline Terminal.
Figure 11-27 Attaching the Unit to the Multiline Terminal
3.
Close the base plate.
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 22
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.5.2
Connecting the Cables on the CTA-U Unit
Connect the RS-232C cable from the computer to the connector on
the CTA-U Unit as shown in Figure 11-28 Connecting the RS-232C
Cable to the CTA-U Unit on the Multiline Terminal.
Figure 11-28 Connecting the RS-232C Cable to the CTA-U Unit on
the Multiline Terminal
3.5.3
Installing the Driver on the PC
Using the setup disk provided with the CTA-U Unit install the driver
on your PC. Refer to the CTA installation Guide for instructions on
installing CTA setup disks.
3.6
Computer Telephony Adapter, CTU(8)-U Unit, with USB Interface
The CTU adapter connects to a PC USB port to provide telephony and sound
device control. The general functions of the CTU include:
J
Telephony Control
The application is based on the Microsoft Telephony Application
Programming Interface (TAPI) and provides call handling on the PC
(e.g., call, answer, Hold, Transfer, Conference, or Caller ID).
J
User Interface to support Dterm Emulation
This function provides the functions of Dterm such as normal telephone
indications, LCD, Line keys, or Hookswitch.
J
Sound Support
Allows voice recording or recording playing on an audio device assigned
to the PC. Voice Mail and Live Record are supported on the PC.
J
Supports Plug and Play
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 23
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
J
Headset Operation
When user uses CTU and TAPI and sets data for Telephony Service
Provider (TSP), the headset button can be controlled by TSP.
J
USB Interface
This adapter uses Full Speed (12Mbps) as defined in the USB
Specification.
3.6.1
CTU(S) Unit Connections
This unit is a Computer Telephony Application adapter to connect a
Universal Serial Bus to an ESI(8)-U( ) ETU and can be connected to
any DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal except DTP-2DT-1, DTP-16HC-1 or
Cordless terminals.
A required AC Adapter is provided with the unit.
The following connections are required:
J
J
J
J
AC Adapter
Multiline Terminal jack labeled LINE
PC USB port
ESI port to ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
DC 24V (ADP)
USB Cable to PC
To ESI Port
To DTU or DTP Multiline Terminal
Figure 11-29 CTU (S)-U Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 24
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.7
HFU-U Unit (Handsfree Unit)
The Handsfree Unit provides full-duplex handsfree communication. Large
areas may cause poor full-duplex operation. This unit comes with the
handsfree adapter and an external microphone.
This adapter can be installed on any DTP or DTU Multiline Terminal except
DTP-2DT-1 TEL or DTP-16HC-1 TEL.
Figure 11-30 HFU-U Unit
3.7.1
Installing an HFU-U Unit on any DTU/DTP Multiline Terminal (except
DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1)
With terminal upside down, facing from the bottom of the open cover,
install this unit in Telephone Slot 1.
Refer to 3.4.1 Installing an APR-U Unit on any DTU/DTP Multiline
Terminal except DTP-2DT-1 and DTP-16HC-1 The instructions for
installing these units are the same.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 25
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.7.2
Installing the External Microphone
An external microphone can be installed on the HFU-U Unit. These
instructions apply to the external microphone obtained from NEC.
The microphone is equipped with a mute button.
Figure 11-31 Microphone with Mute
1.
Plug the microphone cord into the jack on the HFU-U Unit as
shown in Figure 11-32 Attaching a Microphone to a Multiline
Terminal.
The microphone should be between one foot and three feet
away from the Multiline Terminal.
Minimum 1 Foot
from Multiline
Figure 11-32 Attaching a Microphone to a Multiline Terminal
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 26
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.7.3
Switch Settings
The HFU-U Unit uses 2-position switches SW1 and SW2.
Figure 11-33 HFU-U(BK)/(WH) Unit Switches
Refer to Table 11-5 HFU-U Unit Switch Settings.
Table 11-5 HFU-U Unit Switch Settings
SW1
Description
Position
1
Position
2
Position
1
Position
2
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
Full Duplex (Default)
ON
OFF
OFF
ON
Half Duplex (6db mix ratio)
OFF
ON
ON
OFF
Half Duplex (12db mix ratio)
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
Half Duplex (18db mix ratio)
3.8
SW2
Full Duplex: In some large areas or noisy locations half duplex
should be used. The echo canceling ability of the HFU-U is
limited.
Half Duplex: When voice clipping occurs, use a lower decibel
setting.
SLTII(1)-U10 ADP (Single Line Telephone)
The Single Line Telephone adapter provides an interface for Single Line
Telephones and other similar devices from an ESI ETU channel.
This adapter can be connected to any ESI port except 01 and 02.
3.8.1
Connecting the SLTII(1)-U10 ADP to the System
1.
Connect one end of the RJ-11 to the ESI port on the KSU and
one end to the ESI jack on the SLT Adapter.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 27
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Connect one end of a second RJ-11 to the TEL jack on the SLT
Adapter and the other end to the Single Line Telephone.
SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP
TEL
ESI
RJ-11
RJ-11
2-wire
2-wire
ESI
Figure 11-34 Connecting a Single Line Telephone to the
System using an SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 28
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Modular Terminal
ESI ETU
GN
SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP
Y
3
T
R
To ESI
4
RD
BL
Base
Cord
ESI Port
Modular Terminal Connections
Single Line Telephone
Figure 11-35 Connecting the SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP
3.8.2
Wall Mounting the SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP
1.
Remove the two screws from the top to open the SLT Adapter
as shown in Figure 11-36 Removing the Screws from the
SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP.
Figure 11-36 Removing the Screws from the SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 29
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Using the two provided wood screws, attach the unit to the wall.
Close the unit and secure with the two screws that were
previously removed.
Figure 11-37 Attaching the SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP to the Wall
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 30
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9
Wall Mounting
Any Electra Elite Multiline Terminal can be mounted on a wall. Multiline
Terminals can be wall mounted by using the base unit that comes with the
Multiline Terminal or by using the WMU-U Unit to accommodate adapters that
are installed on the Multiline Terminal.
The Wall Mount Unit is required when an APA-U, APR-U, CTA-U, CTU(S)-U
or HFU-U Unit is installed.
3.9.1
Removing and Remounting the Handset Hanger
1.
Remove the hanger by sliding it out of the slot. Refer to Figure
11-38 Positioning the Handset Hanger.
2.
Install it back in its original position so that the hanger
protrudes providing a rest for the handset. (This procedure
applies when using either the base unit or the WMU-U Unit.)
Refer to Figure 11-38 Positioning the Handset Hanger for the
steps for removing and remounting the handset hanger.
A
B
Figure 11-38 Positioning the Handset Hanger
3.9.2
Wall Mounting using the Base Unit
1.
Refer to Section 2 Preparing Multiline Terminal for Adapter
Installation, and perform Steps 1~5.
2.
Press both sides of the base cover and turn it left to remove it.
3.
Rotate base cover 180°, and install it again on the Multiline
Terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 31
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Remove the shaded base plate knockout shown on
Figure 11-39 Removing the Knockout.
Figure 11-39 Removing the Knockout
5.
Assemble the base plate and base cover.
6.
As illustrated in Figure 11-40 Attaching the Base Plate to the
Wall, attach the base plate and base cover assembly (wide end
down) to the posts on the locally provided and installed wall
plate. Place locally provided screws in the nodes on the base
plate and secure the assembly to the wall.
Nodes
Posts
Nodes
Figure 11-40 Attaching the Base Plate to the Wall
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 32
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
7.
Plug the line cord into the jack on the wall plate, wrap the extra
cord and secure it with a tie wrap, and lead the line cord out
through the groove in the side of the base unit.
Figure 11-41 Plugging in the Line Cord using a Wall Jack
8.
When using a modular jack instead of a wall plate, plug the line
cord into the modular jack, wrap the extra cord and secure it
with a tie wrap, and lead the line cord out through the groove in
the side of the base unit.
Figure 11-42 Plugging in the Line Cord Using a Modular Jack
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 33
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
9.
With the base unit attached to the wall, hook the two bottom
tabs in the tab slots on the Multiline Terminal base.
Base Unit
Multiline
Terminal
Line Cord
Wall
Tab
Tab Slots
Figure 11-43 Attaching the Bottom Tabs of the Multiline
Terminal to the Base Plate
10.
Push up on the Terminal and lock the top base unit tabs in the
top slots on the terminal. Figure 11-44 Attaching the Top Tabs
of the Multiline Terminal to the Base Plate shows how the
Multiline Terminal is attached.
Tab Slots
Multiline
Terminal
Tabs
Line Cord
Wall
Wall Mount Unit
Figure 11-44
Attaching the Top Tabs of the Multiline
Terminal to the Base Plate
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 34
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
11.
When properly installed, the wall-mounted Multiline Terminal
looks similar to the one shown in Figure 11-45 Installed Wall
Mount Unit.
Do not adjust the tilt panel after the Multiline Terminal is
mounted on the wall.
Figure 11-45 Installed Wall Mount Unit
3.9.3
Installing the Wall Mount Unit and Mounting the Multiline Terminal
using the WMU-U Unit
When installing any Adapter unit, a separate WMU-U Unit must be
purchased to accommodate this unit.
1.
Remove the line cord, base plate and base cover from the
Multiline Terminal as shown in the previous section.
2.
Cut off the tabs on the adapter as shown in Figure 11-46
Removing the Tabs from the Adapter.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 35
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 11-46 Removing the Tabs from the Adapter
3.
Remove the tabs from the WMU-U Unit as shown in
Figure 11-47 Removing the Tabs from the WMU-U Unit. (The
Tabs that are removed depend on the Multiline Terminal type.)
Cut
Cut
Cut
Cut
Cut
DTU/DTP-8-1 TEL
DTP-8D-1/DTU-8D-2 TEL
DTU/DTP-16-1 TEL
DTP-16D-1/DTU-16D-2TEL
DCU-60-1 CONSOLE
DTU/DTP-32-1 TEL
DTP-32D-1/DTU-32D-2 TEL
Figure 11-47 Removing the Tabs from the WMU-U Unit
4.
Bundle the cord from the modular jack leaving about eight
inches. Use a tie wrap to secure the bundled cord.
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 36
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.
Place the bundled line cord between the WMU-U Unit and the
wall. Lead the line cord out through the slits as shown in Figure
11-48 Leading the Line Cord out of the WMU-U Unit.
Figure 11-48 Leading the Line Cord out of the WMU-U Unit
6.
Attach the WMU-U Unit to the posts on the wall plate (locally
provided). Place locally provided screws in the nodes on the
WMU-U Unit and secure the WMU-U Unit to the wall.
Nodes
Posts
Nodes
Figure 11-49 Attaching the Wall Mount Unit to the Wall
7.
Connect the line cord to the Multiline Terminal.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 37
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.
With the WMU-U Unit attached to the wall, hook the two bottom
tabs on the WMU-U Mount Unit in the tab slots on the Multiline
Terminal. Then push the two top tabs on the WMU-U Unit into
the tab slots on the Multiline Terminal. When the adapter has a
power supply, lead the AC adapter cord out through the
opening at the bottom of the Multiline Terminal. Refer to Figure
11-50 Attaching the Multiline Terminal to the WMU-U Unit.
WMU-U Unit
Multiline
Terminal
Adapter
Tab Slots
Figure 11-50
Wall
Attaching the Multiline Terminal to the WMU-U
Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 38
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.9.4
Removing the Multiline Terminal from the Base Plate
To remove the Multiline Terminal from the base cover, lift the
Multiline Terminal to disengage top tabs, turn it slightly counter
clockwise to unlock lower tabs on base cover, and remove it.
Figure 11-51 Removing the Multiline Terminal from the Base Plate
3.9.5
Removing the Multiline Terminal from the WMU-U Unit
To remove the Multiline Terminal from the WMU-U Unit, lift the
Multiline Terminal to disengage top tabs and lower the terminal from
the WMU-U Unit.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
11 - 39
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.10
ETU Compatibility
ESIB(8)-U10/U20 ETUs and ESIE(8)-U10/U20 ETUs are compatible as
indicated by the table below.
Electra Elite IPK
Electra Elite IPK II
ESIE(8)
U10
ESIE(8)
U20
ESIE(8)
U10
ESIE(8)
U20
ESIB(8)-10
X
X
X1
X1
ESIB(8)-20 in U10 Mode
X
X
X1
X1
ESIB(8)-20 in U20 Mode
N/A
N/A
N/A
X2
X
Supported
N/A Not supported
X1 Does not support SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP, AP(A/R)-R Port Adapters,
PGD(2)-U10 ADP or Multiline Terminals with CT(U/A)-R units installed.
X2 Supports SLTII(1)-U( ) ADP, AP(A/R)-R Port Adapters, PGD(2)-U10 ADP
or Multiline Terminals with CT(U/A)-R units installed.
___________________________________________________________________________________
11 - 40
Installing Electra Elite Optional Terminal Equipment
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 12
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ..................................................................................... 12-1
Section 2
Single Line Telephones ............................................................................... 12-1
Section 3
2.1
DTR-1-1 TEL ............................................................................................. 12-1
2.2
DTR-1HM-1 TEL ....................................................................................... 12-3
Wall Mounting DTR-1-1 TEL/DTR-1HM-1 TEL Single Line
Telephones ................................................................................................... 12-5
3.1
Adjusting the Hanger Hook ....................................................................... 12-5
3.1.1
Section 4
Wall Mounting the Telephone ......................................................................... 12-6
3.2
Using Hanger Hooks on the Single Line Telephone ................................. 12-8
3.3
DTP-1-1 TEL/ DTP-1-2 TEL ...................................................................... 12-9
3.4
DTP-1HM-1/ DTP-1HM-2 TEL ................................................................ 12-10
Wall Mounting the DTP-1-1 or DTP-1-2 TEL and DTP-1HM-1 or
DTP-1HM-2 TEL .......................................................................................... 12-11
4.1
Hanger Hook ........................................................................................... 12-11
4.2
Using Installed Modular Wall Plate ......................................................... 12-12
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List of Figures
Chapter 12
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 12-1
DTR-1-1 TEL Single Line Telephone .......................................................................12-2
Figure 12-2
DTR-1HM-1 TEL Single Line Telephone ..................................................................12-4
Figure 12-3
Removing the Hanger Hook on a Single Line Telephone ........................................12-5
Figure 12-4
Sliding the Hanger Hook on a Single Line Telephone into Position .........................12-5
Figure 12-5
Removing the Metal Base ........................................................................................12-6
Figure 12-6
Reattaching the Metal Base .....................................................................................12-7
Figure 12-7
Hanger Hooks on the Single Line Telephone ...........................................................12-8
Figure 12-8
DTP-1-1 TEL Single Line Telephone .......................................................................12-9
Figure 12-9
DTP-1HM-1 TEL Single Line Telephone ................................................................ 12-10
Figure 12-10
Removing the DTP Telephone Hanger Hook ......................................................... 12-11
Figure 12-11
Turning the Hook Over ........................................................................................... 12-11
Figure 12-12
Sliding the Hook into Position .................................................................................12-12
Figure 12-13
Removing the Screws ............................................................................................12-12
Figure 12-14
Replacing the Plate and Screw .............................................................................. 12-13
Figure 12-15
Protruding Screws .................................................................................................. 12-13
Figure 12-16
Mounting the Telephone ......................................................................................... 12-14
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Figures
Installing Single
Line Telephones
Chapter 12
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Electra Elite IPK II system supports several different Single Line Telephones.
J
DTR-1-1 TEL/DTR-1HM-1 TEL
Both of the DTR Single Line Telephones come in black or white.
J
DTP-1-1 TEL/ DTP-1HM-1 TEL
Both the DTP-1-1 TEL and DTP-1HM-1 TEL come in black or white.
SECTION 2
SINGLE LINE TELEPHONES
2.1
DTR-1-1 TEL
The DTR-1-1TEL is a fully modular terminal that has DTMF and Pulse Dialing
compatibilities and offers Flash key, redial key functionality. A Message
Waiting Indicator, that also functions as Incoming Call Indication, is a standard
feature of this telephone. This telephone comes equipped with a 6-level
receive volume control (three increased levels and two decreased levels), a
4-level ring volume control (Off, Soft, Medium, Loud) and three ring patterns
(Slow, Medium, Fast). The DTR-1-1 TEL has a data port and a built-in wall
mount adapter.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTR-1-1 TELs can be installed. The total number of all
Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 184 DTR-1-1 TELs can be installed. The total number of all
Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 240.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
12 - 1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Each terminal requires an SLTII(1)-U10 ADP or SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU.
The volume up/down setting for the receive volume control should only be used
by hearing impaired individuals, otherwise hearing damage may occur. This
telephone complies with HAC (Hearing Aid Compatible) volume control defined
by section 68.317 of the FCC Rules and Regulations, 1996 edition.
Figure 12-1 DTR-1-1 TEL Single Line Telephone
___________________________________________________________________________________
12 - 2
Installing Single Line Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.2
DTR-1HM-1 TEL
The DTR-1HM-1 TEL is a fully modular terminal that has DTMF and Pulse
Dialing abilities and offers Flash key and Redial key functionality. A Message
Waiting Indicator, that also functions as an Incoming Call Indicator, is a
standard feature of this telephone. The DTR-1HM-1 TEL has eight
programmable speed dial buttons and has Hold and monitor function keys.
This telephone comes equipped with a 6-level receive volume control
(three increase levels and two decrease levels), a 4-level ring volume control
(Off, Soft, Medium, Loud) and three ring patterns (Slow, Medium, Fast). The
DTR-1HM-1 TEL has a data port and a built-in wall mount adapter.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTR-1HM-1 TELs can be installed. The total number of all
Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 184 DTR-1HM-1 TELs can be installed. The total number of all
Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 240.
Each terminal requires an SLTII(1)-U10 ADP or SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU.
The volume up/down setting for the receive volume control should be used only
by hearing impaired individuals, otherwise hearing damage may occur. This
telephone complies with HAC (Hearing Aid Compatible) volume control defined
by section 68.317 of the FCC Rules and Regulations, 1996 edition.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
12 - 3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 12-2 DTR-1HM-1 TEL Single Line Telephone
___________________________________________________________________________________
12 - 4
Installing Single Line Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 3
WALL MOUNTING DTR-1-1 TEL/DTR-1HM-1 TEL SINGLE LINE
TELEPHONES
Single Line Telephones are wall mounted using the metal base that comes attached
to the telephone.
3.1
Adjusting the Hanger Hook
1.
Remove the hook from the unit.
Hanger Hook
Figure 12-3 Removing the Hanger Hook on a Single Line Telephone
2.
Turn the hook with the tab toward the top.
3.
Slide the hook in the slot to form the hanger hook for the handset.
Figure 12-4 Sliding the Hanger Hook on a Single Line Telephone into
Position
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
12 - 5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.1.1
Wall Mounting the Telephone
1.
Remove the metal base from the telephone by removing the
two screws as illustrated in Figure 12-5 Removing the Metal
Base.
Note Position of
Figure 12-5 Removing the Metal Base
2.
Lift the metal plate and note the direction of the tabs so that
they can be correctly reversed.
3.
Flip the metal base around as illustrated in Figure 12-6
Reattaching the Metal Base. Insert the tabs into the
receptacles marked (A) and reattach to the telephone using the
two screws that were previously removed.
Because of manufacturing variations in wall-mount brackets,
installing the terminal wall mount with optional screws offers the
most reliable fit.
___________________________________________________________________________________
12 - 6
Installing Single Line Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 12-6 Reattaching the Metal Base
4.
Hang the telephone on the wall by sliding the holes in the metal
base over the wall posts.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
12 - 7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.2
Using Hanger Hooks on the Single Line Telephone
After the Single Line Telephone is wall mounted, the handset can be hung
from one of two hanger hooks.
When the handset is placed on the hanger hook, located below the switchook,
the telephone is on-hook.
Hanging the handset from the hook located on the top of the telephone
(labeled (C) in the diagram) allows the telephone to remain off-hook.
Figure 12-7 Hanger Hooks on the Single Line Telephone
___________________________________________________________________________________
12 - 8
Installing Single Line Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.3
DTP-1-1 TEL/ DTP-1-2 TEL
The DTP Single Line Telephone is a fully modular terminal with a Flash key,
Redial key, 3-level receive volume control, 2-level ring volume control, data
jack, and message waiting lamp.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTP-1-1 or DTP-1-2 TELs can be installed. The total
number of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 184 DTP-1-1 or DTP-1-2 TELs can be installed. The total
number of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 200.
Each terminal requires an SLTII(1)-U10 ADP or SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU.
Figure 12-8 DTP-1-1 TEL Single Line Telephone
The H switch setting for the receive volume control should only be used by
hearing impaired individuals, otherwise hearing damage may occur. This
telephone complies with HAC (Hearing Aid Compatible) volume control defined
by section 68.317 of the FCC Rules and Regulations, 1996 edition.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
12 - 9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.4
DTP-1HM-1/ DTP-1HM-2 TEL
The Single Line Telephone is a fully modular terminal with a Flash key, Redial
key, 3-level receive volume control, 2-level ring volume control, data jack,
message waiting lamp, and eight programmable Feature Access/Speed Dial
keys.
Basic Port Package
A maximum of 56 DTP-1HM-1 or DTP-1HM-2 TELs can be installed. The total
number of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 56.
Expanded Port Package
A maximum of 184 DTP-1HM-1 or DTP-1HM-2 TELs can be installed. The
total number of all Multiline Terminals that can be installed is 200.
Each terminal requires an SLTII(1)-U10 ADP or SLI(4)/(8)-U( ) ETU.
Figure 12-9 DTP-1HM-1 TEL Single Line Telephone
The H switch setting for the receive volume control should only be used by
hearing impaired individuals, otherwise hearing damage may occur. This
telephone complies with HAC (Hearing Aid Compatible) volume control defined
by section 68.317 of the FCC Rules and Regulations, 1996 edition.
___________________________________________________________________________________
12 - 10
Installing Single Line Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 4
WALL MOUNTING THE DTP-1-1 OR DTP-1-2 TEL AND DTP-1HM-1 OR
DTP-1HM-2 TEL
4.1
Hanger Hook
1.
Remove the hook from the unit.
Figure 12-10 Removing the DTP Telephone Hanger Hook
2.
Turn the hook over (back to the front) with the tab toward the top.
Figure 12-11 Turning the Hook Over
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
12 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Slide the hook on its glides back down into position forming the hanger
hook for the handset.
Figure 12-12 Sliding the Hook into Position
4.2
Using Installed Modular Wall Plate
1.
Unscrew the three screws on the unit to remove the plate.
Figure 12-13 Removing the Screws
___________________________________________________________________________________
12 - 12
Installing Single Line Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Replace the plate and screw in the two positions. (One remaining screw
can be screwed in at the original third position.)
Figure 12-14 Replacing the Plate and Screw
3.
Loosen the screws on the wall telephone plate to protrude a bit.
Figure 12-15 Protruding Screws
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
12 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.
Install the telephone with the plate on the protruding screws.
Figure 12-16 Mounting the Telephone
___________________________________________________________________________________
12 - 14
Installing Single Line Telephones
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 13
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
General Information ..................................................................................... 13-1
Section 2
Radio Frequency Interference ..................................................................... 13-1
Section 3
Dterm ® Headset Cordless Terminal ............................................................. 13-1
Section 4
Section 5
Section 6
3.1
Description ................................................................................................ 13-1
3.2
Selecting an Installation Location .............................................................. 13-2
3.3
Connecting the Base Unit ......................................................................... 13-3
Dterm ® Headset Cordless II Terminal .......................................................... 13-5
4.1
Description ................................................................................................ 13-5
4.2
Connecting the Switch .............................................................................. 13-6
4.3
Charging the Headset ............................................................................... 13-6
4.4
Configuring the Headset to Your Telephone ............................................. 13-7
4.5
Adjusting the Volume ................................................................................ 13-7
4.6
Operation Using the Dterm ® Headset Cordless II ..................................... 13-8
4.7
System Reset ............................................................................................ 13-8
Dterm ® USB Wireless Headset ..................................................................... 13-9
5.1
Description ................................................................................................ 13-9
5.2
Installing the Base Unit ............................................................................. 13-9
5.3
Installing the PerSonoCall Software .......................................................... 13-9
5.4
Charging the Headset Battery ................................................................. 13-10
5.5
Initial Setup ............................................................................................. 13-10
5.6
Using the Headset ................................................................................... 13-10
Dterm ® Cordless II Terminal ...................................................................... 13-10
6.1
Description .............................................................................................. 13-10
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 7
Section 8
6.2
Selecting an Installation Location ........................................................... 13-11
6.3
Connecting the Telephone Cords ........................................................... 13-11
6.4
Applying Power to the Base Unit ............................................................ 13-12
Installing Dterm ® Handset Cordless Terminal ......................................... 13-13
7.1
Description ............................................................................................. 13-13
7.2
Selecting an Installation Location ........................................................... 13-13
7.3
Connecting the Telephone Cord ............................................................ 13-13
7.4
Applying Power to the Base Unit ............................................................ 13-14
Dterm ® Cordless Lite II ............................................................................... 13-15
8.1
Description ............................................................................................. 13-15
8.2
Installing the Dterm ® Cordless Lite II ...................................................... 13-15
8.2.1 Selecting a Location ......................................................................... 13-15
8.2.2
Controls and Indicators ..................................................................... 13-15
8.3
Installation Precautions .......................................................................... 13-18
8.4
Connecting the Telephone Cords ........................................................... 13-18
8.5
Applying Power to the Charging Unit ..................................................... 13-19
8.6
Wall Installation ...................................................................................... 13-20
8.6.1 Standard Wall Plate Mounting .......................................................... 13-20
8.7
Direct Wall Mounting .............................................................................. 13-23
8.8
Charging Unit Wall Mounting .................................................................. 13-25
8.9
Attaching and Removing the Belt Clip .................................................... 13-26
8.10
Installing the Handset Battery Pack ....................................................... 13-27
8.11
Charging the Handset Battery Pack ....................................................... 13-28
8.12
Battery Hot Swap ................................................................................... 13-28
8.13
Low Battery Indications .......................................................................... 13-29
8.13.1 Standby Mode .................................................................................. 13-29
8.13.2 Talk Mode ......................................................................................... 13-29
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
Electra
Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 9
Section 10
8.14
Cleaning the Battery Charge Contacts .................................................... 13-30
8.15
Antenna ................................................................................................... 13-30
Headsets Used with Dterm ® Telephones .................................................. 13-31
9.1
NEC Dterm ® Cordless Headset (MX150) ................................................ 13-31
9.2
NEC Dterm ® Cordless Phone Headset (M175) ....................................... 13-31
9.3
NEC Dterm ® NEC Polaris SupraPlus™ ................................................... 13-32
9.4
NEC Dterm ® NEC Polaris Mirage ® ........................................................................ 13-33
9.5
NEC Dterm ® NEC Polaris TriStar ® ......................................................... 13-33
9.6
NEC Dterm ® NEC Polaris Encore ® ........................................................ 13-34
NEC Conference Max Plus ........................................................................ 13-35
10.1
Wireless Conferencing System ............................................................... 13-35
10.1.1 Installing the Base Unit ..................................................................... 13-36
10.1.2 Connecting And Charging Batteries ................................................. 13-36
10.1.3 Keypad Functions ............................................................................. 13-36
10.1.4 Programming Options ....................................................................... 13-37
10.1.5 Compliance ....................................................................................... 13-38
Section 11
Wireless – DECT Telephone ...................................................................... 13-39
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
Table of Contents
List of Figures and Tables
Chapter 13
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 13-1
Dterm Headset Cordless Telephone (CT-11) ............................................................13-2
Figure 13-2
Connecting the Dterm Headset Cordless Base Unit to the Adapter ..........................13-3
Figure 13-3
Raising the Antenna on the Dterm Headset Cordless Base Unit ..............................13-3
Figure 13-4
Connecting the Dterm Headset Cordless Telephone Cord
to the AP(R)-R Unit ..................................................................................................13-4
Figure 13-5
Dterm Headset Cordless II ........................................................................................13-5
Figure 13-6
Dterm USB Wireless Headset (CS50-USB) ..............................................................13-9
Figure 13-7
Dterm Cordless II ..................................................................................................... 13-11
Figure 13-8
Connecting the Base Unit ....................................................................................... 13-12
Figure 13-9
Dterm Handset Cordless Terminal .......................................................................... 13-14
Figure 13-10
Dterm Cordless Lite II Controls and Indicators ........................................................ 13-16
Figure 13-11
Connecting Base Unit to the Telephone Jack ........................................................ 13-18
Figure 13-12
Connecting the Base Unit to the Multiline Terminal ............................................... 13-19
Figure 13-13
Applying Power to the Charging Unit ..................................................................... 13-19
Figure 13-14
Polarized Plug ........................................................................................................ 13-20
Figure 13-15
Attaching the Wall Mount Stand to the Base Unit .................................................. 13-21
Figure 13-16
Placing the AC Adapter Cord In the Wall Mount Stand .......................................... 13-21
Figure 13-17
Placing the Base Unit on the Posts of the Wall Plate ............................................. 13-22
Figure 13-18
Plugging the AC Adapter into the AC Wall Outlet .................................................. 13-22
Figure 13-19
Inserting Screws into the Wall for Wall Mounting the Telephone ........................... 13-23
Figure 13-20
Placing the Telephone Cords in the Wall Mount Stand .......................................... 13-24
Figure 13-21
Attaching the Wall Mount Unit to the Wall ..............................................................13-24
Figure 13-22
Inserting Screws for Wall Mounting ........................................................................ 13-25
Figure 13-23
Wrapping AC Adapter Cord Around the Strain Relief Clip ..................................... 13-25
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
v
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 13-24
Attaching the Belt Clip to the Handset ................................................................... 13-26
Figure 13-25
Removing the Belt Clip ........................................................................................... 13-26
Figure 13-26
Removing the Battery Cover .................................................................................. 13-27
Figure 13-27
Replacing the Battery Pack .................................................................................... 13-27
Figure 13-28
Replacing the Battery Cover .................................................................................. 13-28
Table 13-1
Low Battery ............................................................................................................ 13-29
Figure 13-29
Cleaning Battery Charge Contacts ......................................................................... 13-30
Figure 13-30
Raising the Base Unit Antenna .............................................................................. 13-30
Figure 13-31
Cordless Headset (MX150) .................................................................................... 13-31
Figure 13-32
Cordless Headset (M175) ...................................................................................... 13-32
Figure 13-33
NEC Polaris Supraplus ......................................................................................... 13-32
Figure 13-34
NEC Polaris Mirage ................................................................................................ 13-33
Figure 13-35
NEC Polaris TriStar ................................................................................................ 13-33
Figure 13-36
NEC Polaris Encore ............................................................................................... 13-34
Figure 13-37
NEC Conference Max Plus .................................................................................... 13-35
Table 13-2
Keypad Functions .................................................................................................. 13-36
Table 13-3
Programming Options ............................................................................................ 13-37
Figure 13-38
Wireless – DECT Telephone .................................................................................. 13-39
___________________________________________________________________________________
vi
List of Figures and Tables
Installing Cordless and
Wireless Telephones
Chapter 13
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
This chapter provides information regarding cordless telephones that can be used in
conjunction with the Electra Elite IPK II system.
SECTION 2
RADIO FREQUENCY INTERFERENCE
When using these cordless RF devices some interference can take place when
operating the cordless telephones in the same environment as other wireless devices
that operate in the same frequency spectrum.
Depending on your environment, the maximum number of cordless devices used
without interference varies.
SECTION 3
Dterm ® HEADSET CORDLESS TERMINAL
3.1
Description
The CT-11 Dterm Headset Cordless telephone is a convenient, pocket-sized
telephone that allows the user to speak and listen in handsfree mode. This
telephone has a 3-line, 16-character backlit handset display. Tone/Pulse
dialing, handset ear piece and ringer volume control, up to 100 phonebook
locations, one-touch dialing, mute, flash, pause, handset find, and
noise-canceling microphone are some of the features that this telephone
provides. Two headsets, a belt clip and holster are also included with this
telephone. This headset is for Single Line Telephones, has a 400-foot range,
and provides 5.5 hours of talk time.
This telephone has a 2.4 GHz frequency range and provides secure
conversation and reduces interference from other cordless telephones.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 13-1 Dterm Headset Cordless Telephone (CT-11)
3.2
Selecting an Installation Location
Before choosing a location for your new telephone, consider these important
guidelines:
J
J
J
J
The location should be close to both a telephone jack and continuous
power outlet. A continuous power outlet is an AC outlet which does not
have a switch to interrupt power.
Keep the base and handset away from sources of electrical noise such
as motors or fluorescent lighting.
Be sure that the base antenna can be fully extended.
The base can be placed on a desk or tabletop or mounted on a standard
telephone wall plate.
Charge your new telephone for 15~20 hours before completing the installation
or using the handset.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 2
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.3
Connecting the Base Unit
1.
Connect the AC adapter to the DC IN 9 V jack and to a standard 120V
AC wall outlet.
Route the cord
To AC Outlet
To DC IN 9V
AC Adapter
(supplied)
Figure 13-2 Connecting the Dterm Headset
Cordless Base Unit to the Adapter
2.
Set the base on a desk or tabletop, and place the handset in the base
unit as shown.
Figure 13-3 Raising the Antenna on the Dterm Headset Cordless Base Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Raise the antenna to a vertical position.
4.
Make sure the status LED is On. When the LED is not On, check to see
that the AC adapter is plugged in and that the handset makes good
contact with the base charging contacts.
H
H
H
H
5.
Use only the supplied AC adapter (730627).
Connect the AC adapter to a continuous power supply.
Place the base unit close to the AC outlet so you can unplug the
AC adapter easily.
After installing the battery pack in the handset, charge the handset
at least three to five hours before plugging it into the telephone line.
Connect the telephone line cord to the TEL LINE jack and the other end
to the AP(R)-R Unit. Refer to paragraph 3.3 AP(A)-R Unit/AP(R)-R Unit
(Port Adapter) on page 9-14 for detailed instructions for installing the
AP(R)-R Unit. This unit can also be connected using an SLI(4)/(8)-U( )
ETU.
AP(R)-R Unit
To TEL LINE
Telephone Line Cord
(supplied)
Figure 13-4 Connecting the Dterm Headset Cordless
Telephone Cord to the AP(R)-R Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 4
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Place the power cord so that it does not create a trip hazard or where it could
become chafed and create a fire or electrical hazard.
Observe the following warnings during installation:
J
J
J
SECTION 4
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.
Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the
telephone line is disconnected at the network interface.
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.
Dterm ® HEADSET CORDLESS II TERMINAL
4.1
Description
The DTR-1C-2 (CS50 Wireless Office Headset System) combines ultimate
mobility with excellent sound quality for hands-free conversation. Refer to
Figure 13-5 Dterm Headset Cordless II.
Listening Volume/Mute
Headset
Talk Button
Talk Indicator
Power Indicator
Charge Indicator
Configuring Dial
Charge Cradle
+ Speak Volume
On Back
Major Listen Vol.
Switch On Back
Lifter On/Off
Down is On
Base
Figure 13-5 Dterm Headset Cordless II
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
This headset gives you up to eight hours talk time with the convenience of
roaming up to 300 feet with secure conversations. It continually charges in the
cradle, and when in use, taking or ending a call requires pressing the talk
button.
An included automatic handset lifter fits on the associated telephone to lift the
handset or return it to the cradle to let you answer calls remotely with the
touch of a button by automatically taking your handset off-hook.
An amplifier boosts the signal to the wireless headset and connects to the
existing telephone using 64-bit digitally encrypted signals to provide secure
communication.
The headset is powered by a LITHIUM ION Polymer (Li-ion) Battery.
4.2
Connecting the Switch
Connection requires installing an AP(R)-R analog adapter (not supplied with
this unit) on the multiline terminal.
4.3
1.
Connect the AC power adapter to the AC Power Adapter Jack (indicated
by a 9V icon) on the bottom of the Base, and plug the adapter into a
power source.
2.
The DTR-1C-2 switch is a small rectangular unit with a line cable on one
end and a line cable and fixed cable on the other. Connect the fixed
cable to the Lifter jack (located left of the AC Power adapter jack) on the
bottom of the Base.
3.
Connect the Line cord next to the fixed cable on the switch to the Base
connector on the bottom of the Base unit indicated by a telephone icon.
4.
Connect the single line on the other end of the DTR-1C-2 switch to the
AP(R)-R analog adapter and connect the AP(R)-R adapter to the
telephone.
Charging the Headset
Slide the Headset into the charging cradle on the Base. The Amber charging
indicator blinks. When the Headset is charged, the indicator remains on
continuously. A complete charge takes three hours.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 6
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.4
Configuring the Headset to Your Telephone
When any of the following situations occurs, the Headset must be configured
to be compatible with your telephone:
J
J
J
J
Dial tone is not present.
The caller is not heard.
The caller does not hear you.
Hissing or buzzing is heard in the Headset.
To configure the Headset:
1.
Lift the telephone handset.
2.
Press the Talk Button.
3.
Locate the configuration Dial, and rotate it to another of the four
positions until a dial tone is heard.
4.5
Align the number with the seam line on the right side.
Adjusting the Volume
Listening Volume
1.
Adjust listening volume using Listening Volume/Mute control on the
headset speaker end.
2.
Rock the control up or down for volume changes.
When the volume is still too loud or too soft, locate the Listening Volume
Major Switch on back of the Base, and move it to another of the four
positions.
Speaking Volume
1.
Adjust speaking volume using the plus or minus button on back of the
Base.
2.
When the volume is still too loud or too soft, locate the four-position
switch on the bottom of the Base, and move it to another of the four
positions.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Using the Mute Feature
1.
Push in the Listening Volume/Mute Control to mute the headset.
2.
4.6
A light beep indicates mute is being used.
Push the control again to turn off the mute feature.
Operation Using the Dterm ® Headset Cordless II
Switch from Headset to Handset
When you are using the headset during a call and want to switch to the
handset:
1.
Remove the handset from the Base.
2.
Press the headset Talk Button, and the handset can be used.
Switch from Handset to Headset
When you are using the handset during a call and want to switch to the
headset:
4.7
1.
Press the headset Talk Button, and the headset can be used.
2.
Place the telephone handset on the Multiline Terminal.
3.
When finished, press the Headset Talk Button to end the call.
System Reset
To recover from some faults, system reset may be necessary. To perform
system reset:
1.
Press both the Talk Button and Mute Control Button on the headset for
five seconds.
2.
When the Talk Indicator blinks release both buttons.
3.
Press the Talk Button again.
4.
Disconnect the AC Power Adapter from the jack for five seconds and
then plug it back in.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 8
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 5
Dterm ® USB WIRELESS HEADSET
5.1
Description
This headset supports IPK/IPK II WebDial Softphone version 2.1.4.0 or higher
and SP30 Softphone version 9 or higher with digital encryption, TIA810a
compliance, and a noise-canceling microphone for secure, clear, and quiet
conversations. It has a 200-foot range and includes nine hours talk time.
The headset can be converted to accommodate over-the-head or over-the-ear
styles.
Status Indicator
Charge Indicator
Charge Contacts
Headset Docking Cradle
Base Unit
Ringer Switch On/Off
AC Power
Adapter Port
Volume/Mute
Control
Stand
Talk Button
On-Line Indicator
Microphone
Figure 13-6 Dterm USB Wireless Headset (CS50-USB)
5.2
Installing the Base Unit
Attach the Base Unit to the stand pegs, and connect the USB connector to a
free USB port on your computer. A USB hub can be used, if you are certain
that it can supply the required 250mA to charge the headset. An optional AC
power adapter can be installed in the AC Power Adapter Port.
5.3
Installing the PerSonoCall Software
To install the software, insert the CD supplied with the unit. If the CD does not
autoplay, use Windows Explorer to find the file called install.bat, double click
on it, and follow the instructions on the screen.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.4
Charging the Headset Battery
To charge the headset battery, place it in the docking cradle. During charging,
the charge indicator is On. When charging is complete the indicator goes Off.
The headset must be charged for a minimum of one hour before use – three
hours to fully charge.
5.5
Initial Setup
The Unit includes a ringer in the base to provide notification of an incoming
call when not wearing your headset. This feature is enabled when the Ringer
switch is down and is disabled when the switch is up.
When the headset is installed, it sets itself as the default device in your
computer. You can set your preferences manually in Windows through the
Sounds and Audio Devices option in the control panel. A softphone may
require choosing the audio device and carries out a short test to match this
device to the softphone. It may also enable you to choose which device
indicates an incoming call. Refer to the softphone documentation for more
information.
5.6
Using the Headset
Refer to the User Guide for operating procedures.
SECTION 6
Dterm ® CORDLESS II TERMINAL
6.1
Description
The Dterm Cordless II terminal uses 900 MHz Digital Spread Spectrum (DSS)
Technology and is connected in tandem to a Multiline Terminal. The terminal
has a 16-digit, 2-line LCD, dial pad, talk key, chan key, hold key, transfer key,
conf key, mute key, vol key, a msg icon, vibrator, and four function keys with
red LEDs.
In an ideal state, this terminal can be switched between cordless and the
Multiline Terminal connected to it using Cordless or Desk key on the base unit.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 10
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 13-7 Dterm Cordless II
6.2
Selecting an Installation Location
Select a location to avoid excessive heat or humidity. The base unit should be
placed on a desk or tabletop near a standard 120 Vac outlet and within reach
of the telephone line connection on the Electra Elite IPK Multiline Terminal.
Keep the base unit and the handset away from sources of electrical noise (e.g.
fluorescent lighting).
6.3
Connecting the Telephone Cords
The Dterm Cordless II terminal is connected to the telephone line and to the
host telephone using two telephone line jacks on the back of the Base Unit:
LINE IN and LINE OUT.
Observe the following warnings during installation:
J
J
J
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.
Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the
telephone line is disconnected at the network interface.
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
To connect the Dterm Cordless Terminal to the host telephone:
6.4
1.
Unplug the telephone line cord from the host telephone, and connect it to
the LINE IN jack.
2.
Using the telephone line cord supplied with the Dterm Cordless Terminal,
connect the LINE OUT jack to the host telephone jack.
Applying Power to the Base Unit
1.
Plug the AC Adapter cord into the AC Adapter input jack on the Base
Unit.
Use only the AC Adapter supplied with the Dterm Handset Cordless
Terminal.
2.
Plug the AC Adapter into a standard 120 Vac wall outlet.
3.
Route the power cord where it does not create a trip hazard or where it
could become chafed and create a fire or other electrical hazards.
The AC Adapter furnished with this telephone can be equipped with a
polarized line plug (a plug having one blade wider than the other). This
plug fits into the power outlet only one way. When you cannot insert the
plug fully into the outlet, reverse the plug. When the plug still does not fit,
contact your facilities coordinator about replacing the obsolete plug. Do
not alter the shape of the blades of the polarized plug.
Line OUT to Host
Line IN from
Telephone Jack
Figure 13-8 Connecting the Base Unit
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 12
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 7
INSTALLING Dterm ® HANDSET CORDLESS TERMINAL
7.1
Description
This Dterm Handset Cordless Terminal is a stand-alone telephone with direct
connection to a single port on the ESI(8)-U( ) ETU.
An ACA-U Unit adapter is required for this terminal.
Each terminal requires an ESI(8)-U( ) ETU port.
7.2
Selecting an Installation Location
Select a location for the DTP-16HC-1 TEL to avoid excessive heat or humidity.
The base unit should be placed on a desk or tabletop near a standard 120 Vac
outlet and within reach of the telephone line connection on the Electra Elite
IPK Multiline Terminal. Keep the base unit and the handset away from sources
of electrical noise (e.g., fluorescent lighting).
7.3
Connecting the Telephone Cord
The Base Unit of the DTP-16HC-1 TEL has two jacks on the back: LINE and
DC24V.
Observe the following warnings during installation:
J
J
J
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.
Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the
telephone line is disconnected at the network interface.
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.
Using the telephone line cord supplied with the terminal, connect the LINE
jack to the telephone line.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 13-9 Dterm Handset Cordless Terminal
7.4
Applying Power to the Base Unit
1.
Power to charge the battery is supplied from the Telephone line.
2.
An ACA-U Unit must be installed in the optional DC24V jack on the Base
Unit to provide power for the Dterm Handset Cordless Terminal.
3.
Plug the ACA-U Unit into a standard 120 Vac wall outlet.
4.
The power level between the Handset and the Base is 10mW.
5.
When the ACA-U Unit is used, route the power cord where it does not
create a trip hazard or where it could become chafed and create a fire or
electrical hazard.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 14
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 8
Dterm ® CORDLESS LITE II
8.1
Description
This cordless terminal achieves a maximum range of 50~150 feet for
transmitting and receiving in accordance with the highest specifications set by
the FCC and IC Part 15. Range is limited by environment, and too many
variables preclude a standard determination. The range quoted is for
reference as a means to compare with other range claims.
Radio interference can be caused by external sources such as TV, fluorescent
lighting, electrical storms, or other wireless devices. The base unit should not
be plugged into a circuit with a connection to a major appliance, and the
antenna should always be fully extended.
8.2
Installing the Dterm ® CORDLESS LITE II
8.2.1
Selecting a Location
Select a location for the Dterm CORDLESS LITE II terminal to avoid
excessive heat or humidity. The base unit of the terminal can be
placed on a desk or tabletop near a standard 120 Vac outlet and
telephone line jack. The base unit can also be mounted on a
standard wall plate using the wall mount adapter. Keep the base unit
and handset away from sources of electrical noise (motors,
fluorescent lighting, computers, PC monitor).
8.2.2
Controls and Indicators
Controls and Indicators are shown on the next page.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
1
Headset Jack
9.
Conference (CONF) Key
2.
LCD Message Display
10. Transfer (TRANSFER)
Key
3.
Hold (HOLD) Key
11.
4.
Talk (TALK) Key
12. Redial (REDIAL) or
Desk/Cordless Softkey
Switch Key
5.
Numeric Keypad
13. F3
6.
F2
14. F4
7.
F1
15. Ringer/Volume (Ring/Vol)
Key
8.
Microphone
16. Mute (MUTE) Key
Channel (CH) Key
Figure 13-10 Dterm Cordless Lite II Controls and Indicators
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 16
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
17
18
19
20
21 22 23
17. Line Out
21. Power
18. Line In
22. Desk LED
19. Cordless
23. Desk
20. Cordless LED
Figure 13-10 Dterm Cordless Lite II Controls and Indicators (Continued)
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.3
Installation Precautions
To ensure optimum performance follow these guidelines:
J
J
J
J
8.4
Each base unit must be placed at least 15 feet apart.
The base antenna should be raised to the vertical position.
Always place the base unit on top of a desk or on higher shelves. Avoid
locations surrounded by metal surfaces.
Place the base away from any electrical component such as a PC,
monitor, or other telephone.
Connecting the Telephone Cords
When connecting the telephone cords, observe the following precautions:
J
J
J
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.
Never touch bare telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line
is disconnected at the network interface.
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.
To connect the telephone cords:
1.
Connect the cord from the telephone jack to the Base Unit LINE IN jack.
Line in From
Telephone
Jack
Figure 13-11 Connecting Base Unit to the Telephone Jack
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 18
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
2.
Connect a qualified NEC digital Multiline Terminal to the LINE OUT jack.
Line Out
Dterm Series E
or Series i
Multiline Terminal
Figure 13-12 Connecting the Base Unit to the Multiline Terminal
8.5
Applying Power to the Charging Unit
The unique design of the telephone allows the user to place the handset in the
charging unit with or without the belt clip attached. The battery pack is
recharged automatically in the handset unit.
AC
Adapter
Figure 13-13 Applying Power to the Charging Unit
Use only the supplied AC adapter for the charging unit.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
The AC adapter furnished with this telephone may be equipped with a
polarized line plug (one blade is wider than the other). This plug fits in the
power outlet only one way. Refer to Figure 13-14 Polarized Plug.
When you cannot plug the AC adapter in the outlet, you may need to replace
it.
AC Adapter
Wide Blade
Figure 13-14 Polarized Plug
Route the power cord where it cannot create a trip hazard, or
where it could become chafed and create a fire or other
electrical hazards.
8.6
Wall Installation
8.6.1
Standard Wall Plate Mounting
The base unit can be mounted on standard wall plate. To attach the
wall mount stand to the base unit:
1.
Slide the wall mount stand in the notches at the top of the base
unit. Rotate the wall mount stand down and snap it into place.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 20
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 13-15 Attaching the Wall Mount Stand to the Base Unit
2.
Plug the AC adapter in the base unit.
3.
Place the AC adapter cord inside the molded channel of the
wall mount stand.
Figure 13-16 Placing the AC Adapter Cord In the Wall Mount Stand
4.
Plug one end of the short telephone cord (locally supplied) in
the LINE IN jack on the base unit. Plug one end of the NEC
digital multiline telephone in the LINE OUT jack. Place the
telephone cords inside the molded channels on the bottom of
the wall mount stand.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 21
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
5.
Plug the other end of the short telephone cord in the modular
wall jack in the center of the wall plate.
6.
Place the base unit on the posts of the wall plate and push
down until it is firmly seated.
Figure 13-17 Placing the Base Unit on the Posts of the Wall Plate
7.
Plug the AC adapter into a standard 120 Vac wall outlet.
Do not use an outlet controlled by a wall switch.
Wide Blade
AC
Adapter
Figure 13-18 Plugging the AC Adapter into the AC Wall Outlet
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 22
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.7
Direct Wall Mounting
When a standard wall plate is not available, mount the telephone directly on
the wall. Before mounting the telephone, consider the following:
J
J
J
Select a location away from electrical cables, pipes, or other items
behind the mounting location that could cause a hazard when inserting
screws into the wall.
Make sure the wall material can support the weight of the base unit.
Use #10 screws with anchoring devices suitable for the wall material.
To mount the telephone:
1.
Insert two mounting screws 3-15/16 inches apart. Allow about 3/16 of an
inch between the wall and screw heads for mounting the telephone.
Figure 13-19 Inserting Screws into the Wall for Wall Mounting the
Telephone
2.
Plug in and secure the AC adapter.
3.
Plug the AC adapter into the base unit.
4.
Plug one end of the short telephone cord in the LINE In JACK on the
base unit. Then plug an Electra Elite IPK multiline terminal line in the
LINE OUT jack. Place the telephone cords inside the molded channels
on the bottom of the wall mount stand.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 23
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 13-20 Placing the Telephone Cords in the Wall Mount Stand
5.
Place the base unit on the posts of the wall screws and push down until
it is firmly seated.
Figure 13-21 Attaching the Wall Mount Unit to the Wall
6.
Plug the other end of the short telephone cord in a telephone wall jack.
7.
Plug the AC adapter in a standard 120 Vac wall outlet. Refer to Figure
13-18 Plugging the AC Adapter into the AC Wall Outlet on page 13-22.
Do not use an outlet controlled by a wall switch.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 24
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.8
Charging Unit Wall Mounting
The charging unit can be wall mounted. Before installing, consider the
following:
J
J
J
Select a location away from electrical cables, pipes, or items behind the
mounting location that could cause a hazard when inserting screws.
Make sure the wall material can support the weight of the charging unit.
Use #10 screws with anchoring devices suitable for the wall material.
To mount the charging unit:
1.
Insert two mounting screws one inch apart. Allow about 3/16 of an inch
between the wall and screw heads for mounting the telephone.
TOP
3/16 in.
1 3/16 in.
Figure 13-22 Inserting Screws for Wall Mounting
2.
Plug the AC adapter in the charging unit. Wrap the AC adapter cord
around the strain relief.
Strain
Relief
Figure 13-23 Wrapping AC Adapter Cord Around the Strain Relief Clip
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 25
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
8.9
Plug the AC adapter in a standard 120 Vac wall outlet.
Attaching and Removing the Belt Clip
A belt clip can be used to attach the handset to a belt or pocket for convenient
portability.
1.
Slide the clip in the tab slots. Press firmly until it snaps into place. The
belt clip fits snugly on the handset.
Figure 13-24 Attaching the Belt Clip to the Handset
2.
To remove the clip, press the retaining clip in toward the belt clip blade
and slide the clip up at the same time.
Figure 13-25 Removing the Belt Clip
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 26
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.10
Installing the Handset Battery Pack
Before installing batteries, refer to Chapter 1 Regulatory Information. Follow
safety regulations when handling batteries.
1.
To remove the battery cover, press the latch and slide the cover down
and off the handset.
Figure 13-26 Removing the Battery Cover
2.
Slide the battery pack down into the handset.
It may be necessary to remove the old battery at this time.
Red
Black
White
Figure 13-27 Replacing the Battery Pack
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 27
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.
Replace the cover and slide it forward until it latches.
Figure 13-28 Replacing the Battery Cover
8.11
Charging the Handset Battery Pack
The rechargeable battery pack must be fully charged before using the Dterm
Cordless Lite II handset for the first time.
Charge the battery pack without interruption for five to eight hours.
1.
Place the handset in the slot of the charging unit.
2.
Make sure the CHARGE indicator lights. If the CHARGE LED does not
come on, check to see if the AC adapter is plugged in and that the
handset is making good contact with the charging contacts on the
charging unit.
8.12
The CHARGE LED lights red during and after charging the handset with
the battery.
Battery Hot Swap
The battery can be hot swapped while a conversation is taking place. The
battery must be changed within 20 seconds or connection is lost.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 28
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.13
Low Battery Indications
The handset has visual and audible indicators to warn of a low battery
condition. The indicators are different for standby mode and talk mode.
8.13.1
Standby Mode
The handset display turns on the
battery low icon. All LEDs are
turned off and LCD messages are
cleared. A battery low alert tone is
emitted every 15 seconds and lasts
for three minutes.
8.13.2
lOW
Talk Mode
The handset display turns on the
battery low icon. All keys and
8085351840
functions are available. The battery
TALK
low alert tone is emitted every three
seconds as long as conversation
continues. After conversation is
completed, the handset returns to the battery low condition in
standby mode.
When you receive the low battery indication, return the handset to the base
unit for charging or replace the handset battery pack with another charged
battery pack.
The following table indicates what occurs and the action to be taken during a
call or in standby mode when low battery indication is displayed.
Table 13-1 Low Battery
On a Call
In Standby Mode
When batt low is displayed:
Only the TALK key operates.
None of the keys operate.
Handset beeps once every three
seconds.
Handset beeps every 15 seconds for
15 minutes.
Action:
Complete the call as quickly as possible.
Cannot make a call.
Replace the battery pack within 20
seconds to continue a call.
Replace the battery pack before
making another call.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 29
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
8.14
Cleaning the Battery Charge Contacts
To maintain a good charge, clean all charging contacts on the handset and
charging unit about once a month. Use a pencil eraser or other contact
cleaner. Do not use liquids or solvents.
Figure 13-29 Cleaning Battery Charge Contacts
8.15
Antenna
Before using the Cordless II telephone raise the antenna to the vertical
position as illustrated in Figure 13-30 Raising the Base Unit Antenna.
Figure 13-30 Raising the Base Unit Antenna
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 30
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 9
HEADSETS USED WITH Dterm ® TELEPHONES
All headsets are equipped with a quick disconnect feature that allows you to move
away from the phone without removing the headset.
9.1
NEC Dterm ® CORDLESS HEADSET (MX150)
M Series Pin Jack Style headsets MX150 and M175 below allow maximum
versatility for wireless or cordless phones. They are easy to put on and can be
worn in either ear. These headsets include an EarBudeez ™ stabilizer for
best possible fit to prevent the headset from becoming dislodged during
important conversations. Over-the-head or over-the-ear style allows you to
select the most comfortable fit.
Figure 13-31 Cordless Headset (MX150)
9.2
NEC Dterm ® CORDLESS PHONE HEADSET (M175)
The NEC M175 mobile headset offers hands-free convenience anywhere you
go. Its convertible design can be worn with a headband or earloop on either
ear, depending on whether you want greater stability or convenient small size.
The pivoting noise-canceling microphone keeps your voice crystal clear, even
in noisy environments. Comfortable, durable, and lightweight, it also works
with headset-ready cordless phones and features a one-touch volume and
mute control so you can be heard clearly.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 31
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Figure 13-32 Cordless Headset (M175)
9.3
NEC Dterm ® NEC POLARIS SUPRAPLUS™
Supra Series Monaural or Binaural headsets are super stable and perfect for
phone-intensive jobs. They have an adjustable headband so they can be
worn all day. The Binaural model allows you to hear conversations in extra
noisy environments.
Figure 13-33 NEC Polaris Supraplus
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 32
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
9.4
NEC Dterm ® NEC Polaris Mirage ®
With no headband, no eartip, no hands, no hassle, these headsets are
lightweight and have concert hall acoustics. With its over-the-ear fit and
receiver that rests gently against the ear it is easy to forget that it is being
worn.
Figure 13-34 NEC Polaris Mirage
9.5
NEC Dterm ® NEC POLARIS TRISTAR
®
For business professionals who require comfort and stability in an
over-the-ear design that does not mess up their hair, the TriStar headset is the
best solution. It’s three point design ensures that it is comfortable and stable
on the ear. It is very lightweight and can also fit most eyeglass wearers.
Figure 13-35 NEC Polaris TriStar
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 33
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
9.6
NEC Dterm ® NEC POLARIS ENCORE ®
Monaural or Binaural Encore headsets are comfortable and practical for
almost everyone. Human factors engineering for near universal fit, light weight
all day comfort, and the SES® (Sound Enhancement System) tone control
switch that allows bass and treble settings brings a new generation of headset
technology.
Figure 13-36 NEC Polaris Encore
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 34
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 10
NEC CONFERENCE MAX PLUS
10.1
Wireless Conferencing System
This wireless conferencing system is ideal for small conference rooms with up
to eight participants. Max Plus provides wireless One-Touch Conferencing
convenience without compromising audio quality or call security. Max Plus
uses Digital Enhanced Cordless Telecommunication (DECT) wireless
standards depending on the model.
Each pod contains a rechargeable battery pack with nickel metal hydride
batteries (7.2 Volts, 2200 mAh) that allows 12 hours of continuous talk time. A
Base Unit that is connected to a power source and analog telephone service is
required for operation of the conferencing pods.
Figure 13-37 NEC Conference Max Plus
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 35
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
10.1.1
10.1.2
Installing the Base Unit
1.
Connect the provided RJ-11 cable between the Base Unit and
the telephone jack.
2.
Connect the power cord to the Base Unit and plug it in an
electrical outlet.
3.
If desired, connect a recording device to the 2.5mm audio jack.
Connecting And Charging Batteries
1.
Slide the cover off the battery compartment on the bottom of
one pod.
2.
Connect the battery pack plug in the port in the compartment
and install the battery pack.
3.
Slide the cover back in place.
4.
Connect the power supply/charger to the conferencing pod and
plug it in an electrical outlet.
5.
10.1.3
Charge batteries for 15 hours prior to first use.
Repeat steps 1~4 for the other pod.
Keypad Functions
Refer to Table 13-2 Keypad Functions.
Table 13-2 Keypad Functions
Key
Function
ON/OFF key
(telephone icon)
Press to activate the telephone and access dial tone.
Press again to hang up and return to standby mode.
PHONEBOOK (book
icon)
Press to dial stored numbers. Press and hold two
seconds to enter Phonebook Edit mode.
REDIAL (circular arrow
icon)
Press once to dial the last number called. Press and
hold two seconds to enter Program mode.
CONFERENCE (three
person icon)
Press to dial the conferencing service provider. This
feature must be programmed.
FLASH (lightning flash
icon)
Press to enable call forwarding, call waiting, or threeway calling when supported by telephone service.
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 36
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 13-2 Keypad Functions
Key
10.1.4
Function
CLEAR (vertical line
and left arrow icon)
Press to clear the last digit entered or press and hold
to clear all numbers.
Press to exit programming mode.
VOLUME (loud and
dim speaker icons)
Press during call to adjust call volume or press while
telephone is ringing or in standby mode to adjust
ringer volume.
MUTE (mic with
diagonal line icon)
Press to mute sound.
Programming Options
To enter Programming mode, press and hold REDIAL until a
diamond arrow is displayed on the LCD. Then press the applicable
key and follow the instruction in Table 13-3 Programming Options.
Table 13-3 Programming Options
Menu Option
Ringer Melody
Dialing Mode
Key
1
2
Programming
Press REDIAL. The current melody selection
flashes. Press 1~5 to change melody. Press
REDIAL to save the selection.
Press REDIAL. The current dialing selection
flashes. Press 1 for tone or 2 for pulse. Press
REDIAL to save the selection.
3
Press REDIAL. The current duration flashes.
Press 1~5 to select duration as follows:
1 = 600 ms
2 = 300 ms
3 = 150 ms
4 = 100 ms
5 = 80 ms
Press REDIAL to save the selection.
Local Number,
4
Press REDIAL. Enter the telephone number
that you want displayed on the LCD in
standby mode. Press REDIAL to save the
number.
Conference,
5
Press REDIAL. Enter the telephone number
you want the conference key to dial. Press
REDIAL to save the number.
Service,
6
Press REDIAL. Enter the telephone number
you want the O key to dial. Press REDIAL to
save the number.
Flash Duration
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 37
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 13-3 Programming Options (Continued)
Menu Option
,
10.1.5
Key
Programming
Press CLEAR to return the previous menu. Press and hold to exit
programming without saving changes.
Press and hold 1 to enter hyphen or , to enter a space in the number.
Press CLEAR before entering a new number.
Compliance
This product is in compliance with the following regulations and
requirements:
J
FCC Part 15/ICES-003
This product has been tested and complies with the limits for a
Class A digital device.
J
FCC Part 68
US:FBIMT01B910158015 Ringer Equivalence Number
(REN):0.1B(ac)
J
Industry of Canada (IC)
IC: 1970A-158015: REN:0.1B(ac)
J
European
Council Directive 1999/5/EC
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 38
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 11
WIRELESS – DECT TELEPHONE
The wireless Digital Enhanced Cordless Telecommunication (DECT) telephone
provides wireless freedom that also allows access to features provided by the Electra
Elite IPK II system. A BSU(4M)-U20 ETU interfaces the Electra Elite IPK II KSU with
four Base Stations that can be expanded to 16 Base Stations using two BSU(6S)-U20
ETUs. The Electra Elite IPK II expanded system supports 40 Wireless – DECT
Telephones. The Electra Elite IPK II basic system supports 24 Wireless – DECT
Telephones.
Figure 13-38 Wireless – DECT Telephone
For more detailed information, refer to the User’s Guide that is furnished with each
telephone.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
13 - 39
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
13 - 40
Installing Cordless and Wireless Telephones
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Chapter 14
___________________________________________________________________________________
Section 1
Introduction .................................................................................................. 14-1
Section 2
Operational Current and Voltage Checks .................................................. 14-1
Section 3
Operational Test Procedures ...................................................................... 14-2
3.1
General Information .................................................................................. 14-2
3.2
Section 4
Before Initializing ........................................................................... 14-2
3.2.1
Cable Connections .................................................................. 14-2
3.2.2
AC/DC Power .......................................................................... 14-2
3.2.3
Initialization Check .................................................................. 14-3
3.3
System Initialization ....................................................................... 14-3
3.4
After Initialization
......................................................................... 14-3
Troubleshooting ........................................................................................... 14-4
4.1
Remote Administration and Maintenance ................................................. 14-4
4.2
4.3
Problem Solving ............................................................................. 14-4
4.2.1
System Down .......................................................................... 14-4
4.2.2
Partial Operation ..................................................................... 14-4
4.2.3
Reset ....................................................................................... 14-4
Flowcharts ..................................................................................... 14-5
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
i
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
ii
Table of Contents
List Of tables
Chapter 14
___________________________________________________________________________________
Table 14-1
Voltage Measurement ........................................................................................14-2
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
iii
Document
Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
iv
List of Tables
System Maintenance
Chapter 14
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 1
INTRODUCTION
The technician can use this chapter to troubleshoot and diagnose problems during
and after system installation. The troubleshooting flow charts and general test
procedures help the technician identify possible causes of the problem by defining the
problem area.
Using the System Data Upload/Download feature, all System Programming and
Speed Dial data can be stored on disk for safe keeping. After all System
Programming is completed, it should be downloaded to a disk for backup. When
system memory fails, this data on the disk can be uploaded and the memory restored.
SECTION 2
OPERATIONAL CURRENT AND VOLTAGE CHECKS
The effectiveness of this maintenance section depends on the technician. Due to
external factors, the technician should not make any assumptions. For example, do
not assume that a new power supply used to replace another power supply is working
properly. Check the output of the power supply with a Volt meter.
The ESI(8)-U( ) ETU allows the measurement of +5V and –24V. This ETU can be
used in the expansion KSU for the power output measurements. Refer to Table 14-1
Voltage Measurement. Before the technician can troubleshoot, the correct tools must
be available. Some of these are listed below:
J
J
J
Digital or analog multimeter that can read DC and AC current and voltage and
DC resistance.
Test Set (lineman) that has termination and monitor modes and DTMF and DP
dialing.
Hand tools such as:
H
H
H
Screwdrivers (flat and Phillips head)
Pliers (long nose and diagonal)
Punch down tool
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 3
OPERATIONAL TEST PROCEDURES
3.1
General Information
When an Electra Elite IPK II system is first powered up, an initialization is
performed. During this process the CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, located in the Basic
KSU, scans each interface slot to determine the hardware configuration used.
This information is stored in the resident system program memory with the
system default values. This section provides test procedures that are used
before, during, and after the initialization process.
3.2
Before Initializing
The technician must follow these steps before initializing the system.
3.2.1
Cable Connections
All wiring for power supplies or flat cable connectors should be
checked for solid connections.
3.2.2
AC/DC Power
Check all power with an AC/DC multimeter. (Refer to Table 14-1
Voltage Measurement.) Run this test with only the CPUII( )-U( ) ETU
and the ESI(8)-U( ) ETU installed.
Table 14-1 Voltage Measurement
Voltages
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
+5V
–-24V
Tolerance
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU
+5 ± 0.25V
–24 ± 0.25V
AC Voltage (117 Vac)
Line to Neutral
Line to Conduit Ground
Neutral to Conduit Ground
117 Vac ± 15%
117 Vac ± 15%
.05 Vac (maximum)
Ring Generator (SLT)
70 ~ 120 Vac @ 20 Hz
CO Line
Off-hook line current
Measuring Points
Ring voltage
may be lower
if the meter
measures only
60 Hz signals.
25 ~ 50 mA
TP1
TP2
TP3
+5V
GND
–24V
AC Terminal Strip
Line L to N
Line L to G
Line N to G
Across Tip and Ring of Ringing
SLT
In series with Tip side of the CO
line at the MDF
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 2
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
3.2.3
Initialization Check
To determine if the system is initializing correctly, only the Basic
KSU, CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, one ESI(8)-U( ) ETU, and terminals should
be installed on the system. After initialization, all the terminals
assigned to the ESI(8)-U( ) ETU can be used for internal calls to one
another. (By default, these stations are assigned station numbers
101~108).
3.3
System Initialization
After the steps described in Section 3.2 Before Initializing are performed and
verified, the entire system should be initialized.
With power OFF, all interface and option cards can be installed in the basic
KSU. The technician can then power up the system to perform a First
Initialization. After the initialization, each station display shows default time
and date indications.
For example:
3.4
12-2 Fri 10:47 AM
After Initialization
Ensure that the battery is installed in CN6 on the
CPUII( )-U10 ETU.
Check all ETU slots in software to ensure the initialization process scanned
the installed hardware correctly.
A general system operation check should be performed using default values
prior to system programming.
After all previous steps are performed and any problems corrected, system
programming is complete.
After System Programming is finished, the technician should perform a
Second Initialization. Performing the First Initialization a second time causes
all programming memory to be lost. Second Initialization refreshes the system
RAM without losing any memory.
This completes the installation procedure for the Electra Elite IPK II system.
The technician should check the operation of each Multiline Terminal to
ensure the system is working properly.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
SECTION 4
TROUBLESHOOTING
4.1
Remote Administration and Maintenance
PCPro can remotely access the Electra Elite IPK II system for maintenance
and diagnostics. The remote PC and the system are connected using a
modem on the CPUII( )-U( ) ETU or using IP.
4.2
Problem Solving
To find the cause, consider all problem symptoms carefully. As each aspect
of the problem is considered, the technician is guided to a probable solution.
The problem must be defined as accurately as possible, so that the most
efficient steps to the solution can be taken. Flowcharts in the next section
help define the problem.
4.2.1
System Down
This term describes one of the following situations:
J
J
J
4.2.2
No access to internal dial tone on any Multiline Terminal or
Single Line Telephone is installed.
No LED indication, display indication, or Multiline Terminal is
installed.
No system tones are generated.
Partial Operation
This term refers to any situation that cannot be completely described
under the System Down conditions.
4.2.3
Reset
At times, the station and/or the ETU must be reset. The following
resets are used in the system:
J
J
Terminal Reset – Unplug the station line cord from the station
and then plug it back into the station.
ETU Reset – Press the RESET switch.
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 4
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
4.3
Flowcharts
Condition
Flowchart
Page
1. No Internal Dial Tone to any
Multiline Terminal or SLT
A1
14-6
2. No LED or Display Indications
on any Multiline Terminal
A2
14-7
1. Radio Frequency Interference
B1
14-8
2. No or Intermittent CO/PBX Ring
C1
14-9
3. Call Dropping
C2
14-10
4. No Outside Dial Tone Access
C3
14-11
5. CO/PBX Dialing Problem:
Cannot Dial Out on CO
C4
14-12
1. Multiline Terminal Function
D1
14-13
2. Multiline Terminal Ringing
D2
14-14
3. Multiline Terminal Dial Tone
Access
D3
14-15
1. No Dial Tone Access on SLT
E1
14-16
2. No Ringing on SLT
E2
14-17
3. No Dial Access to SLT Features
E3
14-18
E.
Low Volume Problems
F1
14-19
F.
External Paging Problems
G1
14-20
G.
SMDR Output Problems
No Call Accounting System
H1
14-21
A. System Down
B.
C.
D.
Partial Operations
Multiline Terminal Problems
Single Line Telephone Problems
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 5
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
A1
No internal Dial Tone to any Multiline Terminal or SLT
All DC
Voltages
Correct?
Incorrect or No DC Voltage
Check AC Input
Power.
Good
Turn system Off. Disconnect all
connectors and remove all printed circuit
boards except CPUII( )-U( ) ETU and the
first installed ESI(8)-U( ) ETU in the basic
KSU associated with the programming
station.
Dial Tone
Build system, one card at
a time until problem
reappears. Replace
defective card.
Turn system On.
Dial Tone on Multiline
Terminal on 1st
ESI(8)-U( ) ETU?
Correct AC Power
Problem.
AC Power?
Good
Replace
Fuse(s).
Bad
PSU Fuses
F1 and F2
good?
Good
Replace Corresponding
Power Supply.
No Dial Tone
Reset ESI(8)-U10. If trouble
persists, replace ESI(8)-U( ) ETU.
Bad
Yes
Problem
Solved?
Done.
No
Yes
Remove all ETUs but
one ESI, and retest.
Dial tone?
No
1. If problem not solved, perform First Initialization
and test. If trouble persists go to step 2.
2. Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU and test system using
default program.
Build system
one card at a
time and
replace bad
ETU(s).
Yes
Problem
Solved?
No
Replace KSU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 6
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
A2
No LED or Display Indications on any Multiline Terminal
All DC
Voltages
OK?
Incorrect or No DC Voltage
Check AC Input
Power.
Good
Terminate one Multiline Terminal from
the basic KSU, 1st ESI(8)-U10
(Programming Station) directly to MDF
and test.
Yes
Check
Station
Cabling.
No
Terminal
Indications?
Correct AC Power
Problem.
Turn system Off. Disconnect
connectors; remove all ETUs
except CPUII( )-U( ) ETU and
first installed ESI(8)-U10 in
basic KSU, associated with the
programming station.
Bad
AC Power?
Good
Replace
Fuse(s).
Bad
PSU Fuses
F1 and F2
Good?
Good
No Indication
Replace Corresponding
Power Supply.
Terminal
Installed
Indication?
Yes
Reset ESI(8)-U10. If trouble
persists, replace ESI(8)-U( ).
Correct
Indication
Done.
Problem
Solved?
No
Correct
Indications?
Rebuild System one card at
a time. If problem reappears
replace defective card(s).
None
1. If problem not solved, perform First Initialization
and test. If trouble persists go to step 2.
2. Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU and test system using
default program.
Build system
one card at a
time and
replace bad
ETU(s).
Remove all ETUs but
one ESI, and retest.
Yes
Problem
Solved?
No
Replace KSU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 7
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
B1
Radio Frequency Interference (RFI)
Is interference only on outside calls
or anytime station is off-hook?
Remove one CO line
at MDF and test using
standard SLT.
On CO calls only
RFI Event?
Multiline Terminal off-Hook
No
RFI on CO
Lines?
Check cable for the
affected terminal(s).
Yes
More than 1-pair
Twisted
No
Twisted
pair?
Ground all unused
pairs at MDF.
No
RFI Cleared?
Cable with 1-pair twisted
pair cable.
No
RFI Cleared?
Yes
Yes
End
Inform
Telco.
End
Follow the steps below, one at a time, and test after each step.
1. Place a 0.01 microfarad ceramic capacitor (0.001 microfarad for FM Interference)
across receiver and transmitter elements in the Multiline Terminal handset.
2. Add a 0.01 microfarad ceramic capacitor from one transmit lead to one receive lead.
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 8
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
C1
No or Intermittent CO/PBX Ring
Test to see if problem occurs
on one line or several lines.
Several Lines
One Line
Check PRG 22-04 to ensure that line is
programmed to ring on an installed
station.
See if problem occurs on
all Multiline Terminals
Assigned Ringing.
Occurrence?
All Terminals
Yes
Occurrence?
Ringing
Assigned?
Not all terminals
Replace one terminal
that has problems.
No
Program ring assignment
and
. test.
Still have
Problem?
Cleared
Yes
End.
No
Corrected?
Program station for off-hook and
day/night ring, deny DND feature,
Not Cleared and test again.
Yes
No
See if affected lines
can be isolated to One
COI(8)-U10 ETU.
Corrected?
Done.
Return defective Multiline
Terminal for repair.
Yes
Reset/ Replace
COI(8)-U10 ETU.
1 COI(8)-U10
ETU?
No
Perform the following tests:
1. Measure CO ring voltage with AC meter
(100 Vac 20 Hz) at the MDDF.
2. Perform Second Initialization.
3. Place external ringer in front of system on
worst case CO line. Check if customer
can hear external ringer at times when the
system does not detect ringing on this line.
4. If problem is not solved, perform First
Initialization and replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU.
Test system using default program.
Check whether or not
affected lines can be
.
isolated
to one KSU.
Yes
No
Corrected?
Done.
No
Yes
Basic KSU?
Replace Ribbon cable
between KSUs.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 9
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
C2
Call Dropping
See if problem exists
on all Lines.
No
Yes
Calls
dropped on
all lines?
No
Yes
All
lines at same
time?
Check DC voltages with
a meter and AC power
with a line disturbance
analyzer.
Check outside line key
after call drops.
On
Check COI(8)-U10 LED.
CO
Line Key
LED Status?
Off
Have Telco check line circuits.
Increase Automatic Release
Signal Detection Time. Refer to
PRG 14-02-09.
Off
COI(8)-U10
LED Status?
1. Perform Second Initialization.
If trouble persists go to step 2.
2. Replace COI(8)-U10 ETU. Test.
On
Have Telco check
Line circuit(s).
No
Problem
Solved?
Perform First Initialization.
Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU,
and test system using
default program.
Yes
Return Defective ETU
for repair.
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 10
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
C3
No Outside Dial Tone Access
SLT
Multiline
Terminal or SLT?
Yes
Check for Internal
Dial tone.
No
All
Terminals
affected?
No
Both
Internal
Dial Tone?
Check for Internal
Dial tone.
Yes
Check for Internal
Dial tone.
No
Internal
Dial Tone?
1. Reset terminal
and test.
2. Replace terminal
OR
Reset ESI(8)-U10
ETU and test.
3. Replace ESI(8)-U10
and test.
Internal
Dial Tone?
Yes
No
1. Perform Second
Initialization.
2. Reset and test
SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU.
3. Replace and test
SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU.
Go to Flowchart
A1.
Leave an SLI(4)/(8)-U( )
ETU and an ESI(8)-U( )
ETU installed. Go to
Flowchart A1.
Yes
Test for CO dial
tone at MDF with
test set, and check
CO wiring.
No
Yes
Check SW 1~8 on COI(8)-U10
ETU for proper switch setting.
1. Check PRG 21-04 and 14-01-07 for
Station Restriction.
2. Check PRG 15-06 for Trunk access.
CO
Dial Tone?
Have Telco
check lines.
Check conduit and frame ground to
system for ground start trunks.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Reset and test; replace COI(8)-U10 ETU and test. If trouble persists go to step 2.
Perform Second Initialization. If trouble persists go to step 3.
Perform First Initialization. If trouble persists go to step 4.
Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, and test using default program.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 11
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
C4
CO/PBX Dialing Problem: Cannot Dial Out on CO
Check CO lines at MDF
with test set to see if they
are DTMF or DP.
No
SLT
problem
only?
Yes
Check
PRG 15-03-01.
DP
DTMF
DTMF
Line type
program?
DP or
DTMF?
DP
Check CO lines at MDF
with test set to see if they
are DTMF or DP.
Check PRG 14-01-10
Selection to ensure lines are
programmed for DP.
DTMF
DP
DP or
DTMF?
Programmed
for?
DP
DP or
DTMF?
DTMF
DP
DTMF
Check CO lines at MDF
with test set to see if they
are DTMF or DP.
Program lines for DTMF.
Program lines for DP.
Program as DP.
Monitor Line with test set, and
verify if system is sending digits.
Yes
No
Digits Sent?
1. If lines are DTMF, increase the DTMF
duration in PRG 80-02-01.
2. If lines are DP, choose 10 or 20 pps
option in PRG 14-02-01.
3. Check off-hook CO line current.
1. Reset COI(8)-U1- ETU. If trouble persists,
go to next step.
2. Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, and test.
3. Perform Second Initialization, and test.
4. Perform First Initialization, and test.
5. Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 12
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
D1
Multiline Terminal Function Problems
Yes
All
terminals?
Go to Flowchart A2.
No
Check PRG 10-03-01for
correct Station Assignment.
No
Reassign.
Assignment
correct?
Yes
Yes
Perform Multiline Terminal Self Test:
1. Unplug terminal line cord.
2. Hold down * and # together and plug in the line card.
3. Press each terminal key to test tones, LEDs, and key contacts.
4. Return terminal on-line by taking handset off-hook and then
return to on-hook.
Problem
solved?
End.
No
Reset and test. Replace defective
terminal, and test.
No
Yes
Send terminal
in for repair.
Connect terminal directly
to MDF, and test.
Problem
solved?
No
Reset and test. Replace
faulty ESI(8)-U10 ETU.
No
Yes
Send ESI(8)-U10 ETU in
for repair.
Problem
solved?
Problem
solved?
Yes
Replace station cable.
1. Perform Second Initialization, and test.
2. Perform First Initialization, and test.
3. Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, and test using
default program.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 13
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
D2
Multiline Terminal Ringing Problems
Intermittent
Problem?
Go to Flowchart C1.
Consistent
Check to see if problem occurs on CO or
internal calls (including station-to-station
or transferred calls).
Internal
CO
Check to see if station is
call forwarded or in DID.
Problem?
Check PRG 15-07.
Both
Yes
No
Station in
Call Forward
or DID?
Yes
Wrong
Assignment?
Check and adjust
volume control, and
test again.
Program
again.
No
Cancel
feature.
Check PRG 22-04
for ring assignment.
Yes
Problem
Solved?
Done.
Yes
No
Wrong
Assignment?
Reset/replace station,
then reset or replace
ESI(8)-U10 ETU.
Program
again.
No
Yes
Problem
Solved?
Reset/replace station,
then reset or replace
ESI(8)-U10 ETU.
Yes
Send terminal
in for repair.
No
No
Problem
Solved?
Done.
1. Perform Second Initialization, and test.
2. Perform First Initialization, and test.
3. Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, and test
using default program.
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 14
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
D3
Multiline Terminal Dial Tone Access Problems
Check to see if problem occurs
on CO or Internal call.
CO
Go to Flowchart C3.
Internal
CO or
Internal dial
tone?
Go to Flowchart A1.
Both
Go to Flowchart A1.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 15
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
E1
No Dial Tone Access on SLT
Check PRG 10-03 for
SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU assignments.
Yes
End.
No
Problem
solved?
Assignment
correct?
Assign Again.
No
Yes
Both
No CO
or internal
dial tone?
Replace SLT, and test.
Go to Flowchart C3.
Check CO line dial tone on a
Multiline Terminal.
Good
Yes
No
CO
Internal
Problem
solved?
Replace SLT, and test.
Bad
Go to Flowchart C3.
Yes
Problem
solved?
Repair SLT.
No
1. Reset SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU, and test.
2. Replace SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU, and test.
3. Perform Second Initialization, and test.
Yes
Done.
Problem
solved?
No
Leave one SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU, one ESI(8)-U10 ETU, and
CPUII( )-U( ) ETU installed. Go to Flowchart A1.
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 16
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
E2
Ringing Problem on SLT
Replace SLT.
Yes
Problem
solved?
SLT defective.
No
Check to see if ringing
problem is intermittent.
No
Check to see if SLT
is call forwarded.
Intermittent
Problem?
Yes
Yes
No
Cancel call
Forwarding.
Call
Forward?
Check SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU for
ring voltage output with AC
meter.
Pass
Check BLF indication
for station.
Fail
RSG Test?
Replace SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU.
Busy
BLF
Indication?
Terminate SLT on MDF.
Idle
1. Reset/replace SLI(4)/(8)-U10 ETU, and test.
2. Perform Second Initialization, and test; then
perform First Initialization and test.
3. Change CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, and test
using default program.
Busy
Check MDF
connection.
Idle
BLF
Indication?
Check/replace
station cable.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 17
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
E3
No Dial Access to Features on SLT
Check to see if SLT can access
internal or CO dial tone.
No
Access dial
tone?
Go to Flowchart E1.
Yes
Check PRG 20-06 for
feature assignment.
Good
No
Feature
allowed?
Program C.O.S. to allow
feature, and test.
Done.
Yes
Bad
Check PRG 11-01 and
11-10~11-15 for access
assignment.
No
Correct
Access Code?
Recheck feature access with
correct Access Code.
Yes
Recheck SLT features operation
selection to verify procedure for
feature.
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 18
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
F1
Low Volume Problems
Yes
No
All lines?
No
Yes
Yes
Bridge on
system CO
line?
All stations?
Remove it.
No
Move suspected bad line to
good COI(8)-U10 ETU port.
Move good line to original
COI(8)-U10 ETU port.
Replace
Multiline SLT.
Run a dB level test at DMARK
on lines with 1 kHz test tone. No
less than -8dB at MDF is
required.
Yes
Port
Line
Problem
on port or
line?
Check line with dB
meter and/or contact
Telco.
Reset or replace
COI(8)-U10, and
test again.
Less than
-8 dB?
Report Problem
to Telco.
No
Replace COI(8)-U10 ETU.
Yes
Problem
solved?
Done.
No
1. Perform Second Initialization, and test.
2. Perform First Initialization, and test with
default program.
3. Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 19
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
G1
External Paging Problems
No
Yes
Amplifier
provided?
Install amplifier.
Place Test Set on output of paging
at KSU port or PDG(2)-U10 ADP
with all external wiring removed.
Yes
External
page heard on
test set?
External amplifier or PRG
11-01 and 11-10~11-15
No
Check PRG 11-01 and 11-10~11-15
for correct access code (external) for
paging.
No
Access Code
correct?
Yes
Pass
1. Reset/replace PDG(2)-U10 ADP, and test.
2. Perform Second Initialization, and test; then
perform First Initialization and test.
3. Replace CPUII( )-U( ) ETU, and test
using default program.
Retest using
correct access
code.
Done.
Fail
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 20
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
H1
SMDR Output Problems (No Call Accounting System)
No
Yes
Incoming
problem only?
Serial
Check PRG 35-02-08.
Output
Method?
TAPI Adaptor
TCP/IP
Is Output Type Set
correctly? Check
PRG 35-01-01.
Yes
GO
to A
No
No
Is Output Type Set
correctly? Check
PRG 35-01-01.
Set PRG
35-01-01
Correctly.
Yes
GO
to A
Set PRG
35-01-01
Correctly.
Is Output Type Set
correctly? Check
PRG 35-01-01.
Yes
No
Set PRG
35-01-01
Correctly.
GO
to B
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 21
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
A
Is SMDR
port
Correct?
Yes
Is language
Correct?
No
No
Correct the language.
Check PRG 35-01-03
and 80-05-01.
Yes
Yes
Does the
trunk
provide
SMDR?
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
Set Trunk to provide.
Check PRG 14-01-06.
Include the call type.
Check:
PRG 35-01-05 ~ 07
35-02-01 ~ 03.
Set port correctly for
Trunks and Dept.
Groups. Check PRG
35-03-01, 35-04-01.
Is call type
included in
the report?
Is the call
type
included in
SMDR?
Yes
Does
extension
provide
SMDR?
Yes
No
No
Set Extension to
provide.
Check PRG 15-01-03.
Include the call type.
Check
PRG 35-02-08 ~ 12.
End
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 22
System Maintenance
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
B
Yes
Yes
Is the
adapter
CTA or
CTU?
No
End
Set CTA/CTU Mode
for extension in
PRG 15-02-19.
Yes
No
DIP Switches
2, 5, 6 On and
1, 3, 4, 7, 8 Off?
Yes
Solved?
No
Yes
Correct USB
Driver
Installed?
No
Yes
No
End
Correct DIP
Switches.
No
End
Replace
cable.
No
Yes
Solved?
Yes
Solved?
End
Correct DIP
Switches.
No
No
End
Correct DIP
Switches.
Yes
Yes
Solved?
End
Correct Baud Rate in
PRG 15-02-20.
No
Yes
Yes
Solved?
Station set for
CTA/CTU Mode ? No
Check PRG
15-02-19.
Yes
No
Is cable
between
adapter and PC
good?
No
No
No
Yes
Are DIP
switches set to
1 and 2 On
3 and 8 Off?
Define the
extension in
PRG 35-01-02.
Yes
End
Set CTA/CTU Mode
for extension in
PRG 15-02-19.
Solved?
Baud Rate
Correct?
Check PRG
15-02-20.
CTU extension for
SMDR defined?
Check PGR 35-01-02.
Yes
Yes
Define the
extension in
Solved?
PRG 35-01-02.
No
Station set for
CTA/CTU Mode ?
Check PRG
15-02-19.
No
CTU
CTA
CTA extension for
No
SMDR defined?
Check PGR 35-01-02.
Yes
Solved?
Power Cord
with Ferrite
beads installed?
No
End
Correct DIP
Switches.
Yes
Solved?
End
Yes
Is the driver for
the adapter
correct?
No
Yes
Install
correct
Driver.
No
Solved?
Yes
End
Problem
solved?
Replace Adapter.
Yes
End
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
14 - 23
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
14 - 24
System Maintenance
Glossary of Abbreviations
Appendix A
___________________________________________________________________________________
The following table includes common abbreviations used throughout this document
that are listed in alphabetical order.
Abbreviations
Definition
ACD
Automatic Call Distribution
Provides a cost-effective method for supervising incoming telephone
traffic and associated staff activity.
AIS
Alarm Indication Signal
Replaces the normal traffic signal when a maintenance alarm indication
is activated. An AIS signal is transmitted downstream to indicate an
upstream failure was detected.
BHCA
Business-Hour Call Attempts
The number of times a telephone call is attempted during the busiest
hour of the day.
BNC
Bayonet-Neill-Concelman
Connector for slim coaxial cables. This is similar to ones used with
Ethernet.
BPV
Bipolar Violation
Indicates the presence of two consecutive one bits of the same polarity
on a T carrier line.
BRI
Basic Rate Interface
ISDN subscriber interface. BRI has two bearer B-channels at 64 Kbps
per second and a D-channel at 16 Kbps per second. The bearer
B-channels are provided for PCM voice, video conferencing, group 4
facsimile machines, and other similar types of transmissions. The data
D-channel is used to bring in information about incoming calls and take
out information about outgoing calls. BRI can also be used to access
slow-speed data networks such as videotex and packet switched
networks.
BRI has two standards:
U Interface for 2-wire
T Interface for 4-wire
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
A-1
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
Abbreviations
Definition
CRC
Cyclic Redundancy Check
CRC is a common method to establish that the data is correctly received
in data communications. This process checks the integrity of a data
block. A CRC character is generated at the transmission end. Its value
depends on the hexadecimal value of the number of ones in the data
block. The transmitting device calculates the value and appends it to
the data block. The receiving end makes a similar calculation and
compares its results with the added character. If there is a difference,
the recipient requests retransmission.
DN
Directory Number
Unique number (telephone number) assigned to each telephone or data
terminal.
ISDN
Integrated Services Digital Network
An international plan to migrate the public switched network to the
universal implementation of standard digital technology.
LBO-Line Build
Out
A combination of induction, capacitance, and resistance is added to a
cable pair to increase its electrical length by a desired level of
impedance and loss characteristics.
Local Loop
Back
An internal process where data goes through the entire chip during
Transmit and Receive cycles.
Line Loop Back
Allows the user to check Transmission Line Continuity.
LSA
Line Synchronization Alarm Detection
An FT1 trunk looses frame synchronization. Frame synchronization
occurs when a given digital channel (time slot) at the receiving end is
aligned with the corresponding channel (time slot) of the transmitting
end as it occurs in the received signal. Usually extra bits (frame
synchronization bits) are inserted at regular intervals to indicate the
beginning of a frame and for use in frame synchronization.
LCR
Least Cost Routing
A feature that automatically chooses the lowest cost telephone line to
the destination.
OOF
Out-of-Frame Condition
During FT1 transmission, an Out-of-Frame error occurs when two or
more of four consecutive framing bits are in error. When this condition
exists for more than 2.5 seconds a Red alarm is sent by the OOF
detecting unit. Equipment that receives this Red alarm responds with a
Yellow alarm.
OPX
Off-Premise Extension
A telephone that is located in a different office or building from the main
phone system. The OPX is connected by a dedicated telephone line.
This extension has all abilities of the telephone system.
___________________________________________________________________________________
A-2
Glossary of Abbreviations
Electra Elite IPK II
Document Revision 3
___________________________________________________________________________________
Abbreviations
PRI
Definition
Primary Rate Interface
ISDN subscriber interface. PRI has 23 bearer B-channels at 64 Kbps
per second and a D-channel at 64 Kbps per second. The bearer
B-channels are provided for PCM voice, video conferencing, group 4
facsimile machines, and other similar types of transmissions. The data
D-channel is used to bring in information about incoming calls and take
out information about outgoing calls. PRI can also be used to access
slow-speed data networks such as videotex and packet switched
networks.
PRI has two standards:
J
J
U Interface for 2-wire
T Interface for 4-wire
SLIP
Serial Line Internet Protocol
An Internet protocol is used to run IP over serial lines such as telephone
circuits. IP is the most important of all protocols on which the Internet is
based. This protocol allows a packet to traverse multiple networks
before it reaches its final destination.
SMDR
Station Message Detail Recording
A feature that collects and records information on outgoing calls by
station.
SPID
Service Profile Identifier
ISDN service is ordered with certain parameters. The SPID is an 8- to
12-digit number that uniquely identifies the service ordered. The
telephone company assigns an SPID for every phone number. Each
ISDN BRI line usually has two telephone numbers.
The SPID is a label identifier that points to a particular location on the
telephone company central office memory that stores the details of the
ISDN services ordered. This number is necessary for the operation of
the ISDN telephone, fax, or PC software. Without this number, ISDN
services cannot be accessed.
VoIP
Voice over Internet Protocol
The ability to carry normal telephone-style voice over an IP-based
internet with POTS-like functionality, reliability, and voice quality.
The Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) connects to the LAN
IP network through a VoIP gateway. Digitized speech is transported
through IP packets and can include real-time conversation or voice mail.
The IP network can be public or private, and voice transport can be
telephone-to-telephone, computer-to-telephone, or
computer-to-computer.
___________________________________________________________________________________
System Hardware Manual
A-3
Document Revision 3
Electra Elite IPK II
___________________________________________________________________________________
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
___________________________________________________________________________________
A-4
Glossary of Abbreviations
YSTEM HARDWARE MANUAL
S
NEC Unified Solutions, Inc.
Document Revision 3
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertising